Baensch Aquarium Atlas (Vol. 3) [3 ed.]
 3882440538, 9783882440539

Citation preview

___BAENSCH

a >

ee a

HH

THE BAENSCH ATL,ta COLLECTION {| Internationally acclaimed for the

breadth of their coverage and the depth of information included, the

Baensch Atlases are time-tested reference tools for aquarists, divers, — snorkellers and natural history explorers the world over.

Subject categories include: Freshwater Aquariums & Species Fishes, aquatic plants, captive system set-up and maintenance Marine Aquariums & Species Fishes, invertebrates, macro-algae, systems and husbandry Water Gardens & Pond Species Planning, building and stocking outdoor aquatic gardens

Natural History Fossil fishes, reproductions of classic ichthyological art and other works.

_ For further information on these and other Baensch Atlases inthe

English language, please contact:

MICROCOSM Ltd. P.O: Box 580

=

- Shelburne; VT

ce

USA"

05482:

5

|



WON)

NNN

TTAN PUBLIC LIBRARY DISTR

MANHATTAN PUBLIC LIBRARY DISTRICT PO BOX 53 240 WHITSON ST. MANHATTAN,

IL 60442

DEMCO

OCT 3 0 2006

Digitized by the Internet Archive in 2023 with funding from Kahle/Austin Foundation

https://archive.org/details/aquariumatlasOOO0Orieh_x1p4

“This book 6s dedicated to my wife Barbara Dr. Rudiger Riehl

Coverphotos: Title:

Melanotaenia boesemani Arend van den Nieuwenhuizen,

Backcover:

Aphyosemion [Diapteron] sp. Arend van den Nieuwenhuizen

Corydras adolfoi, C. imitator David Sands

Aulonocara hansbaenschi Manfred K. Meyer

Hygrophyla stricta Kurt Paffrath

Page 3:

Aphyosemion huwaldi Steffen Hellner

"Fullaba"

Publisher: Hans A. Baensch

Editor: Dr. Rudiger Riehl Translated and revised by: Gero W. Fischer, Ph.D. Shellie E. Borrer, M.S.

© Copyright 1996/1997 MERGUS®-Verlag, 49302 Melle, Germany ® MERGUS is a registered trademark in USA

All rights reserved. No part of this book may be reproduced or transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic or mechanical, including photocopying, recording, or by any information storage and retrieval system, without the written permission of the Publisher, except where permitted by law. Library of Congress Catalog Card Number 95-21997

ISBN: 1-890087-14-9 (U.S.A. only) ISBN: 3-88244-053-8 (For other countries)

First English Edition, 1996 Second Revised English Edition, 1997

MICROCOSM Published in the United States by: Microcosm Ltd., 2085 Shelburne Road, Shelburne, Vermont 05482 Distribution USA: Canada: Great Britain:

Australia:

4:4:

Microcosm Ltd., 2085 Shelburne Road, Shelburne, Vermont 05482 Rolf C. Hagen Inc., 3225 Sartelon Street, Montreal, Que. H4R 1E8 Rolf C. Hagen (U.K.) Limited, California Drive, Whitwood Industrial Estate, Castleford WF 10 50H, West Yorkshire, England. Pet Pacific Pty Ltd., Unit C, 30 Skarratt Street, Auburn NSW 2144, P.O. Box 398, Rydalmere NSW 2116, Australia

Printed in Singapore

&:

Dr. Rudiger Riehl

Hans A. Baensch

AQUARIUM ATLAS Volume 3

Bee > MERGUS Publishers of Natural History and Pet Books Hans A. Baensch « Melle *»Germany

MANHATTAN P'RILIC LIBRARY DIST.

Preface Preface to Volume 3

After Aquarium Atlas Volumes 1 and 2, no enhancement seemed possible. However, after laborious work we have again successfully collected over 1,000 color photographs of species not presented in the previous volumes of the Aquarium Atlas. It was then merely a question of time and detective work to collect the necessary textual information. A newly installed computer significantly eased this task. Today we can print out the names of over 6,500 freshwater fishes and search and sort them by scientific data and photos.

Your help in improving and augmenting our texts is always welcome, since pertinent literature is often scant. Only experience helps further. Hobbyists frequently work hand in hand with science. This volume

again emphasizes

cattfishes,

killifishes and,

naturally,

the cichlids—the eternal favorites of most aquarists. But Russian species, hereto almost unknown in Western Europe, the United States, Canada,

and the Far East, have been

included to a larger

degree than previously. It will probably be several years more unti! these species appear in our aquaria. The sometimes exotic beauty of species from the Amur River (the “Russian Amazon”) will fascinate some western aquarists. Garden ponds and coldwater aquaria will be enriched by their presence. The aquarium hobby has a never ending diversity to draw upon. This diversity complemented with breeding efforts and information gained—from aquarists—will help ensure that we have the knowledge and ability to protect species from outside pressures threatening extinction. Hans

Frey, the old master of aquarium

literature since 1950, once

wrote the following to me in a book dedication: Aquarism is merry science and serious hobby. This is the vein in which we published Aquarium Atlas 3. It is not lacking—yet makes a lovely and enjoyable addition.

3 8001 00071 2145

For help with this extensive volume we especially want to extend our thanks to the following persons:

Hans-Joachim Herrmann (Cichlids) Harro Hieronimus (Catfishes and many other species) Hans Horsthemke (Gobies) Manfred K. Meyer (Livebearers) Gerhard Ott (Cyprinids) Kurt Paffrath (Plants) Gina and Mike Sandfort—British Catfish Ass. (Catfishes) Jurgen Schmidt (Labyrinth fishes, characins, and other species) Lothar Seegers (Killifishes and other species) Andreas Spreinat (Cichlids) Rainer Stawikowski (Cichlids) Uwe Werner (Cichlids) Axel Zarske (Cyprinids) —and the many unnamed aquarists We are presently working on Aquarium Atlas Volume 4, and we appreciate all contrioutions our readers care to make in regard to photographs and additional textual information. Only with your helo can the Aquarium Atlas continue to present a continuously expanding and up-to-date knowledge base. Rudiger Riehl Dusseldorf

Hans A. Baensch Melle

Spring 1997

.

Table of Contents =) fs(01 EPR ene

ee Ron eco

Rona cir ance’ faberinscgneedcbodanacsn20c6p60 4

The Plants (elaborated by Kurt Paffrath) .......cceeeeeeeeenees 7-71 Definition Of the Groups’... sccceeeeece eee eeseteenen cetiemente terre ae oer aaeens 8 Explanation: Of the SyMDOts yer rccire..encetercnenatee esteem 12-13 Photographs and Descriptions of 64 Aquarium Plants......... 14-71 1).. Plants: with: Upright Stennis gal). Propagation not always easy.

Sim! CHO 2 Hardness up to 10° KH

Plants within this group are not very adaptable and generally require soft water. They normally have a high light requirement of about 1 watt per 1.5 liters (?/, gal). Propagation usually difficult. pH 6.0-6.8 Hardness up to 4° KH

12

Plants KH = Carbonate Hardness

The proportion of carbonate hardness in the water often determines the well-being of the plants. Very soft water, below 2° KH, is usually less suitable for plant growth, but the overall ability of the plant to adapt to a certain hardness range decides the issue. Some plants have to have soft water. Numerous plants, although tolerant of higher carbonate hardnesses, respond to a higher pH or low carbon dioxide concentrations by diminished growth. Information in the data line below each species shows the most favorable range for plant growth. Minor fluctuations are possible, as many factors are interrelated. !t is best not to combine plants with widely differing requirements. pH = Acidity and Alkalinity of the Water This is the acidity or alkalinity at which the plant grows best. Most plants prefer the favorable range of 6.5-7.2. While the pH can fluctuate above or below the suggested value, many species or genera may be harmed by values too deviant from the suggested range. If problems in growth are noted, pH can easily be measured to identify or eliminate it as the source of the problem. Plants with widely differing preference should not be panice in the same

tank. T = Temperature The range in which the plant grows best under normal conditions is indicated. The optimum is usually slightly above the middle value. In certain species, 2°C above the listed values is possible, but higher levels of nutrients and light have to be provided to compensate for increased respiration.

AH = Aquarium Height The appropriate aquarium height for the species is listed. Tall plants, large rhizome plants, and rapid growing stalked plants should be placed in aquaria which are as roomy and tall as possible. In shallow aquaria, such plants are out of place or have to be pruned too often. Plants that are low or moderately tall are suitable for any tank in regard to height, but keep in mind the light-attenuating effect of water which may result in small or small-leaved stalked plants languishing from lack of light in tall aquaria. For brevity, tank heights are grouped into three types. AH=1 Small aquaria up to 35 cm (14”) in height. AH=2 Medium aquaria up to about 45 cm (18”) in height. AH=8 Large aquaria more than 45 cm (18”) in height.

~

1.

Plants with Upright Stems

1.1.

Leaves Alternate

Eichhornia natans

+(BEAUVOIS) SOLMS-LAUBACH

(1882)

Fam.: Pontederiaceae Hab.: Tropical Africa. Main axis is erect, later becoming natant. Aquatic leaves are alternate (opposite) with those at the apex usually arranged in a spiral. Blade is entire and clasping, up to 6 cm long, 0.7 cm wide, and narrowing uniformly towards its obtuse tip. There are 3-4 fine veins between each of the 5 main veins. Floating leaves are broad, cordate, and 4 cm long and wide with a cordate and overlapping base. Peduncle grows up to 6 cm long and has a 3 cm sheath at its base. Inflorescences are situated in the axils and are reduced to one small, blue, 6 petaled flower on each. Either suitable as a submersed aquatic plant or in its natant form. It is extremely difficult to cultivate, quickly perishing in hard water. Very soft water is a prerequisite. Under proper conditions, the submersed leaves are long-lived. However, it tends to regularly develop floating leaves. Small flowers are produced in its natant form under strong illumination. Eichhornia diversifolia is a significantly better aquarium plant. It was presented in Vol. 2, p. 48.

Prop.: Lateral shoots.

D: 4, KH: 2-4, pH: 5.5-6.5, T: 22°-25°C, AH: 1-2

Hydrocotyle lemnoides Fam.: Apiaceae

BENTHAM (1868)

Hab.: Australia. The thin shoot is upright when submersed. Leaves are alternate, reniform to roundish, indented at the base, and up to 1 cm wide with 3 notched cuneate lobes. Each blade is supported by a short petiole. There are tiny umbels in the axils with 4-5 small, often imperfect flowers. An adaptable, easily grown aquarium plant. Even new water rarely causes problems. Although the stems are not expressly light-demanding, they should

nevertheless be exposed to direct light. Besides the submersed form, there is a floating form. Its thin, creeping, emersed shoots make a good ground cover in bog aquaria. Prop.: Self-branching of the shoots. D: 1, KH: 2-15, pH: 6.0-7.8, T: 22°-28°C, AH: 1-3

14

Plants ee

Hydrocotyle lemnoides

ee

~

1.

Plants with Upright Stems

1.1.

Leaves Alternate

Mayaca sellowiana

KUNTH (1843)

Fam.: Mayacaceae

Hab.: South America. Leaves are linear, pointed, up to 1.5 cm long, 0.15 cm wide, and arranged in alternate spirals. Blade is single veined. The upper side of the leaf is light green, while the underside is light pink. The land form is prostrate with needle-shaped aerial leaves. Flowers are single and axile with 3 white petals, 3 yellow short filamented stamens, and a very short style with a tiny stigma. A delicate plant for moderately tall aquaria that fulfill its requirements. Soft water is preferred; light requirement is high. Let it grow undisturbed, regularly trimming the surface-reaching shoots and planting anew. In time, dense decorative bunches form.

Prop.: Self-branching.

D: 3, KH: 2-5, pH: 5.5-6.8, T: 24°-26°C, AH: 1-2

Potamogeton pusillus

LINNE (1753)

Fam.: Potamogetonaceae Hab.: Europe, Asia, Africa, America.

The thin elongated main shoot is richly branched. Leaves are slender, up to 6 cm long, 0.2 cm wide, and pointed with 1-3 fine, longitudinal veins emerging from the base. The spike grows up to 0.7 cm long and bears few blooms. This is one of the few Potamogeton of temperate latitudes that can be kept in the aquarium for extended periods of time, largely due to the fact that these plants are often found in warm subtropical regions. Intense illumination is suggested. Grouped shoots will soon develop lateral shoots which grow into an extensive stand. Densely intertwined mats result in the garden pond, where this hardy aquatic plant grows well. Prop.: Lateral shoots. D: 2, KH: 5-12, pH: 6.0—7.5, T: 10°-25°C, AH: 1-3

Polygonum javanicum

DE BRUYN

Fam.: Polygonaceae Hab.: Southeast Asia. Aquatic shoots are erect with divided, slender leaves. Blade is up to 9 cm long, 1.5 cm wide with a pointed tip, cuneate base, and finely serrate or ciliate edges. Running next to the main vein are 15 pairs of finer lateral veins. The inflorescence is branched and eachshort spike bears up to 20 small white blooms. It is best to only use moderately long cuttings. These are introduced shallowly and left undisturbed to root. Aerial leaves, if present, quickly die. But by that time, sufficient aquatic leaves are generally present so that the plant can continue to grow. The light requirement is high. Under moderate light, the shoots become excessively elongated and the leaves remain small. Prop.: Lateral shoots.

D: 2, KH: 5-10, pH: 6.0-7.5, T: 22°-26°C, AH: 2

16

Plants

Polygonum javanicum

»

1..

Plants with Upright Stems

1.1.

Leaves Alternate

Saururus cernuus

LINNE (1753)

Lizard-tail, water dragon, swamp lily

Fam.: Saururaceae — Lizard-tails Hab.: States along the Atlantic seaboard of North America.

Leaves grow alternately on an erect axis. The variable-sized blade is between 5 and 10 cm long and 3-5 cm wide with a pointed tip. A decorative, appreciated group plant that needs

intense illumination.

Other require-

ments are moderate. When decorating the aquarium, this plant can be used in a variety of ways. The simplest use for this species is to plant it in groups, but another method involves taking cuttings of various lengths and densely planting them with the shortest in the foreground and the tallest in the back, creating a “plant street.” However, the latter method demands regular and intense care. Prop.: Lateral shoots after cutting.

D: 2, KH: 5-12, pH: 6.0-7.5, T: 22°-30°C, AH: 1-3

Zosterella dubia

(JAQUIN) SMALL (1913)

Syn.: Heteranthera dubia, Heteranthera graminea Fam.: Pontederiaceae Hab.: Central America, southern North America. The main axis is thin and elongated with long internodes. Leaves are linear, alternate, sessile, up to 12 cm long and 0.5 cm wide, entire, green to brown in color, and long tipped. The central vein is pronounced, while the lateral veins are faint. In the axils of floating shoots, there are single, pedunculated blooms. The flower is about 2 cm in diameter and has six linear, yellow petals. Terrestrial shoots creep in shallow water and

produce fleshy aerial leaves. Undemanding plant when provided with unobstructed illumination, temperate temperatures, and water that is not overly soft water. Its elongated internodes allow for rapid upward growth, meaning shoots reach the water

surface even in tall aquaria. Once the shoot reaches the surface, it continues growing in a natant fashion, providing a green zone in the upper water strata with its many lateral shoots. This rapidly growing plant has to be regularly trimmed. During the summer, Zosterella grows in the shallows of warm, bright ponds. There the dense mats produce numerous flowers. Prop.: Cuttings from lateral shoots, self-branching.

D: 2, KH: 5-15, pH: 6.0-7.5, T: 15°-25°C, AH:3

18

Plants

Saururus

Ccernuus Keogee

f

Saururus

cernuus,

inflorescence

~

1.

Plants with Upright Stems

1.2

Leaves Opposite

Alternanthera philoxeroides

GRISEBACH (1879)

Fam.: Amaranthaceae Hab.: Argentina. The main axis and leaves are green. Blades are petiolate, lanceolate, up to 4 cm long and 2 cm wide with a pointed base and tip. Several curved lateral veins emerge from the pronounced central vein. Short capitate (head-shaped) spikes with ca. 20 small white blooms are borne in the leaf axils. This species sometimes appears in the trade mixed among other imported plants, as it is easily confused with Hygrophila polysperma. Little suited for aquaria, since submersed shoots become highly elongated and break the water surface in a few weeks. This process is postponed if the water is kept cool. Generally considered a plant for either bog aquaria or garden ponds. There it forms beautiful, bushy specimens.

Prop.: Lateral shoots.

D: 4, KH: 2-15, pH: 6.0-8.0, T: 15°-20°C, AH: 3

Alternanthera reineckii

BRIQUET (1899)

Type: Slender red Syn.: Al/ternanthera sessilis red Fam.: Amaranthaceae Hab.: South America. This plant was erroneously identified as A. sessilis and presented as such in earlier editions of Vol. 1, pp. 92-93. Aquatic leaves are slender, up to 10 cm long, about 1 cm wide with sinuate edges, a pointed tip, and a base that elongates into a short petiole. Its blade is olive green to brown-red superiorly and wine red inferiorly. This is the best variety of A. reineckii for aquaria. Easily adapts to various conditions. Under intense illumination, the plant is more compact and darker red. Large aquaria are more effective for group plants, where they can serve as an excellent point of emphasis in the decor.

Prop.: Cuttings.

D: 2,.KH: 2-12, pH: 5.5-7.2, T: 24°-30°C, AH: 2-3

Alternanthera reineckii Type: Red-green

BRIQUET (1899)

Fam.: Amaranthaceae Hab.: Tropical South America. An extremely variable species which is divided into different varieties based on leaf shape and color. The variety presented here has characteristic aquatic leaves that are distinctly divergent in color with a green center and dark red edges. Blade is about 8 cm long and 3 cm wide with a pointed tip and base. Because of the green portions of the leaves, this variety is less demanding than, for example, the red Alternanthera “ilacina,” which is likewise a variety of A. reineckii, See Vol. 1, pp. 92-93. A large terraced group provides a striking decorative effect. Refrain from planting the cuttings too close to one another. Prop.: Lateral shoots after cutting.

D: 2, KH: 2-10, pH: 5.5-7.2, T: 24°-30°C, AH: 2-3

20

4

Alternanthera

Alternanthera

philoxeroides

reineckii,

slender red

Alternanthera

reineckii,

red-green

~.

1.

Plants with Upright Stems

1.2

Leaves Opposite

Alternanthera sessilis (LINNAEUS) DE CANDOLLE Fam.: Amaranthaceae Hab.: Tropics of the Old and New World.

(1836)

Basically it has to be said that this plant will not adapt to submersed life and is therefore

totally unsuited for aquaria. Its inappropriateness will not be readily apparent, since it maintains its beauty for several weeks before it begins to dissolve. The bog aquarium represents a better environment. The main axis and leaves are naked, bright red, and shiny. Blades are obtuse, up to 10 cm long and 1 cm wide. Small blood-red clusters of blooms develop in their axils.

Prop.: Cuttings. D: 4, KH: 2-15, pH: 6.0-8.0, T: 20°-25°C, AH: 2-3

Bacopa lanigera (CHAMISSO et SCHLECHTENDAHL) Type: Green-leaved Fam.: Scrophulariaceae Hab.: Brazil.

WETTSTEIN

(1891)

Leaves and stems of the terrestrial form are densely pilose. Blades are sessile, round-

ish-oval, up to 3 cm long and 2.5 cm wide, and light green. The leaf base clasps and overlaps the stem. The single pedunculated blooms are 0.5 cm in diameter with a violet upper labia and a lower labia that is either white with violet venation

or totally violet.

There is a variety with yellow-veined blades which was previously introduced in Vol. 2, pp. 30-31. That variety as well as this one is virtually impossible to adapt to aquatic life. Successful cultivation is contingent on intense illumination and COs and iron fertilization. Prop.: Cuttings. D: 4, KH: 2-8, pH: 6.0-7.0, T: 20°-24°C, AH: 1-2

Bacopa monnieri

(LINNE) PENNELL (1891)

Type: Crenate Fam.: Scrophulariaceae Hab.: Africa. Blades are oval, up to 2 cm long and 0.8 cm wide, with a petiolelike slender base and a rounded tip. Unlike the nominate form with entire leaves, this type has crenate blades. It was first imported from Africa in 1975. This plant does not have the status of species or variety. However, it is more suitability as an aquarium plant than the familiar nominate form. An excellent subject for dense terraces, but intense illumination is needed for tight growth.

Prop.: Cuttings, lateral shoots after cutting. D: 1, KH: 2-15, pH: 6.0-7.5, T: 22°-30°C, AH: 1-3

Crassula aquatica

(LINNE) SCHONLAND (1891)

Fam.: Crassulaceae Hab.: Europe, North America, Siberia.

The ‘slender clasping submersed ieaves are up-to 2 cm long, 0.15 cm wide, sessile, and slightly arched. They are supported by a thin elongated axil. Aerial leaves are shorter, succulent, smooth, and shiny. Almost extinct in nature. Occasionally, pondcultivated plants are sold in pet stores. This is a delicate group plant for cold to temperate aquaria. At higher temperatures, the shoots become progressively weaker. A good addition for the garden pond. Bog plants are annuals, while aquatic plants are perennials.

Prop.: Cuttings. D: 3, KH: 2-15, pH: 6.0-7.8, T: 15°-22°C, AH: 1-2

22

Plants

Bacopa

monnieri crenate

Bacopa

lanigera green-leaved

Crassula

aquatica



1.

Plants with Upright Stems

1.2

Leaves Opposite

Hygrophila polysperma

ANDERS (1867)

Dwarf Hygrophila

Type: Brown-red Fam.: Acanthaceae — Acanthus

Hab.: India. Aquatic leaves are narrowly lanceolate, up to 8 cm long, 0.6 wide, and have a short petiole and a pointed tio. Depending on the illumination, leaf color varies from dark green to brown to olive green. This type was imported for the first time in 1977 and positively identified based on flowering specimens. It differs from the green nominate form that has been imported since 1948 and was introduced in Vol. 1, pp. 98 and 99. Aerial leaves are shorter, lanceolate, brown to dark green, and wavy to crisp. Both the short-bracteate terminal spike and the flowers correspond in morphology to the nominate form. When this plant receives strong, unobstructed light, its leaves are dark brown, creating an interesting color contrast to green plants. The main shoots have numerous branches and quickly create a dense bush. Insure that the plant receives direct light. Prune the shoots regularly and plant anew. Prop.: Lateral shoots, cuttings, self-branching.

D: 2, KH: 2-10, pH: 6.0-7.5, T: 22°-28°C, AH: 2-3

Hygrophila corymbosa

(BLUME) LINDAU (1885)

Fam.: Acanthaceae — Acanthus

— Afrikanischer Wasserfreund Syn.: Hygrophila stricta

Hab.: Africa (Senegal). This plant was imported for the first time in 1977. Aquatic leaves are lanceolate, shortstalked, up to 17 cm long and 2.5 cm wide, uniformly tapering from the center to both ends. The relation of length to width is about 5.5 to 1. In comparison thereof, the blades of the Asian form are about 7 times as long as wide (15 x 2 cm). Emersed leaves are about 7 x 1.8 cm in size, pointed on both ends, and dark green. Like the Asian form, this plant has clusters of blooms in the leaf axils. However, the clusters only consist of 5-7 blooms. Young leaves are slightly reddish and pilose along the edges, but otherwise naked. The aquatic form is difficult to identify. Some of the other Hygrophila species are very similar. The Asian form of H. stricta has narrower leaves, and H. corymbosa has shorter, broader aquatic blades. Excellent aquatic plant that adapts well to almost all conditions. The fast growing shoots have short internodes, producing a leafy, compact solitary plant. Its easy propagation makes this plant eminently suitable for extensive groups in roomy aquaria. Prop.: Lateral shoots.

D: 1, KH: 2-15, pH: 6.5-7.5, T: 24°-80°C, AH: 2-3

24

q

Hygrophila

polysperma,

Hygrophila

corymbosa,

brown-red

Africa

~

1.

Plants with Upright Stems

1.2

Leaves Opposite

Ludwigia palustris

(LINNE) ELLIOTT (1821)

Fam.: Onagraceae — Evening primroses Hab.: Europe, western Asia, Mediterranean region, North America. The axis bears paired, lanceolate to ovate, pointed aerial leaves. Yellow-green, small, crownless blooms are borne in the leaf axils. Different varieties, primarily distributed in North America, are described for this species: var. elongata with large leaves, var. longifolia with long, slender leaves, and var. rotundifolia with round leaves. While European Ludwigia is not normally used as an aquarium plant, it can nevertheless be easily cultivated. Provide the plant with intense light and moderate temperatures. Cuttings off terrestrial plants generally adapt to the aquatic environment without major difficulties.

Prop.: Lateral shoots.

D: 2, KH: 2-10, pH: 6.0-7.5, T: 20°-25°C, AH: 1-3

Ludwigia repens

FORSTER (1771)

Creeping ludwigia, false loosestrife

Fam.: Onagraceae — Evening primroses Hab.: Southern North America, Central America, Caribbean. This species has several geographical morphs or types that do not have the status of variety. For our purposes, the forms are differentiated according to leaf morphology and coloration.

1. Slender-leaved reddish form. Leaves are lanceolate, elliptical, 3 cm long and 1 cm wide, with a pointed tip and a base that narrows into the petiole. Upper side of the leaf is olive green or, depending on the light, partially reddish. Underside is reddish. 2. Slender-leaved green form. Leaves are similar to the form above, but they are dark green superiorly and green, not reddish, inferiorly.

3. Round-leaved reddish form. Leaves are elliptical to roundish, up to 4 cm long and 3.5 cm wide, with a roundish base that narrows into the petiole. The leaf tip is short and curved. Upper side of the leaf is olive green or, depending on the light, partially dark red. Underside is dark red. This form was presented in Vol. 1, pp. 98 and 99.

4. Round-leaved green form. Leaves elongated to roundish, up to 3 cm long and 2 cm wide, with an arched base and: a short,, pointed, arched tip. Upper side of the blade is green, rarely light olive green, and lacks red tones. The lower side of the blade is a light green, not reddish. All forms are undemanding and adaptive aquarium plants and recommended for the aquarium without reservations. Reddish forms seem to be more light requiring than green forms. Plant this species in groups, since the fast growing shoots branch readily and form a dense stand. Regularly shorten and plant the cuttings.

Prop.: Cuttings, self-branching.

D: 1, KH: 2-15, pH: 5.5-7.5, T: 20°-B0°C, AH: 2-3

26

Plants

Ludwigia repens,

slender green form

Ludwigia repens,

slender red form

1.

Plants with Upright Stems

1.2

Leaves Opposite

Najas flexilis

(WILLDENOW)

ROSTKOVIUS et SCHMIDT (1824)

Fam.: Najadaceae Hab.: Europe,

Mediterranean.

Main axis thin, smooth, and flexible. Leaves are linear, occasionally arched back, up to 2 cm long and 0.1 cm wide, with a pointed tip, 2 longitudinal veins, and up to 40 fine teeth along the edge. The angular sheath at the base of the leaf has 5 tiny, pointed teeth. Annuals in nature, but perennials in aquaria. Recommended for cool to moderately warm, brightly lit aquaria. Dense bunches will form in time. This plant will also form a natant mat just beneath the water surface, providing a spawning substrate for many fish species. Adapts easily to different water values. Rarely cultivated in aquaria. Prop.: Self-branching.

D: 2, KH: 2-15, pH: 6.0-7.8, T: 15°-22°C, AH: 1-3

1.

Plants with Upright Stems

1.3.

Leaves in a Whorl

Hyadrilla verticillata var. crispa

CASPARY

Fam.: Hydrocharitaceae Hab.: Southeast Asia, Indonesia, Australia, Africa, Europe.

Main shoot is thin and slightly brittle with whorls of 3-9, sessile, slender lanceolate, acuminate, up to 2.5 cm long and 0.6 cm wide, coarsely dentate leaves. This variety has very arched blades with crisp (curled) edges. It has been described as an autonomous

species (Udora lithuanica). Short cuttings can be used in an open site in the foreground. Under bright illumination, the shoots grow horizontally, later developing into dense moderately high stands. Prop.: Cuttings, lateral shoots. D: 1, KH: 2-15, pH: 5.0-7.8, T: 15°-28°C, AH: 1-3 )

28

Plants

Najas_ flexilis

Hydrilla verticillata var. crispa

1.

Plants with Upright Stems

1.3.

Leaves in a Whorl

Limnophila heterophylla

©BENTHAM (1835)

Fam.: Scrophulariaceae Hab.: India, Pakistan, Sri Lanka, Indonesia, south China.

The main shoot bears whorls of 5-13 leaves that are pinnate and opposite with lower pinna pinnate and upper pinna forked. Tips are up to 0.2 cm wide, not broadened. The length of the last segment surpasses both tips below. Leaf segments are twisted, often resulting in the light underside of the leaf being partially turned up. Under insufficient illumination, this plant deteriorates into the nominate form, presented in Vol. 2, pp. 22 and 23. Excellent group plant for an open central section of the aquarium. The older stand is opportunely rejuvenated with cuttings of the new tips. Prop.: Cuttings from lateral shoots, runner-like lateral shoots.

D: 2, KH: 2-10, pH: 6.0-7.2, T: 22°-28°C, AH: 2-3

Limnophila indica

(LINNE) DRUCE (1923)

Indian Ambulia

Fam.: Scrophulariaceae Hab.: Tropical regions of Africa, Southeast Asia, Australia. Several forms of this widely distributed species have been described. The plant presented in Vol. 2, p. 23 is a delicate form of L. indica. The type species is pictured and briefly described here. Whorls are up to 5 cm wide and are composed of 6-12 leaves that are simple pinnate with forked proximal segments. These segments are about 2 mm wide, and the final segment surpasses both of those below by almost half their length. An-adaptive, decorative aquarium plant that makes an excellent point of contrast.

Prop.: Cuttings from lateral shoots. D: 2, KH: 2-12, pH: 6.0-7.5, T: 22°-28°C, AH: 3

Nitella flexilis

(LINNE) AGARDH

(1824)

Fam.: Characeae Hab.: Europe, Asia, America.

The slender, stalklike main axis has short shoots that in turn have whorls of 1-6 leaves. But these “leaves” are actually lateral shoots which are either bifurcate or trifurcate. The leaves are apiculate. An extremely easily cultivated aquatic plant that is even suitable for very hard water. Nitella is generally used in coldwater tanks, but-higher temperatures are also tolerated. However, when grown under the latter conditions, the shoots are very thin and weak. Planted shoots will take root, but their brittle nature makes them better kept natant. Lateral shoots help form dense drifting mats that serve as a spawning substrate and a subsequent shelter for young fishes. Supposedly they also condition the water. Prop.: Lateral shoots.

D: 1, KH: 2-15, pH: 5.5-7.5, T: 10°-22°C, AH: 1-3

30

Plants

Va

Limnophila_

Nitella_

flexilis

heterophylla

2

Plants with Leaves in a Rosette

2.1

Narrow-Leaved Rosettes

Acorus gramineus

SOLANDER (1789)

Japanese rush

Fam.: Araceae Hab.: East Asia. Rhizome is elongated and up to 1 cm thick. Leaves are basal, linear, 50 cm long, 1 cm wide, dark green, with a long, pointed tip, and arranged in a fanlike fashion. An upright 20 cm stem supports the 10 cm spadix and its pointed bract. Small, whitish perfect flowers densely cover the spadix. Use of this plant is limited, since it will not grow submersed. Therefore, to maintain this plant as a decorative aquarium addition, it must be regularly exchanged for fresh specimens that have been growing terrestrially. Rooted, potted plants are buried in the substrate, pot and all.

Prop.: Lateral shoots off the rhizome.

D: 4, KH: 2-15, pH: 5.5-8.5, T: 15°-20°C, AH: 1-3

Acorus gramineus

SOLANDER (1789)

Japanese rush

Type: Aureovariegatus

Fam.: Araceae Hab.: Cultivated plant.

Leaves are linear, 40 cm long, 1 cm wide with a long pointed tip and arranged in a fanlike fashion. The main characteristic is the golden to light yellow longitudinal striation along the blade. Like the nominate form, this type is only suitable as an exchange plant.

It is usually sold for coldwater aquaria, where it remains alive for extended time. A good winter hardy pond plant. Type argenteostriatus white stripes along the blade.

periods of

is similar but has silver-

Prop.: Lateral shoots on the rhizome.

D: 4, KH: 2-15, pH: 5.5-8.5, T: 15°-20°C, AH: 1-3

Blyxa octandra

(ROXBURGH) PLANCHES ex THWAITES (1902)

Fam.: Hydrocharitaceae Hab.: Sri Lanka, India, Burma, southeast Asia, northern Australia.

The basal rhizome produces a dense rosette. In its natural biotope, the grasslike leaves are up to 60 cm long and 1 cm wide. However, the leaves are considerably smaller on aquarium forms, reaching a mere 15 cm in length and 0.5 cm in width. Flowers are imperfect. Male blooms have 9 stamens. Seeds have 8 rows of tiny hook-shaped thorns. Very difficult to grow, usually only enduring a few months in the aquarium. Soft water and intense illumination of about 100 watts per 100 | of water are mandatory. Due to its extremely brittle leaves, handle with care and only associate with sedate fishes. Prop.: Lateral shoots off the rhizome. D: 4, KH: 1-3, pH: 5.5-6.5, T: 22°-26°C, AH: 1-2

32

lyxa octandra

~

2.

Plants with Leaves in a Rosette

21

Narrow-Leaved

Rosettes

Crinum sp. “Tortifolia” Fam.: Amaryllidaceae Hab.: Africa. The up to 5 cm thick tuber has a bulblike 20 cm long projection. Leaves are light green, thin, and up to 50 cm long and 2 cm wide. As the plant grows, the leaves begin to curl from the bottom. The first specimens were imported in 1974, but the species has not been identified. In nature, it is constantly supmersed. This notorious plant should be planted totally in the open and further accented with contrasting plants. Water depth should be at least 45 cm; otherwise, young leaves grow above the water surface and wither. Moderate requirements generally lead to uncomplicated care.

Prop.: Lateral tubers on the rhizome.

D: 2, KH: 2-15, pH: 6.0-7.5, T: 24°-28°C, AH: 3

Isoetes lacustris

LINNE (1753)

Fam.: lsoetaceae — Quillworts Hab.: Europe, northern Asia, North America.

Leaves are dark green, widely spread, 25 cm long and 0.3 cm wide, with a cylindrical cross-section. Tapered. The tip is slightly hooked, while the base is somewhat spoonshaped. This is a small plant for the foreground of shallow temperate aquaria. The very brittle leaves require cautious handling, so do not associate with robust fishes. Best kept in aquaria that house peaceful, cool water characins. Acid water is required for continued healthy growth. Prop.: Unknown for aquarium plants; otherwise through spores.

D: 4, KH: 2-5, pH: 5.0-6.0, T: 18°-22°C, AH: 1-2

Isoetes velata var. sicula

CESAT! et DE NOTARIS apud GENNARI (1861)

Fam.: lsoetaceae — Quillworts Hab.: Western Mediterranean region. The name has now been corrected (Kasselmann). Vol..2, pp. 58 and 59 lists the plant as being /soetes malinverniana, which is incorrect. That species is little suited for tropical aquaria. The medium green leaves usually grow to a length of 40 cm and a width of ca. 2 mm in the aquarium. Cross-section of the leaf is roundish to semicircular, not angular. Exterior leaves are laterally bent towards the bottom before they rise again in a slight spiral. Easiest quillwort to cultivate in an aquarium. Prop.: Spores; extremely difficult.

D: 2, KH: 2-10, pH: 5.5-7.0, T: 22°-28°C, AH: 3

34

Crinum

sp.

“Tortifolia”

lsoetes

velata

2.

Plants with Leaves in a Rosette

2.1

Narrow-Leaved Rosettes

Vallisneria americana var. biwaensis

M\ICHAUX (MIKI) LOWDEN

Type: Broad-twisted

(1982)

Syn.: Vallisneria asiatica

Fam.: Hydrocharitaceae

Hab.: Southeast Asia. Leaves are ribbonlike, twisted several an obtuse and rounded tip. Usually imported into Germany in 1975. This variant of V. asiatica. Adaptive group

times, 25-80 cm long and up to 2 cm wide, with only dentate along the edges near the tip. First species has not yet been identified. It could be a plants that can also be used in shallow aquaria. Growth tends to be compact when the plants are loosely planted and grown under moderate temperatures and intense illumination. When one or more of these criteria are not met, the plants grow taller and no longer have their characteristic twisted leaves. Numerous adventitious plants form intertwined dense groups that will need to be thinned occasionally. Insure proper iron levels and do not cultivate in extremely soft waters.

Prop.: Runners with numerous daughter plants. D: 1 KH: 5-12, pH: 6.0-7.5, T: 22°-25°C, AH: 2-3

Vallisneria spiralis var. spiralis Fam.: Hydrocharitaceae

LINNAEUS (1753) Syn.: Vallisneria aethiopica

Hab.: Africa (central and east Sudan)

Blades are linear, usually somewhat twisted distally, 5-12 cm long and up to 0.4 cm wide, with serrate, undulate edges, and an acute tip. This species was first imported into Germany in 1977, but identification has not been confirmed with flowering specimens. In nature it grows in shallow, cool waters. This Vallisnera enriches the assortment of available small plants for the foreground. Adapts to general aquarium conditions quite well, but demands bright light. When pa illuminated, growth is compact and the plants reproduce copiously. Seldom cultivated. Prop.: Daughter plants from species of the genus.

runners,

but less numerous

D: 2, KH: 5-12, pH: 6.0-7.5, T: 22°-28°C, AH: 1-2

36

than those of most

other

Plants

Vallisneria

americana

var. biwaensis

Vallisneria spiralis var. spiralis

~

2. 2.2

Plants with Leaves in a Rosette Broad-Leaved Rosettes

Anubias barteri var. glabra

N. E. BROWN

(1901)

Type: “Minimus”

Syn.: Anubias minima Fam.: Araceae Hab.: Tropical west Africa. The flat, creeping rhizome grows up to 5 mm in diameter. Blades are lanceolate, 5— 10 cm long and 2-5 cm wide, with a pointed tip, and a cuneate base. Short petioles. A. minima CHEVALIER, 1909 was previously considered an autonomous species. Crusio, who published a revision of the genus Anubias, did not recognize A. minima. Instead, he classified the plant as a type, not a variety, of A. barteri var. glabra. \ts height of 10-15 cm makes it suitable for small, shallow tanks. Well-rooted specimens grow well. Prop.: While its natural tendency is not to grow lateral shoots, cutting the rhizome induces the back part of the rhizome that remains in the substrate to generate a new shoot.

D: 2, KH: 2=12, pH: 6.0=7.5, 7: 22°-28°C, AH: 1-3

Anubias heterophylla ENGLER (1879) Syn.: Anubias congensis Fam.: Araceae Hab.: Tropical west Africa.

The blade is narrow to broadly lanceolate, up to 20 cm long, 10 cm wide (aerial leaves 30 x 15 cm), and tapered to slightly rounded towards the base, with a short pointed tip. Spathe up to 5 cm long and whitish on the inside. Spadix about equal in length to the spathe with the female

part slightly shorter than the male

segment.

When left undisturbed and provided with favorable living conditions, this plant will become quite large. In shallow aquaria, the leaves readily break the water surface. General adaptation is good. Appropriate illumination and a correct photoperiod should

be provided.

Prop.: Lateral shoots off the rhizome.

D: 2, KH: 2-15; pH: 6.0-7/5, I: 22°-26°C; AES

Nymphaea lotus x lotus Fam.: Nymphaeaceae Hab.: Southeast Asia (Thailand). Both the green and red tiger lotus (Nymphaea lotus) are common aquarium plants that can adapt to submersed growth. This plant, a cross between the green and red tiger lotus, is likewise adaptable to life in aquaria. Blade coloration is not always uniform. It tends to be a faded brown-red with dark spots. Hybrid flowers produce seeds that germinate and yield 25% green, 25% red, and 50% hybrids (a textbook example of Mendel’s hereditary laws). The solid color plants are homozygous and therefore generate solid-colored offspring. The hybrid plants again produce a variety of offspring when sexually reproduced.

D: 2, KH: 2-10, pH: 5.5-7.5, T: 22°-28°C, AH: 2-3

38

Anubias

Anubias

barteri var.

heterophylla

glabra,

“Minimus”

Nymphaea lotus x lotus

2.

Plants with Leaves in a Rosette

cat

Broad-Leaved Rosettes

Nymphoides cordata

(ELLIOT) FERNALD

Fam.: Menyanthaceae Hab.: Newfoundland to Florida. The cylindrical, banana-shaped dark green tubers at the base of the plant are much more slender and pointed than those of N. aquatica. Aquatic leaves are shiny green, occasionally with brownish speckles, up to 15 cm wide, roundish with a cordate base, and borne on short petioles. Floating leaves—similar to those of N. aquatica— are up to 20 cm wide and supported by long petioles. This species can exist very well in its aquatic form without immediately growing floating leaves, but the plant will need to be placed in a free area and left to produce its decorative aquatic leaves undisturbed. Soft water and intense illumination are additional conditions for submersed growth. Remove the floating leaves at the base as they form.

Prop.: Adventitious shoots off flowered petioles from the floating leaves.

D: 3, KH: 3-8, pH: 5.5-7.0, T: 20°-27°C, AH: 2-3

Spathiphyllum grandifolius Fam.: Araceae Hab.: South America.

Since Spathiphyllum are very difficult to identify, the systematics of this species are not definite. Petiolate leaves emerge off a stout rhizome. Blades are elongated to broadly-lanceolate, up to 40 cm long, 25 cm wide, with both ends pointed, and a slightly undulate edge. Petiole about 40 cm long. Spathe is white, 15 cm long, and wide open.

Terrestrial

specimens

are often unable to adapt to submersed

life, loosing their

leaves after just a few days. Young specimens rooted in a pot and maintained in sunlight for about 4 weeks in a plastic bag usually have less problems and, since they are capable of maintaining their leaves for a longer period underwater, it allows the plant more time to form new leaves.

D: 4, KH: 2-10, pH: 6.0-7.0, T: 20°-25°C, AH: 3

Spiranthes odorata

(NUTALL) LINDLEY (1840)

Fam.: Orchideaceae Hab.: Southern North America.

Syn.:Spiranthes cernua

Small rosette plant with blades that are lanceolate, medium green, 10-15 cm long and 1-2 cm wide, with a pointed tip, and a tapered stalklike base. Flowers are generally produced by terrestrial plants, but they have been known to form on submersed aquarium plants as well. The 40 cm peduncle pushes the bud above the water. The spiral, 10 cm spike bears numerous small white blooms (orchids). Afterwards the leaf rosette dies. New plants arise from the rhizome. An appropriate small plant for the foreground. Healthy growth requires medium-hard water, sufficient illumination, and a moderately coarse substrate. Prop.: Daughter plants on the rhizome after flowering and the root tips.

D: 2, KH: 2-12, pH: 6.0-7.0, T: 22°-26°C, AH: 1-3

40

Plants

Nymphoides

Spiranthes

odorata

~

2.

Plants with Leaves in a Rosette

2.3.

Amazon Sword Plants (Echinodorus)

Echinodorus tenellus

(MARTIUS) BUCHENAU

(1868)

Red tenellus

Fam.: Alismataceae Hab.: Central America, southern

Brazil.

The dwarf form of this plant (E. t. var. parvulus), which is the more difficult of the two to cultivate, was presented in Vol. 1, pp. 126 and 127. This aquarium plant was identified as variety tenellus in 1975 based on its flowers and seeds. Aquatic leaves are up to 12 cm long, 0.2 cm wide, and dark green, occasionally red when young (known as red tenellus to aquarists). The up to 5 cm long aerial leaves are about 0.5 cm wide and are clearly more slender at the tip than the base. Peduncle is usually 1.5 times as long as the blade, but equal or shorter than the blade in the dwarf form. Extremely adaptive aquarium plant which is becoming more common in the aquarium hobby. At a height of about 10 cm, this variant is appropriate for the foreground and to create large green areas. Adapts well to hard water, and its light requirement is normal.

Prop.: Runners with numerous daughter plants.

DeiKHY 22115, ps6. Sf

onze 2626

Echinodorus pellucidus

RATAd (1974)

FARIS

Fam.: Alismataceae Hab.: Paraguay, Argentina, southern

Brazil.

This rare, medium-sized bog plant does not always make a good aquarium plant. Only recommended for plant specialists. Aerial leaves are elliptical, up to 11 cm long and 5 cm wide, with a base that is occasionally cordate, and a long petiole. Inflorescence is erect, infrequently branched basally, up to 60 cm long with a row of 1.5 cm blooms that have 24-28 stamens. Aquatic leaves are elliptical, up to 12 cm long and 3 cm wide, with a pointed, rarely rounded, base, and a short, obtuse tip. Petioles are frequently significantly longer than the blades. Usually 3 very faint longitudinal veins emerge from the base. Young developing leaves have irregular brown spots, while older leaves are olive green to dark green. Some specimens will grow to be 385 cm tall. Large plants such as this must be placed in the open. If grown under crowded conditions, the blades grow above the water surface and are borne on overly long petioles. Cut these stems, but do not transplant at the same time.

Prop.: Separate lateral shoots from the rhizome and plant singly. Such juveniles usually grow short-stalked leaves for an extended period of time. D: 3, KH: 5-12, pH: 6.5-7.2, T: 22°-28°C, AH: 3

42

Echinodorus

pellucidus

~

2.

Plants with Leaves in a Rosette

2.4

Cryptocorynes

Cryptocoryne aponogetifolia

MERRIL (1919)

Fam.: Araceae Hab.: Philippines. This species was incorrectly identified as Cryptocoryne usteriana and introduced as such in Vol. 1, pp. 1386 and 137. Research done by J. Bogner (Munich) proved the autonomy of the species. The linear leaves of C. aponogetifolia grow 100 cm long and 5 cm wide and are pilose over their entire length. Even aquarium specimens may flower. The spathe, depending on the water level, reaches a height of 30-50 cm and sits on a 20 cm peduncle. Flag is about 8 cm long, purple-red, wrinkled, lighter through the throat region, and lacks a collar. Robust plants that adapt well to captivity. This plant, which becomes quite volumihous, requires a roomy tank with at least 60 cm of water. Best placed on the side or in the back section of the tank. Generally the long leaves drift along the water surface. Prop.: Daughter plants from runners are numerous

and fast growing.

D: 2, KH: 2-15, pH: 6.0—7.8, T: 20°-30°C, AH: 3

Cryptocoryne auriculata

ENGLER (1897)

Fam.: Araceae Hab.: Northeast Borneo, southwest Philippines. Small bog plant with elongated oval or small ovate leaves that are up to 9 cm long and 3 cm wide with a round to cordate base and a long, tapered acute tip. Superior side of the leaf is light green with dark crossbands. Spathe is 3 cm long, flag 2 cm, wide open, somewhat twisted, white, throat equally colored, without collar. Aquatic leaves are elongated, ovate, somewhat bullate, up to 5 cm long, 3 cm wide, and slightly cordate at the base, with an obtuse, pointed tip. These dark green leaves have an even darker green design when placed under strong illumination from above. Aquarium plants are only a few centimeters tall; the leaves frequently lie almost

prostrate. Due to its reduced ability to adapt, it is quite difficult to cultivate, especially under weak illumination. Little growth will occur under these conditions. Sensitive to suboptimal water values. Rarely imported. In its native waters, it grows in the cracks of rock terraces in river beds and in humid shady clefts on sites that are periodically

inundated. Prop.: Daughter plant production is very moderate. Growth is slow.

D: 4, KH: 2-8, pH: 5.5-6.8, T: 25°-28°C, AH: 1-2

44

Cryptocoryne

aponogetifolia iY

Cryptocoryne

auriculata

~

2.

Plants with Leaves in a Rosette

2.4

Cryptocorynes

Cryptocoryne ciliata var. latifolia

RATAJ (1975)

Fam.: Araceae Hab.: Southeast

Asia (Celebes).

Blade is broadly lanceolate, short-stalked, solid green, up to 15 cm long and 8 cm wide, with a cordate base, and a short, pointed tip. The petiole, as a rule, is equal in

length to the blade. Spathe is similar to that of C. ciliata var. ciliata, but the cilia along the edge of the blade are simple, according to Rataj. In comparison to the taller nominate form (see Vol. 1, pp. 132 and 133), this broad-leaved variant remains more compact. Acclimating the land form to an aquatic environment is somewhat time consuming, largely due to its high light requirement. Prop.: Daughter plants are rare, and runners are not produced. In the axils of older leaves, short lateral shoots grow, which can be removed and planted; however, they are very slow growing.

D: 2, KH: 2-12, pH: 6.0-7.0, T: 22°-26°C, AH: 2-3

Cryptocoryne crispatula

ENGLER (1920)

Fam.: Araceae Hab.: Northeast India, Thailand. Erroneously identified as C. retrospiralis, a name it has become known by in aquarium literature. However, that species is an entirely different plant with extremely slender leaves (8 mm) and is totally unsuitable for aquaria. C. crispatula's linear leaves are 60 cm long and 1.5 cm wide with a relatively broad central vein. Suomersed plants occur in deep, fast-flowing waters. Well suited for the background of tall aquaria. Adapts to general conditions well, and cultivation has proven to be unproblematic. Prop.: Daughter plants on runners are numerous and fast growing.

D: 1, KH: 2-15, pH: 6.0-7.5, T: 25°-28°C, AH: 3

Cryptocoryne x willisii

REITZ (1908)

Fam.: Araceae

Syn.: Cryptocoryne lucens

Hab.: Sri Lanka.

Theslanceolate leaves are solid green, up to 10 cm long, 0.6 cm wide, and uniformly tapered distally into a long tip. Spathe up to 7 cm long, flag up to 2 cm long, roundish, broad and obtuse, slightly twisted, warty, dark purple, throat darker, with a collar. This small species is used as a foreground

plant. Substrate

heating, fertiliza-

tion, and strong illumination greatly foster growth. Prop.: Moderate

formation

of daughter plants on runners

mother plants.

D: 2, KH: 2-10, pH: 6.0-7.2, T: 25°-28°C, AH: 1-2

46

and only off well-rooted



Cryptocoryne

Cryptocoryne

ciliata var.

crispatula

/atifolia

Cryptocoryne

x willisii

~

2.

Plants with Leaves in a Rosette

2.4

Cryptocorynes

Cryptocoryne minima

RIDLEY (1910)

Fam.: Araceae Hab.: Malay Peninsula. Aerial leaves are ovate to narrowly ovate, pointed, rounded at the base, up to 4 cm long, 2.5 cm wide, matte green, slightly bullate, and purple on the inferior side. Spathe remains very small, tube about 1 cm long, flag somewhat longer and matte

yellow with brown dots. Throat is darker, shiny, with a collar. Leaf shape in aquatic specimens and terrestrial plants is largely the same. However, aquatic blades are smooth and slightly olive green with a dark design. Decorative small plants for the foreground and very small aquaria. When compared to other species, its requirements are stringent and growth is slow. Prop.: Due to the moderate formation of daughter plants on runners, it is not easy to produce a large group. Therefore, it is recommendable to procure several specimens simultaneously to use in a group. Rarely cultivated.

D: 3, KH: 2-8, pH: 5.5-6.8, T: 25°-28°C, AH: 1-2

Cryptocoryne nurii Fam.: Araceae

FURTADO (1935)

Hab.: Malay Peninsula. Small amphibious bog plant with hard, somewhat thick, 18 cm long, 3 cm wide, redbrown aerial leaves. Spathe 10 cm long, flag about 5 cm, straight, roundish and brown with a 2 cm tip. Throat darker and lacks a collar. Aquatic leaves are narrowly lanceolate, up to 10 cm long and 2 cm wide, olive green bronze with dark red striations, and finely dentate edges. Extremely difficult to cultivate due to its limited adaptability. Very soft water with a low mineral content is needed. Light requirement is extremely high, and the substrate should contain quite a bit of clay. Imported specimens usually lose their leaves; rhizomes undergo moderate growth, and new blades initially remain quite small. Very rare and only suggested for experienced hobbyists whose aquaria have the

required

living conditions.

Prop.: Daughter plants on runners are rarely formed.

D: 4, KH: 1-3, pH: 5.5-6.5, T: 25°-28°C, AH: 1-2

48

Plants

Cryptocoryne

Cryptocoryne

minima

nuril

49

2.

Plants with Leaves in a Rosette

2.4

Cryptocorynes

Cryptocoryne wendtii

DE WIT (1958)

Type: Latifolius Fam.: Araceae

Hab.: Sri Lanka. Five different varieties of this extremely variable species were presented in Vols. 1 and 2. This form was described as a type and imported in 1978. It has not been scientifically described. There are probably more types and transitional forms. Latifolius refers to the fact that these plants have broader, shorter blades than the nominate form. Leaves are ovate, up to 5 cm long, 3.5 cm wide, short-stalked, with a cordate base, and slightly sinuate edges. Upper side of the leaf is olive green to reddish brown with a faint green angular design; underside is brown. This compact plant is suitable for the foreground. While not difficult to cultivate, it does demand a certain amount of light.

Prop.: Daughter plants on runners.

D: 2, KH: 2-12, pH: 6.0-7.2, T: 22°-28°C, AH: 1-3

Cryptocoryne

50

undulata,

see Vol. 2, page

124

Plants a

Cryptocoryne

wendtii,

latifolius

LH.

Cryptocoryne

x willisii, see page 46

3. Creeping-Shoot Plants Elatine macropoda

GUSSONE (1827)

Fam.: Elatinaceae Hab.: Mediterranean

region, east Africa.

Thin creeping shoot with roots that are about 4 cm long. Leaves are opposite, spadeshaped, up to 1.7 cm long, 0.3 cm wide, entire, with an elongated base, an obtuse tip, and a pronounced central vein. Very small, whitish green blooms with exposed sepals and petals are borne in the leaf axils. E. macropoda can only be distinguished from Glossostigma elatinoides by its flowers. Under favorable conditions, this species proves to be a good aquarium plant which, through branching of the creeping shoot, produces flat, dense growth suitable for the foreground. Plant the shoots shallowly and horizontally in a medium-grained substrate. Situate in an open site that receives direct light. High carbonate hardness usually results in poor growth, but this can be overcome with carbon dioxide fertilization. Certain medications against algae and fish diseases are not tolerated, and snails show a particular fondness for the tender leaves of this plant. Prop.: Removal of branches.

D: 3, KH: 2-10, pH: 6.0-7.0, T: 22°-26°C, AH: 1-2

Glossostigma diandra

KUNTZE (1891)

Fam.: Scrophulariaceae

Hab.: Australia. Thin creeping shoot with short roots. Leaves are opposite, paliform, entire, up to 0.8 cm long, 0.3 cm wide, with an obtuse rounded tip. The blade tapers into a petiole

of similar length. Single blooms on short peduncles sit in the axils of the aerial leaves. The crown is 0.3 cm in diameter and white with 5 petals and 2 stamens. The number

of stamens will differentiate this species from the very similar Glossostigma elatinoides. Shallowly introduce shoots in the upper layers of the sand substrate, planting them uniformly throughout the area where the stand is desired. Coarse-grained gravel should be avoided, and due to the high light requirement, floating plants should be absent. Usually the shoots tend to grow more or less upright. Do not look for a lawn of these plants to develop with their creeping shoots, as this type of growth demands intense light, making it a rare occurrence in aquaria. To keep the stand low, the shoots must be regularly pruned and replanted. In general, this species is not very adaptable to submersed life.

Prop.: Lateral shoots.

D:8, KH: 2512, pH: 6.0-7.0, T: 22°-25°C, AH: 1-2

52

Plants

Elatine macropoda 1Y

Glossostigma

diandra

3. Creeping-Shoot Plants Hydrocotyle vulgaris

LINNE (1753)

Pennywort, umbrella plant

Fam.: Hydrocotylaceae Hab.: Europe, around the Mediterranean.

Thin creeping main shoot grows along the substrate. Peltate, almost round, petiolate leaves are 1-4 cm in diameter. Veins radiate like the spokes of a wheel from the cupshaped center towards the indented edge. Each small, capitate inflorescence produces an umbel with 3-5 flowers; though rare, occasionally 2 flower whorls will be found, one superior to the other. Though decorative, its limited ability to adapt to submersed life restricts its use. Constant elevated temperatures found in tropical aquaria are hardly suitable for this species. Maintaining short petioles is virtually impossible. Generally the petioles elongate, while the blades become smaller, totally degenerating after a while. Small, unheated aquaria that are illuminated with naturai sunlight are moderately appropriate. An attractive perennial bog plant for the garden pond. Prop.: Lateral shoots.

D: 4, KH: 2-10, pH: 6.0-7.0, T: 15°-20°C, AH: 1-2

Lilaeopsis brasiliensis

(GLAZIOU) AFFOLTER (1985)

Fam.: Apiaceae Hab.: Brazil. The thin creeping shoot bears petiolate leaves. Blades are lanceolate, 5-12 cm long, 0.5 cm wide, and have an obtuse tip. Several very fine veins run along the midrib; a few crossveins extend to the faintly incised edge. Aquatic leaves are more slender, up to 0.3 cm wide, with an acute tip. Only the midrib is pronounced. It seems that both L. polyantha and L. novae-zelandiae are synonyms of L. brasiliensis. A decorative, low-growing foreground plant that can green large surfaces. Adapts well to submersed life. Bunches planted in the upper layers of the substrate produce numerous elongated lateral shoots, creating an extensive stand which looks like a small lawn.

Prop.: Branchings off shoots; removal of lateral shoots.

D: 2, KH: 2-15, pH: 6.0-7.5, T: 20°-28°C, AH: 1-3

54

SS a SS

Lilaeopsis

brasiliensis

Plants

ee

3. Creeping-Shoot Plants Marsilea crenata

K. B. PRESL (1830)

Dwarf four-leaf clover

Fam.: Marsileaceae Hab.: Australia. For a long time, this species was confused with M. drummondii

in aquarium literature. The two can only be positively identified by their infrequently formed sporocarp, which is ribbed in M. crenata, but smooth in M. drummondii. The four-lobed aerial leaves grow up to 2 cm in diameter on a thin, creeping shoot. Aquatic leaves are predominately unilobed, usually roundish-ovate, and up to 0.6 cm wide. Only when aerial shoots are planted under water are the more or less divided aquatic leaves generated. Cultivating this plant as an aquarium plant has proven .somewhat tricky, since its general adaptation to submersed life is poor. Soft water, strong light, and the addition of carbon dioxide favor submersed growth. Nevertheless, M. crenata cannot be constantly maintained as a submersed plant, but for a

limited time, a beautiful low lawn results which can be placed in the open foreground. D: 3, KH: 2-8, pH: 6.0-7.0, 7; 22°-25°C, AH: 1-2

Pilularia globulifera

LINNE (1753)

Fam.: Marsileaceae Hab.: Europe. The creeping shoot supports upright leaves that are soft, grass green, awl-shaped, about 1 mm thick, up to 10 cm long, with a pointed tip, and a roundish cross-section. Pea-sized short peduncled brown sporocarps are borne in the axils on bog plants.

Occasionally found in deeper waters of its natural habitat. There its leaves may reach lengths of 100 cm. A lawnlike plant for the foreground of shallow aquaria, Culture in sand substrates at low temperatures. Higher temperatures of up to ca. 25°C are tolerated for short periods of time, but a corresponding increase in illumination will be required. An extremely rare aquarium plant. Generally used along marshy pond shores. Prop.: Lateral shoots.

D: 4, KH: 2-5, pH: 6.0-7.0, T: 15°-20°C, AH: 1-2

56

Plants

Marsilea

crenata

Pilularia globulifera

3. Creeping-Shoot Plants Selliera radicans CANAVILLES (1799) Fam.: Goodeniaceae Hab.: East Australia, Tasmania,

New Zealand, Chile.

The thin shoot has roots at the nodes and grows simple petiolate leaves. Blade is slightly succulent, lanceolate, up to 6 cm long, 1.5 cm wide, with an elongated base, and an obtuse rounded tip. In the axils of aerial leaves are single blooms that are 0.7 cm in diameter with 5 petals on a white crown. Rarely kept in aquaria today. To separate the genus from the nonflowering state of Lilaeopsis, note Selliera's leaf morphology, which is broader and more bladelike. Suitable for the foreground of shallow, long, roomy aquaria. Only recommended for cooler temperatures; higher temperatures tend to cause the internodes to elongate and the leaves to become thin and degenerate. Strong illumination and an open area are demanded. The terrestrial form is easily grown around the garden pond during the summer months.

Prop.: Removal _of lateral shoots.

D: 3, KH: 2-10, pH: 6.0-7.0, T: 18°-22°C, AH: 1-2

4. Floating Plants Aponogeton distachyos

LINNE filius (1781)

Fam.: Aponogetonaceae Hab.: South Africa. The tuber grows up to 3 cm thick. The blade is elliptic, leathery, up to 25 cm long, 37 cm wide, and floats on the water surface. It is attached to the tuber by a long petiole. The superior side of the blade is light green with occasional dark spots. Inflorescence has 2 spikes that are about 6 cm long with 5-10 flowers on each. Each flower has 25 stamens, 6 carpels, and one white petal that is 10 x 5 cm.

This aponogeton can be kept in intensely illuminated aquaria as long they are not too tall. Temperatures should be moderate. Not a perennial plant. After a period of speedy growth, its growth slows and the plant becomes dormant. At that time the tuber should be removed and stored in a cool, moist place for about 2 months. Not a suggested aquarium plant, but on the other hand, it does well along shallow pond edges during the summer, even surviving mild winters in this setting.

Prop.: Seeds.

D: 3, KH: 2-8, pH: 6.0-7.5, T: 18°-23°C, AH: 1-3

58

:

Plants

Aponogeton

distachyos

4. Floating Plants Limnobium spongia

(BOSC) STEUDEL (1841)

Fam.: Hydrocharitaceae Hab.: North America. Free floating rosette plant that has 2-4 cm cordate to circular blades supported by 10 cm petioles. Upper side of the leaf is slightly arcuate to flat, light green, and occasionally has red spots; the lower side is spongy, lighter green, and slightly violet or spotted. Roots that hang into the water are long, pilose, and whitish or violet. Male blossoms are arranged in groups and have a singly bract, 3 sepals, 3 green-white petals, and 9-12 stamens. stigmas.

Female blossoms

An excellent floating plant for either slightly to various water values; however, it has plant for bog aquaria. During the summer, either floating or rooted in a bog. Requires

have 6 styles with bicleft, wide, awllike

heated or unheated aquaria. Adapts well a high light requirement. An appropriate these plants can be grown in the open, full sunlight to flower.

Prop.: Through prolific production of daughter plants on runners, quickly formed; thin the stand regularly.

a dense stand is

D: 2, KH: 2-15, pH: 6.0-7.5, T: 15°=20°C, AH: 1-3

Riccia rhenana

LORBEER ex. K. MULLER (1941)

Sinking riccia

Fam.: Ricciaceae Hab.: Cosmopolitan. This plant looks like Riccia fluitans, though the tips of the thallus are shorter and slightly finer. Shoots frequently sink to the substrate in aquaria and anchor themselves with their rhizoids to rocks or grains of sand. This species is occasionally found with Riccia fluitans. lf such a cluster, having been exposed to intense illumination, is separated, R. rhenana sinks to the bottom. With dim lighting, R. rhenana drifts

just beneath the water surface. With continuous dichotomous splitting, the single, benthic plant segments grow into dense spherical mats. An interesting foreground decoration is created near the bottom.

Prop.: Dividing the group.

D:-1, KH: 5-15, pH: 6.0-8.0, T: 15°-30°C, AH: 1-2

60

Limnobium

spongia Y

Riccia

rhenana

4. Floating Plants Salvinia natans

LINNE (1753)

Fam.: Salviniaceae Hab.: North Africa, temperate Asia, Europe. This plant has a horizontal main shoot and floating leaves borne on short stalks. The blade is oval, up to 2 cm long, 1 cm wide, usually twice as long as wide, with a cordate base, and an emarginate tip. Upper side is warty and loosely pilose with free, upright bristles in semi-regular rows. In nature, this is a protected species on the brink of extinction. Conditionally recommended for tropical aquaria because the high humidity under the cover of the tank rots the plants. Appropriate for brightly illuminated, unheated tanks. Growing S. natans in the open is undoubtedly optimal. During the winter, this annual floating fern dies. Sporocarps are formed which sink to

the bottom when the plants disintegrate in the winter.

In the following spring, the

spores germinate, float to the water surface, and develop into new individuals. Prop.: Separation of lateral shoots and sowing the rare sporocarps.

D: 4, KH: 2-8, pH: 6.0-7.5, T: 15°-20°C, AH: 1-3

Salvinia oblongifolia

VON MARTIUS (1834)

Fam.: Salviniaceae Hab.: Brazil, Amazon

Basin.

Horizontal main shoot with floating leaves that are elongate-ovate, up to 3 cm long, 1 cm wide, frequently smaller, but usually 3 times as long as they are wide, with a cordate base, and a faintly indented tip. Upper side is warty and very densely and finely pilose; the free standing bristle clusters are pointed forward. There is a degenerate form that appears in aquaria which is easily confused with S. auriculata. Note the narrower leaves whose clustered bristles do not converge in an arch. Extremely rarely cultivated and therefore unfamiliar to aquarists. This photophilous floating fern should, if possible, be kept in loose formations; this means that they must be occasionally thinned. The finely divided aquatic leaves that hang down from the clusters are up to 10 cm long and provide a good spawning substrate for some

fish species and shelter for fry. Excessive current at the water surface is not tolerated. Prop.: Separation of lateral shoots which develop in great numbers.

D: 3, KH: 2-12, pH: 6.0-7.5, T: 18°-25°C, AH: 1-3 \

62

Salvinia

i

Salvinia

natans

$A :

oblongifolia

4. Floating Plants Salvinia rotundifolia

W\ILLDENOW (1810)

Fam.: Salviniaceae Hab.: Tropical America. Horizontal main axis with floating leaves that are roundish-ovate, up to 0.7 cm long and 0.6 cm wide, usually almost as long as wide, with a rounded, weakly concave tip. The upper side of the leaf is warty, whereby each papillose projection has 1-2, upright, short, light setae. Under bright light, the leaves are tomentose; however, artificial lighting generally results in less pilose specimens. Sometimes similar to a degenerate form of S. auriculata, so note the number of setae on the warts. S. auriculata has 4 setae per wart. Free floating plant for aquaria that meet its requirements. It seems that hard water and dripping condensation is tolerated better by this species than by many other floating ferns. Prop.: The numerous lateral shoots soon form new plants, producing a dense mat. Ensure that rooted plants receive sufficient illumination by occasionally thinning the stand.

D: 2, KH: 2-15, pH: 6.0-7.5, T: 18°=25°C, AH: 1-3

Utricularia aurea

LOUREIRO (1790)

Fam.: Utriculariaceae Hab.: Tropical southeast Asia.

The elongated main shoot grows to a length of 100 cm and is about 0.3 cm thick. The four-part leaf grows up to 8 cm in size and has 24 pinna. These divide further into as many as 12 filiform tips until there are up to 700 threadlike tips. Leaves have small capture bladders (utricles), which the plant uses to catch and digest aquatic insects. What determines the presence or absence of these utricles is unknown. Newly imported shoots might not have utricles, but develop them in an aquarium. But wild specimens that have utricles may spontaneously cease to grow them in an aquarium. Besides adaptive characteristics influenced by environment, species-specific factors must also play a role. This delicate surface plant adapts well and forms extensive mats with its numerous lateral shoots and rapid growth. Its uncommonly rapid initial growth, however, diminishes over time, and older aquarium specimens grow slower and become weaker.

Prop.: Lateral shoots, dividing of shoots, leaf cuttings.

D: 1, KH: 2-15, pH: 5.5-7.5, T: 22°-80°C, AH: 1-3 5

64

[3

Salvinia

Utricularia

rotundifolia

aurea

Utricularia

aurea

(flowers)

5. Unsuitable “Aquarium Plants” Unsuitable “Aquarium Plants” In the following chapter, a number of plant species are introduced which have appeared in aquarium stores more frequently of late. Some of these so-called “aquarium plants” are regularly offered, and the selection of this type of plant is constantly increasing. The first question to ask is whether or not these plants are aquatic plants in their natural habitat. A few are found in moist locals, but they are not aquarium plants in the traditional sense of the word. In other words, they cannot grow submersed. Vendors rarely feel guilty, because clients are usually informed of the limited suitability of these plants. On the positive side, some of these plants are attractive and very different from common aquatic plants that are offered, providing a special accent without having to resort to plastic plants. Another point in their favor is that—terrestrial or not—they often have a longer life span in the aquarium than even true aquatic plants, since many aquatic plants quickly decompose under suboptimal water conditions. Each aquarist must decide how to weigh these aspects and decide whether to place the following plants in the aquarium or on the window sill—or refrain from buying them altogether. Since these plants are found in retail stores and find appropriate use in bog, amphibious, and other specialty aquaria, we deemed it apropos to include a brief introduction here.

66

Plants

Iresine

lresine lindenii

lindenii

VAN HOUTTE

Hab.: Ecuador. A foxtail from the family Amaranthaceae.

Stalked plants with opposite leaves.

Blades

are about 8 cm long, 3 cm wide, brown-red, with dark red veins. These soft plants live a short time underwater. Better suited for flower pots, balconies, or gardens during the summer.

67

5. Unsuitable “Aquarium Plants” Alternanthera ficoides

(LINNE) BRAUN ex ROEMER

et Schultes

Type: “Bettzickiana” Hab.: South America. This compact, stalked plant reaches a height of 10-15 cm. Blades are slender and normally rolled upwards along the sides. Depending on the type, blades are redgreen or yellow-green. In the aquarium, the plant remains green before decomposing. Grows well in the yard during the summer.

Chamaedorea elegans

for a few weeks

MARTIUS

Hab.: Mexico, Guatemala.

Usually 20-30 cm tall seedlings are sold. These have about 6 leaves that are simple pinnate. This palm is very resistant and can live for long periods of time submersed. To keep alive, regularly fortify the plant by removing it from the water.

Cryptanthus bivittatus

(HOOKER) REGEL

Hab.: Brazil. Small leaf rosettes are grown on short shoots. Blades are green, about 5 x 1 cm, and have two light green striations. Its hard leaves make it resistant to submersed conditions. Very appropriate in bog aquaria as an epiphyte fastened to wood.

Chlorophytum comosum

(THUNBERG) JAQUES

Spider plant, airplane plant

Hab.: South Africa. A common indoor plant which is almost indestructible. Leaves of the rosette are slender with green striations along the outer edge and white stripes along the midrib. Long peduncles later develop adventitious plants. As robust as this plant is in its terrestrial environment, it is totally inappropriate for submersed life.

Chlorophytum bichetii

(KARRER)

BAKER

Hab.: Gabon

This 15 cm edges and underwater aquarium.

plant has a rosette of lanceolate leaves. Blades have white to yellowish occasionally have thin light stripes through the middle. Its maintenance is extremely precarious. Appropriate as an indoor plant or for the bog Propagated through adventitious plants.

Dracaena sanderiana

SANDER ex MAST

Hab.: Cameroon. An attractive representative of the agave plants. The upright, almost 1 cm thick stem supports leaves that are white and green striped along the edges, up to 15 cm long, and quite hard. Young, 30 cm shoots live about 8 weeks underwater before they begin to decompose. Grows well in brightly lit windows.

68

Cryptanthus

Dracaena

bivittatus

sanderiana

Chamaedorea

Chlorophytum

elegans

bichetii

5. Unsuitable “Aquarium Plants” Dracaena marginata

LAMARCK

Hab.: Madagascar. Upright stem has leaves from top to bottom. Broad, lanceolate blades around the terminal tip are dark red with a green center. Older leaves keep the red margins. The plant lives for about 2 months submersed. Decorative plant when grown on the window sill: it tolerates wet roots In the bog aquarium.

Fittonia verschaffeltii

(LEMAIRE) VAN HOUTTE

Hab.: Columbia, Bolivia. The prostrate shoot has opposite,

ovate

leaves that are up to 15 cm

long, 10 cm

wide, and brownish with red veins. Offered for the aquarium, but they cannot live for any length of time underwater. Beautiful low-growing contrast plant. Good ground cover in the bog aquarium.

Fittonia verschaffeltii

(LEMAIRE) VAN HOUTTE

Type: “Argyroneura” Hab.: Colombia, Bolivia. Main shoot grows prostrate. Leaves are opposite, up to 10 cm long, and 5 cm wide. Blade is light green with a dense net of silver white veins. Its beautiful leaf design is a temptation to anyone looking for plants, but it lives only a few weeks underwater.

Maranta leuconeura

MORREN

Type: “Kerchoviana” Hab.: Brazil.

Attractive plant with oval leaves on a short prostrate shoot. Blade is 15 x 8 cm, dark green, velvety, with red veins, and light spots along the midrib. Not suitable for aquaria, but potted specimens can be propagated in hot, humid bog aquaria or window sills.

Selaginella martensii

SPRINGER

Hab.: Mexico. Small (15 cm) rosette plant with short-stalked leaves. Very small pinna sit in dense rows next to each other. Life underwater is limited to about 2 weeks. Afterwards, the plant begins to disintegrate. Maintain in humid, warm bog aquaria and mist with rain water.

Selaginella willdenowii

BAKER

Hab.: Tropical Asia. Sold as an aquatic fir, but it is not at all aquatic. As a rule, they have single leaves which are about 30 cm in size and borne on equally long petioles. The trilobed blade is dark green and rigidly structured. Remains attractive for about 6 weeks submersed. * Yi

Syngonium auritum

(LINNE) SCHOTT

Hab.: Jamaica, Honduras. The climbing shoot has dark green leaves which are hastate (spearlike) in their juvenile form. Venation is lighter green. Totally worthless for the aquarium, since the plant decomposes rapidly in water. Use it as a climbing plant in large bog aquaria or support it with a small trellis in the window sill.

70

Sel

Fittonia

Fittonia

verschaffeltii

verschaffeltii

Syngonium

auritum

River in Borneo

ie

Explanation of the Symbols*

Fishes

Symbols Used in the Illustrated Fish Section: Family.

Fam.: Subfam.:

= =

Syn.:

= Synonym = additional names for the same species. In the systematics of faunal nomenclature, only the name given by the original describer is valid. Subsequent de-

Beh

Set

WC

Subfamily.

scriptions of the same species using another name create so-called synonyms. Habitat; the natural region of origin. First import. It is often interesting to know how long a particular species has been known in the hobby. Differences between the sexes. Social behavior. Conditions recommended for maintenance. A specific value placed in parentheses following a range for pH, degrees German total hardness (° dGH), and degrees German carbonate hardness (° dKH) indicates the optimal value within the range for the species. Breeding. Recommendations under this heading are merely meant to be used as a guideline. Complete breeding accounts should be obtained from fish journals or relevant specialized books. Feeding. Under this heading you will see the abbreviations C, H,L, O. These stand for: C = Carnivore = meat/fish eater H = Herbivore = plant/vegetable eater L = Limnovore = aufwuchs/detritus eater O = Omnivore = eats foods from all above categories Special observations. Temperature. ow Maximal length of the adult fish. A value in parenthesis refers to maximal length achieved in aquaria. Recommended aquarium length. iil Water region preferred by the fish in an aquarium: t = top, m = middle, b = bottom. Degree of difficulty. For explanations refer Vol. 1, p. 203. D: 1 = species for the beginning hobbyist. D: 2 = species for novices with some basic knowledge. D: 3 = species for advanced hobbyists. D: 4 = species for experts and specialists.

-H = Herbivore; Ch = Water chemistry; C = Carnivore; S = Size = Wild caught specimen.

* Detailed explanations can be found in Aquarium Atlas, Vol. 1, p. 200.

73

Group 1 Sturgeons

Fam.: Acipenseridae

BRANDT,

Acipenser baeri Siberian sturgeon

1869

A. ste-

added to its water beneficial. Best kept in a species aquarium.

Hab.: Asia: former Soviet Union, in the rivers of Siberia from the Ob River to the

B: Its mature size and the limited space of an aquarium make it impossible to bred these animals in captivity. A. baeri requires many years to attain sexual maturity: dod need at least 11 years, whereas 22 require 17 years! The animals are anadromous, spending most of their lives at sea, but entering rivers to spawn. The spawning season extends from June to July. Up to 420,000 eggs are laid. The 2 only spawns once over the course of several years.

Syn.: Acipenser stenorhynchus, norhynchus var. baicalensis.

Kolyma River, including their mouths. F.l.: Has not been imported.

Sex.: None known. Soc. B.: Despite its size, this is a peaceful species. A. baer’ digs as it searches for food. M: Only juveniles are suitable for home aquaria. The aquarium should be as roomy as possible with a large surface area. Provide open swimming areas and a sand or fine-grained gravel substrate; sharp stones should be avoided so that the fish do not injure their mouth while digging. The water should be clear, clean, and oxygen-rich with a pH of 7.0— 7.5 and a hardness up to 20° dGH. A. baeri finds water movement and sea salt

F: C; live foods, benthic invertebrates (insect larvae, crustacea, molluscs, worms), and sometimes small fishes.

S: A. baeri has two geographic races, one eastern and one western. While this is considered a migratory species, some large Siberian lakes (e.g., Lake Baikal) contain nonmigrating strains.

T: 10°-20°C (coldwater fish), L: 200 cm, A: 80 cm, R: b, D: 3-4

BRANDT,

Acipenser gueldenstaedti Syn.: None. Hab.: Europe and western Asia: the Black, Azov, and Caspian Seas. The species enters the mouths of rivers to spawn. Known to migrate up to Pressburg (Bratislava) in the Danube. F.1.: Unknown.

Sex.: No definite external differentiating characteristics are known. Soc. B.: Despite its size, quite peaceful. It digs as it searches for food. They live in localized schools in their natural habitat.

M: As for Acipenser sturio (p. 81). Only juveniles are suitable for home aquaria; only public aquaria can meet the spatial requirements of adults.

is, it enters freshwater to spawn. At least eight years are needed to reach sexual maturity. More than 800,000 eggs can be laid over rubble substrates. The eggs develop in about 90 hr. F: C; live foods such as fishes (gobies, etc.) and all kinds of invertebrates, e.g., chironomid

larvae, molluscs, and Daph-

nia. S: Because it is an important source of caviar, A. gueldenstaedti is of great economic consequence. The meat is also tasty and valuable. Beside the nominate form, there are two additional subspecies: A. g. persicus BORODIN, 1897 and A. g. colchius MARTI, 1940.

B: Probably impossible in aquaria because of its size. In nature they spawn in June. The species is anadromous; that T: 10°-20°C, L: to 400 cm, A: over 200 cm, R: b, D: 3-4 (C)

74

1833

Pseudo-Bony and Cartilaginous Fishes

Acipenser

baeri

Fam.: Acipenseridae

Sturgeons

Acipenser medirostris

AYRES,

1854

Green sturgeon Syn.: Acipenser micadoi, A. acutirostris. Hab.: America and Asia: along the east and west coasts of the northern Pacific Ocean. Also enters mouths of rivers.

F.I.: Has not been

imported

into Ger-

F: C: live foods, invertebrates.

but primarily benthic

S: This rare species can easily be distinguished from other sturgeons by its olive green coloration.

many. Sex.: None known. Soc. B.: Anadromous. M: There is no information available concerning caring for this sturgeon in captivity.

B: Little is known about A. medirostris’ reproductive behavior in its natural habitat. This anadromous fish leaves the sea and moves up rivers to spawn. In the Datta River (former Soviet Union) it spawns from mid-June to mid-July. All other information about this species is based on suppositions. T: 10°-20°C (coldwater fish), L: to 210 cm, A: from 200 cm, R: b, D: 3-4

LOVETZKY,

Acipenser nudiventris Syn.: Acipenser schypa.

glaber,

A. schipa,

1828

A.

1.5 and 3 mm. At temperatures of about 20°C, the eggs take 5 days to develop.

Hab.: Asia and Europe: Caspian, Aral, and Black Seas. From there it also en-

F: C; live foods such as benthic invertebrates (e.g., crustacea, mussels, worms, and insect larvae).

ters rivers such as the Danube.

F.I.: Has probably into Germany.

not been

imported

Sex.: None known.

S: Unlike other sturgeons, A. nudiventris has a solid lower lip. A. nudiventris and A. stellatus will hybridize.

Soc. B.: Despite its size, this is a peaceful fish. It digs as it searches for food. M: Only juveniles are suitable for aquaria. Furnish the aquarium as you would for Acipenser sturio (p. 81). B: Not possible in aquaria due to its size. In nature A. nudiventris is anadromous, entering rivers from the sea to spawn. Spawning season extends from March to May. Water temperature at that time is between 10°-15°C. The 200,000 to 1.3 million eggs are laid on rubble substrates. Egg diameter varies between T: 10°-20°C (coldwater fish), L: 200 cm, A: from 200 cm, R: b, D: 3-4

76

Pseudo-Bony and Cartilaginous Fishes

Me L Te wl

Acipenser

nudiventris

Sturgeons

Fam.: Acipenseridae

BRANDT,

Acipenser schrencki Amur sturgeon Syn.: None. Hab.: Asia: China and former Soviet Union, in the Amur system from its estuary to the headwaters of the Argun and Schilka Rivers. F.l.: Has many.

not been

imported

into Ger-

Sex.: None known.

1869

and 435,000 eggs are laid over rubble or sand substrates. 92 do not spawn every year. F: C; all kinds of invertebrates e.g., crustacea, worms, insect larvae, and. molluscs. Large specimens also eat fishes.

S: Morphologically, A. schrencki is very similar to Acipenser baer.

Soc. B.: In nature, A. schrencki form localized schools which remain in certain regions. Despite its size, this is a peaceful fish.

M: As suggested for Acipenser sturio. B: Its respectable mature size makes reproduction in an aquarium impossible. In nature, the spawning season extends from the end of May to the end of June, sometimes to mid-July. Between 29,000

T: 10°-20°C (coldwater fish), L: to 290 cm, A: from 200 cm, R: b, D: 3-4

Acipenser stellatus Star sterlet Syn.: Acipenser hellops.

Hab.: Azov, tered found

Europe and western Asia: Black, and Caspian Seas. Rarely encounin the Adriatic Sea, but sometimes in the Aral Sea. Enters rivers.

F.I.: Could not be determined.

Sex.: No definite external differentiating characteristics are known. 2 2 are somewhat fuller during the spawning season. Soc. B.: See Acipenser sturio (p. 81).

PALLAS,

mediately or after a maximum of 3 months, follow the current into the sea.

F: C; live foods, particularly chironomid larvae and small crustacea. Small fishes are occasionally accepted. S: After migration, A. stellatus Classified into a winter and a form. The winter form enters spawn, while the summer form spawn at the river’s mouth.

M: Follow recommendations for A. sturio.

B: Has not been accomplished in an aquarium, largely because of its mature size. In nature, A. stellatus is anadromous, It spawns from June to September in the mouths of rivers or often on banks in the sea. The 20,000-350,000 eggs adhere to stones. Depending on temperature, the young hatch after 2-4

days, rise to the surface and, either im-

T: 10°-20°C (coldwater fish), L: to 190 cm, A: from 150 cm, R: b, D: 3

78

1771

can be summer rivers to tends to

Pseudo-Bony and Cartilaginous Fishes ee

Acipenser stellatus

Fam.: Acipenseridae

Sturgeons

_*

Lake Baikal, former Soviet Union

This lake in southern Russia, considered the deepest on earth (1,620 m), is situated

455 m above sea level. With its 31,500 km? of surface area, it is about 60 times larger than Lake Constance. Several species from this ancient lake, such as the oil fishes, have persevered in this environment since the Tertiary Period.

Qn

Pseudo-Bony and Cartilaginous Fishes Fam.: Acipenseridae

Acipenser sturio Sturgeon Syn.: None. Hab.: European coasts from North Cape to the Mediterranean and Black Seas, northern Atlantic, along both the European and American Coasts and the Baltic Sea and Lakes Onega and Ladoga. F.I.: Native to Europe. Sex.: None known.

Soc. B.: Peaceful despite its size. The animals dig as they search for food. Hardy when appropriately cared for. M: Only juveniles are suitable aquarium inhabitants. The tank should have a large surface area and a soft sand substrate. Do not use sharp gravel as substrate lest it proves injurious to the animals as they dig for food. Leave plenty of free swimming space. The water should be clear, cold, oxygen-rich, medium-hard to hard (10°-20° dGH), and slightly alkaline (pH about 7.5). Good filtration is required, and as a secondary consider-

Sturgeons

LINNAEUS,

1758

ation, the fish may find pump-generated current beneficial. Likewise, salt can be added to the water. Best kept in a species tank. B: The mature size of the animals circumvents successfully breeding A. sturio in an aquarium. Anadromous fish; that is, it leaves the sea and enters rivers to spawn. From June to July it spawns in deep channels in fast-flowing sections of the river proper. Between 400,000 and

2.5 million eggs are laid. The fry hatch in 3-5 days. There are conflicting reports on how long the juveniles remain in freshwater before migrating to the sea. F: C: live benthic invertebrates (crustacea, mussels, worms) and the occasional small fish.

S: A. sturio is an important source of caviar. Due to environmental degradation of rivers, the species is virtually extinct in Germany. Occasionally an individual specimen is caught.

T: 10°-18°C (coldwater fish), L: max. 6 m, A: from 200 cm, R: b, D: 4 (S)

81

Sturgeons

Fam.: Acipenseridae

(GEORGI, 1775)

Huso dauricus Syn.: Acipenser dauricus, A. orientalis. Hab.: Asia: former Soviet Union and China, in the Amur system from its estuaries to the head waters of the Schilka and Argun Rivers. F.l.: Has many.

not been

imported

into Ger-

Sex.: No definite external differentiating characteristics

are known.

Soc. B.: Localized schools are frequently found in the Amur. Peaceful as juveniles, turning predacious as they age. M: Only juveniles are suitable for aquaria. See Acipenser sturio. B: Impossible in aquaria due to its ma-

14°C. The 600,000 to 4.1 million eggs are laid over sand or rubble substrates at depths of 2-4 m. Eggs are slightly adhesive, 3.2-4.0 mm in diameter, and dark gray when mature. After the yolk sac is absorbed, the juveniles become benthic. F: C; juveniles consume all live foods, €.g., worms, mosquito larvae, mussels, and crustacea. Adults primarily feed on fishes. S: Unlike Huso huso, H. dauricus's first dorsal shield is larger than the rest, and the dorsal fin has less than 60 rays.

ture size. In its natural habitat, these sturgeons spawn for several days in May and June when temperatures are 12°

T: 10°-20°C (coldwater fish), L: to 5.6 m,

(LINNAEUS, 1758)

Huso huso

Syn.: Acipenser huso,

Hab.: Asia and Europe: Caspian, Black, Azov, and Adriatic Seas as well as their tributaries (Po River). F.l.: Could

: from 200 cm, R: b, D: 4

not be determined;

some-

times kept in show aquaria. Sex.: According to BERG there is slight sexual dimorphism, but how it is manifest is not given.

Soc. B.: Anadromous fish which may be found in upper river courses. Adults are predators.

ber of eggs laid correlates to the size of the fish, fluctuating between 360,000 and 7.7 million. At temperatures of about 13°C, egg development takes about 8 days. After hatching, the young soon proceed to the sea. F: C; all kinds of live invertebrates; larger animals predominately feed on fishes. S: At a length of 9 m and a weight of up to 1.5 tons, this is one of the largest fishes. H. huso produces the world famous Beluga caviar.

M: See Acipenser sturio. Only juveniles are suitable for home aquaria. B: Impossible in aquaria. In nature, there are several races, each of which under-

goes spawning migrations at different times of the year (fall and spring). Usually the spawning sites are in the lower to central courses of the rivers. Soawning occurs along the river bed. The numT: 10°-20°C (coldwater fish), L: to 9 m, A: from 200 cm, R: b, D: 4

82

Pseudo-Bony and Cartilaginous Fishes

Pg

Huso

l ag

dauricus

Huso huso, adult

83

Sturgeons

Fam.: Acipenseridae

(BOGDANOW, 1874)

Pseudoscaphirhynchus kaufmanni Syn.: Scaphirhynchus

kaufmanni.

Hab.: Former Soviet Union: from the lower course of the Amu Darya River to Pjandsha.

F.l.: Has probably into Germany.

not been

imported

S: In contrast to the American shovel sturgeons of the genus Scaphirhynchus, Pseudoscaphirhynchus has a shorter caudal peduncle which is not completely covered with plates.

Sex.: dd have a pointed mouth and a much more elongated tail fin; 22 have rounded mouths. Soc. B.: Unknown. M: As for Acipenser sturio (p. 81).

B: Has not been successfully accomplished in aquaria. In nature, the animals spawn in mid-April. Sexual maturity is attained at a length of ca. 45 cm. F: C; live foods of all kinds. In nature, these animals primarily feed on fishes from the genera Nemacheilus, Barbus, and Capoetobrama. Insect larvae are also appreciated. T: 10°-20°C, L: 75 cm, A: 150 cm, R: b, D: 3-4 (C)

Amu

84

Darya River at Tschadshou

Pseudo-Bony and Cartilaginous Fishes

ee

Pseudoscaphirhynchus

a

kaufmanni

3

a S.£-

Pseudoscaphirhynchus

kaufmanni

2

African Lungfishes

Fam.: Protopteridae

HECKEL,

Protopterus aethiopicus aethiopicus Ethiopian lungfish Syn.: Hab.: Lakes gabo,

Lepidosiren arnaudil. Africa: the Nile, but particularly Albert, Edward, Victoria, NabuTanganyika, Kyoga, and No.

F.1.: Unknown.

Sex.: None known.

Soc.

B.: Quarrelsome,

found on amphibian eggs. Juveniles nave branched external gills very similar to those of newts. After 2-3 months, the larvae undergo a transformation (metamorphosis) and adopt the adult morphology.

F: C; all kinds of hardy live foods such indolent,

cious predator. It practices (paternal family).

vora-

broodcare

M: As for Protopterus annectens annectens. Solitary maintenance is best. Only juveniles are suitable for home aquaria.

B: Lack of adequate space precludes breeding in aquaria. In nature, spawning generally occurs during the rainy season in muddy, deep holes. 6 d guard the eggs and the hatching young. The eggs are large with a large yolk and a gelatinous cover, reminiscent of that T: 25°-30°C,

1851

as fishes, worms, snails, mussel meat, crustacea, and insects and their larvae. The species can also be trained to accept pieces of meat.

S: Besides this nominate form, two other subspecies have been described: P. a. congicus POLL, 1961 (Zaire Basin from the upper Lualaba to Kinshasa) and P. a. mesmaekersi POLL, 1961 (lower Zaire Basin).

L: 200 cm, A: from 200 cm, Reb) im, Dr4 (Ce)

Protopterus annectens annectens (no photo) (OWEN, 1839) African lungfish Syn.: Lepidosiren annectens, L. tobal, istry. Since this voracious fish frequently Protopterus anguilliformes, P. rhinocrypbites, individual maintenance is strongly tis, Rhinocryptis amphibia, R. annectens. recommended. Hab.: Africa: Senegal, Niger, Gambia, Volta, and Chad Basins. Occasionally found in the tributaries of the Chari River in western Sudan. FalSsiono; Sex.: None known.

Soc. B.: This predator is antagonistic and waspish with congeners and other species. do guard the eggs and fry (paternal

family).

M: Maintaining these fish is limited to those persons or institutions having large show aquaria. Only young specimens are suitable for the home aquarium. A muddy substrate and dense vegetation are advantageous. The water does not need to be very deep; 30 cm is plenty. No demands are placed on water chem-

B: Has not been aquarium.

in an

F: C; hardy live foods such as fishes, snails, earthworms, and insects and their larvae. Sometimes these animals will learn to eat pieces of meat. S: Besides the nominate form, another, smaller (60 cm) subspecies has been described, P. annectens brieni POLL, 1961. The life history of Protopterus species was addressed on p. 208 of Vol 1 (S.).

T: 25°-30°C, L: 82 cm, A: from 120 cm, R: b, m, D: 4 (C)

86

accomplished

Pseudo-Bony and Cartilaginous Fishes

Protopterus aethiopicus,

white form

se.

Protopterus

aethiopicus

aethiopicus

87

Characins

Moenkhausia

88

colletti,

2 above,

3 below

African Characins Fam.: Alestidae

True African Characins

Subfam.: Alestinae

Hemigrammopetersius

barnardi

&

(HERRE,

Hemigrammopetersius barnardi Syn.: Rhabdalestes barnardi, Hemigrammopetersius intermedius. Not to be confused with the “true” H. intermedius. Hab.: East Africa: Tanzania, gions.

coastal re-

F..: 1983 by SEEGERS and WISCHNATH. Sex.: 2 2 have a small anal fin (picture); 66 have an anal fin that broadens into a round lobe. Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish that is suitable for large community aquaria.

1936)

S: According to GERY, this fish should be classified into its own genus, but despite its peculiarities, it remains in the genus Hemigrammopetersius. The pictured animal is probably not H. barnardi, but an undescribed

species.

M: The aquarium must have a volume of at least 160 |. Maintain plenty of free swimming space. Keep vegetation confined to the edges. H. banardi should always be kept in schools. B: Unknown.

F: C, O; live and flake foods. Te 24°-27°C, LX 676m, Az 100/em; Rem, D: 2

89

True African Characins

Fam.: Alestidae Subfam.: Alestinae

BOULENGER,

Micralestes stormsi True red Congo tetra

1902

Syn.: Alestes imberi. Often confused with Micralestes humilis.

fish can be acclimated hardness of 25° dGH.

Hab.: Africa: Lake Chad.

B: Unknown. Probably similar to the blue Congo tetra, Phenacogrammus interruptus, Vol. 1, p. 222.

Zaire

Basin

and

southern

F.1.: Unknown,

Sex.: dd can easily be recognized by their red adipose fin and iris. 2 2 have a Silver iris.

Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish which should always be maintained in groups. Well suited for large community tanks.

to water with a

F: C, O; live and flake foods. S: Like other Micralestes species, M. stormsi is rarely imported, although these fish are common in the Zaire Basin.

M: House in long aquaria and confine vegetation to the tank’s fringes to insure plenty of swimming space. There are no particular demands placed on water quality: pH 6.0 to 7.6; hardness to

18° dGH. With careful adaptation, these T: 22°-26°C,

L: 7.5 cm, A: 100 cm, R: m, D: 2

HILGENDORF,

Petersius conserialis

Syn.: None. Hab.: East Africa: Tanzania, Dar es Salaam to Morogoro, in small flowing watersy

F.I.: 1982 by CLASSEN

and SEEGERS.

Sex.: The d has a convex anal fin.

Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish. M: Provide a large aquarium with plenty of swimming space, good filtration, and water movement. Limit tall vegetation to the edges. B: Unknown,

EEG); S: Petersius is a monotypic genus containing only, P. conserialis. Very little is known about this species. T: 22°-26°C,

90

L: 14.5 cm, A: 100 cm, R: m, D: 3

1894

African Characins

Micralestes

storms!

Petersius conserialis

Ngerengere

near Morogoro,

Tanzania

True African Characins

Fam.: Alestidae Subfam.: Alestinae

(BOULENGER,

Phenacogrammus altus Syn.: Hemigrammalestes altus, Nannopetersius altus, Petersius altus, Phenacogrammus nummifer. Hab.: West Africa: Zaire Basin. F.1.: Not known.

Sex.:

66

are more

colorful, while

9 2

nensis. All of these species are very similar.

tend to be rounder.

Soc. B.: Friendly schooling fish. M: Needs

a moderate-sized,

well-plant-

ed aquarium. Maintain high water quality. Water: pH 6.2-7.0; hardness up to 15° dGH. Insure the presence of plenty of swimming space in the foreground. Keep a large group if possible.

B: Unknown. Probably similar to the blue Congo tetra, Phenacogrammus interruptus (see Vol. 1, p. 222). F: C, O; live and flake foods. 1-24°=27-C.

i6:5 cm

AsOtcomy

Bathyaethiops caudomaculatus,

92

Ramin Das

Buta-Buma,

1899)

S: This rarely imported species is difficult to keep and especially problematic to breed. Additional members of the P. a/tus group are P. notospilus, P. huloti, P. pseudonummifer, P. cadwaladeri, and P. gabo-

Zaire, compare to p. 95.

African Characins

Phenacogrammus

altus

Phenacogrammus

altus

?, Kindu

Fam.: Alestidae

True African Characins

Subfam.: Alestinae

(BOULENGER, 1910)

Phenacogrammus ansorgli Ansorg's blue Congo tetra Syn.: Petersius ansorgei, P. ubalo, Nannopetersius ansorge/, Phenacogrammus ansorgel. Hab.:

West

Africa:

Gabon,

Zaire,

and

Angola. Pole Ce While! Sex.: dd have a comma-shaped spot behind the operculum and long threadlike dorsal and anal fins. 2 2 do not have a spot behind the operculum, and they are generally smaller with shorter fins. BOULENGER erroneously described the 22 as a different species, Petersius ubalo.

space. Suitable for “Dutch” aquaria. When the tank is illuminated from the front, the notorious blue dorsal section becomes obvious. Soft and slightly acid water (up to 12° dGH and pH 6.5, respectively) is recommended. Its requirements closely mirror those of the blue Congo tetra, Phenacogrammus interruptus (see Vol. 1, p. 222).

Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish suitable for large community aquaria containing fishes such as Phenacogrammus interruptus or Brycinus longipinnis. Always keep a small group, since individual

B: Rarely successful. According to FRANKE, the species’ reproductive biology is similar to that of the blue Congo tetra, P. interruptus.

F: C, O; all types of live foods, especially those that float on the water surface (Drosophila), and flake foods. S: Infrequently kept in aquaria. P. lamberti is the only similar species from the P. ansorgii group.

specimens wane.

M: Needs a large aquarium with dense vegetation yet plenty of free swimming We Zea 2S Oe ke W/Seiin, (ASO Oli), (RS ian 1h DE eZ)

(POLL, 1945)

Bathyaethiops breuseghemi African moon characin Syn.: Phenacogrammus breuseghemi, Micralestes breuseghemi. Hab.: Africa: Zaire Basin.

F.I.: Ca, 1980 to the United States, but only imported into Europe as unidentified by-catch. Sex.: 22 are deeper-bodied and fuller than 63. 66 have a more.colorful dorsal fin.

Soc. B.: Friendly schooling fish which should either be kept in a species tank or with other delicate fishes.

M: B. breusegheni needs free swimming space, a dark substrate, and a corner of floating plants. Filter over peat. Watehsil) GiO=A2 Mnandness: 108 152562) dGH. Exchange water every 2-3 weeks, and add a good water conditioner. hi; 22°=25°6, Ev cra, An 8Oicnn Rom, DaZ=s

94

B: Eggs are scattered among plants. The morning sun or a strong incandescent light directed into a dark aquarium stimulates spawning. Breeders must be conditioned with live foods.

F: C, O; small live foods of all kinds, flake and FD foods, frozen mosquito larvae, etc.

S: This seldom imported species only develops into a beautiful fish under optimal water conditions. A rewarding species for the specialist. Very similar to Bathyaethiops caudomaculatus.

African Characins

Phen.

Bathyaethiops

breuseghemi

Citharinids

Fam.: Citharinidae

(GEOFFROY,

Citharinus citharus Syn.: Citharinoides citharus, Citharops citharus, Citharinus citharinus, C. geoffroyl. Hab.: Africa: from Senegal Basin.

to the Nile

F.I.: Ca. 1970. Sex.: Unknown. Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish. M: This characin's rapid growth limits its suitability to show aquaria. Its high food intake challenges most filter systems, so use a powerful filter and bolster its

effectiveness changes.

1809)

Subfam.: Citharininae with frequent water ex-

B: Unknown. Due to its size, breeding is very unlikely in an aquarium. F: O; live foods, plant fare, and flake foods. Goldfish foods can be fed sparingly. S: In Africa, Citharinus species are widely distributed and very important food fishes. Juveniles have many black longitudinal striations, whereas adults are uniformly silver. It weighs up to 7 kg.

T:; 22°-28°C, L: 58 cm, A: from 120 cm, R: m, D: 3

Fam.: Distichodidae

Distichodins GUNTHER, 1871

Nannaethiops unitaeniatus African single-line characin Syn.: None.

Subfam.: Distichodinae re G, ©

Hab.: Africa: Sudan, Chad, Nigeria, the Gold Coast, Cameroon, Gabon, in the Loange and Kabinda Rivers. Widely distributed from the Zaire River to the Niger River and the White Nile. F.l.: By “Platy-Tischrunde” “Niger region,” in 1931.

from

the

S: This fish's colors quickly fade when it is disturbed or maintained in an unfavorable environment. It usually leads a secluded life. While N. unitaeniatus was presented in Vol. 1, the pictured animal was a 2. The more attractive 3 is shown here.

Sex.: dd are more slender and brighter orange than @ 2. Soc. B.: Peaceful, timid schooling fish. M: House in fine-grained tion, and lots hardness up

a species tank that has a substrate, sparse vegetaof light! Water: pH 6.5-7.5; to ca. 12° dGH.

B: Easily accomplished. 228. T: 23°-26°C,

96

See Vol 1, p.

L: 6.5 cm, A: 60 cm, R: b, m, D: 2-3

African Characins

Citharinus

citharus

Nannaethiops

unitaeniatus

Citharinids

Fam.: Citharinidae Subfam.: Distichodinae

Neolebias ansorgii, red form

BOULENGER, 1912

Neolebias ansorgil Syn.: Neolebias landgrafi, Micraethiops ansorgli. Hab.: Africa: Cameroon, Angola, Central African Republic, and Zaire (Tshilenge). Though it prefers to inhabit swamps, it has been found in the rivers Luculla and

B: Possible but not easy. Spawning occurs in peat substrates. The young hatch after one day and must be fed the tiniest live foods as they become free-swimming.

F: C, O; small live foods, flake foods.

Luali. F.1.: By MCEVOY of Hamburg, Germany,

S: This is a rare color morph. The common green form is pictured in Vol. 1, p.

in 1924,

28ip

;

Sex.: d¢ are darker. 92 have a fuller ventral area. In the picture, the top fish isa @ and the lower two are dc.

Soc. B.: This peaceful fish is often shy when kept-under suboptimal conditions.

Pair maintenance is possible. Not suitable for community aquaria! M: This problematic species demands high water quality. Frequent small water

exchanges are necessary. 1; 24°=28°C, E-3.51ome A: O/C

98

abn

Dae=s

African Characins Distichodins

Fam.: Distichodidae Subfam.: Ichthyborinae

(BOULENGER,

Ichthyborus ornatus Ornate fin-nipper

1899)

Syn.: Neoborus ornatus, Phago ornatus,

F: C: fishes or pieces thereof. Juveniles

Ichthyborus

also accept

taeniatus,

Phagoborus

or-

natus.

Hab.: Tropical Africa: Zaire Basin.

F.1.: Ca. 1980. Sex.: Unknown.

Soc. B.: Specialized fish and fin predators. Maintenance should be limited to a species tank. Provide plenty of food to prevent cannibalism.

insect larvae

S: This species is similar to the rarely imported (only as by-catch) Phago maculatus. According to GERY, there is an additional smaller species, Phagoborus guadrilineatus, from the Casamance Riv— er in Senegal.

M: Needs a dark-bottomed species tank rich in plants and hiding places. Cover the surface with floating plants. Bogwood and bamboo will provide additional hiding places and can serve to subdivide the aquarium. Water: pH 5.8-7.0; hardness up to 15° dGH. Strong filtration and frequent water exchanges are needed to keep dissolved metabolite concentrations low B: Unknown.

T: 22°-26°C, L: 20 cm, A: 100 cm, R: m, t, D: 4 (C)

99

Leporins

Fam.: Anostomidae Subfam.: Anostominae

HOLMBERG

Abramites solarii

Syn.: Leporinus ternetzi, L. solarii, Abramites nigripinnis.

B: Not known.

Hab.: South America: sin.

zen peas. Offer small live foods for variety. Juveniles will also eat tablet and flake foods (e.g., Tetra Conditioning Food).

F.1.: 1984 by many).

BLEHER,

Rio Paraguay BaFrankfurt

(Ger-

Sex.: Have not been described.

Soc. B.: Occasionally consumes tender plant shoots when sufficient plant fare is not provided. Older specimens may be rough towards conspecifics.

F: L, H; algae, lettuce, spinach, and fro-

S: A beautiful species that should be imported more frequently. There is an additional Abramites species from the Rio Magdalena in Colombia (A. egnes), but to the best of our knowledge, it has not been imported.

M: Provide good filtration and illumination. The substrate should consist of pebbles and rock fragments. Crevices are thoroughly searched for edibles. Only use tough plants such as Java fern, etc., and just remove algae from the front pane. Water: pH 6.5-7.8; hardness up to 20° dGH. T: 22°-25°C,

L: 12 cm, A: 120 cm, R: m,

OSS

Anostomus plicatus Syn.: None.

Hab.: South America: Guyana and Suri-

name. F.1.: Unknown.

Sex.: Unknown.

Soc. B.: A congenial fish which can be appropriately cared for either in large schools or in community with heterospecifics. Loners may become quarrelsome.

EIGENMANN,

F: H, O; vegetable fare is necessary, as are algae and small organisms such as water fleas and mosquito larvae. S: At times, this species has four dark spots along its sides, recognizable as

light areas in the photo. Their intensity is mood

M: Strongly illuminate the aquarium to provide the densely planted, somewhat algae-covered biotope these fish favor. Algae and vegetable fare are dietary necessities for long term care. Anostomus plicatus’s natural habitat is rich in plant life. Water: pH around 6; hardness up to 12° dGH, but lower values are better. Strong filtration helps insure the high water quality this fish demands. B: Unknown.

T: 24°-28°C,

100

1912

L: 15 cm, A: 100 cm, R: b, m, D: 2-3

related.

American Characins

Abramites

solarii

Anostomus

plicatus

Leporins

Fam.: Anostomidae Subfam.: Anostominae

WINTERBOTTOM,

Anostomus spiloclistron Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: Guyana and Suriname. F.1.: Unknown. Sex.: Unknown. Soc. B.: When 6 or more animals are kept in a school, they are quite peaceful. Individuals wane and disturb other

fishes.

Suitable for community

1974

S: The genus Anostomus is divided into the subgenera Anostomus and Laemolyta. Only Anostomus taeniatus (see Vol. 1, p. 234) belongs to the subgenus

Laemolyta. A. anostomus, A. gracilis, A. plicatus, A. spiloclistron, A. ternetzi, and A. trimaculatus belong to the subgenus Anostomus GRONOW, 1763.

aquaria

that are not overstocked.

M: This is a somewhat problematic species. See Anostomus plicatus and Anostomus anostomus, Vol. 1, p. 234.

B: Unknown. F: H, O; plant fare, small live or frozen foods, and flake foods. T: 24°-28°C, L: 16 cm, A: 100 cm, R: b, m, D: 3

EIGENMANN,

Leporinus granti Grant's leporinus Syn.: Hypomasticus “maculatus.”

granti,

Hab.: South America: Amazon Basin.

Leporinus

Guianas

and the

F.1.: Unknown. Sex.: None.

Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish which makes an appropriate addition for large

community tanks. If the school is excessively small,

towards

they may

turn belligerent

conspecifics.

M: Leporinus species require large tanks with clear, well-filtered water, but the current should not be overly strong. Its captive environment should have a fine, dark gravel substrate, bogwood, and hardy, tough plants such as Java

fern. All plants must be omitted from tanks containing adult specimens. Since

have a capacity of at least 200 |. Exchange '/2 to '/; of the water volume every 2 to 3 weeks. While filtering over peat or adding peat extract increases the well-being of the fish, it is not necessary for successful maintenance. Water: pH 5.5 to 7.5; hardness up to 20° dGH with a dKH of 10°, but less is better. B: Has not been successful.

F: H; flake foods, fruits, algae, lettuce, spinach, and chickweed. Various fruits or soft vegetables should be tried. Live or frozen foods should occasionally be offered. S: Spotted Leporinus species are difficult to tell apart. Leporinus badueli, L. granti, L. marcgravi, L. megalepis, and L. steyermarki all hail from the same region and are often confused.

most Leporinus species attain a respectable size, the aquarium should T: 22°-26°C,

102

1912

L: 20 cm, A: 100 cm, R: b, m, D: 2

American Characins

Anostomus

spiloclistron

Y;

Leporinus

granti

103

~

Leporins

Fam.: Anostomidae Subfam.: Anostominae

MARAL-CAMPOS,

Leporinus lacustris Lake leporinus Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: Sao Paulo Province of Brazil and Laguna Negra in Paraguay (see MAHNERT,1987. Das Aquarium, 11: 221). F.I.: Ca. 1980. Sex.: There are no external differentiat-

ing features. Soc. B.: This peaceful schooling fish is suitable for large community aquaria. M: House in large aquaria that have clear water, a gravel bottom, roots, and very tough plants (e.g., Java fern) or those of plastic. Leporinus are usually unappreciated aquarium fishes because of their nasty habit of consuming any and all plants. They live in deep sections of sandy-bottomed

creeks,

often

1945

strongest currents, and feed off foods such as aquatic plants, fruits, and leaves carried to them in the current. Trees that have fallen into the water are “grazed.” Since most species reach a respectable size, prospective purchasers should beware of the increasing demands these fishes will place. Water: pH 5.8-7.8; hardness up to 20° dGH. B: Has not been successful.

F: H (OQ); vegetable fare. Live or frozen foods should occasionally be offered. S: The pictured specimen is a young fish from Laguna Negra. The dark spots disappear with age.

in the

T: 22°-27°C, L: 20 cm, A: 100 cm, R: b, m, D: 2

GUNTHER, 1863

Leporinus megalepis Large-scaled leporinus Syn.: Hypomasticus

megalepis.

Hab.: South America: Guayas and Amazon Basins.

This species, though quite common its natural habitat, is rarely imported.

F.1.: Unknown.

Sex.: There are no external differentiat-

ing features. Soc. B.: While considered to be a schooling fish, single specimens can be kept. Conspecifics and heterospecifics are not disturbed, making it a good species for community tanks. M: See Leporinus granti or Leporinus friderici, Vol. 2, p. 238. B: Unknown.

F: H, O; herbivore that will appreciate frozen or FD foods occasionally being added to the diet. Flake and tablet foods will be accepted.

S: Very similar to Leporinus megalepis, L. friderici, L. granti, and L. “maculatus.” T: 22°-27°C, L: 30 cm, A: 120 cm, R: b, m, D: 3

104

in

American Characins

Leporinus

Leporinus

lacustris

megalepis

Leporins

Fam.: Anostomidae Subfam.: Anostominae

SCHOMBURGK,

Leporinus nigrotaeniatus Black-band leporinus Syn.: Chalceus nigrotaeniatus, Leporinus margaretaceus, Salmo. biribiri. Hab.: South America: the Guianas the Amazon Basin (?).

and

F.|.: Unknown.

1841

S: Because of its size, L. nigrotaeniatus is conditionally suitable for aquaria. This fish can be easily maintained in sizeable aquaria housing large cichlids. The pictured animal is an adult; a juvenile can be found in Vol. 1 on p. 241.

Sex.: Sexes cannot be differentiated by external characteristics. Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling species which may tend to be aggressive towards conspecifics if maintained in schools that are too small. Suitable for very large community aquaria.

M: Refer to Vol. 1, p. 240, or Leporinus granti. B: Unknown. Fata

T: 23°-26°C, L: 40 cm, A: 150 cm, R: b, m, D: 3

Leporinus steyermarki Gray leporinus Syn.: None.

INGER, 1956

Hab.: South America: Venezuela (?) and Paraguay. F.1.: Not known.

Sex.: Sexes cannot be differentiated by external characteristics.

Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish that can be kept in large aquaria. M: See Leporinus granti. B: Has not been successfully plished in an aquarium.

accom-

F: H, O; plants as well as live foods. S: The pictured fish is a juvenile. As the fish ages, the design fades. There are several similar species. See Leporinus granti, p. 102. T: 22°-26°C, L: 30 cm, A: 120 cm, R: b, m, D: 3

106

American Characins

Fam.: Characidae

True American Characins

Subfam.: Bryconinae

(GUNTHER, 1869)

Brycon cephalus South American trout Syn.: Megalobrycon cephalus, M. erythropterus (?), Chalceus cephalus. Hab.: South America: Amazon

Basin.

F.I.: Only imported as by-catch. Sex.: There are no external distinguishing features. Soc. B.: Juveniles are peaceful schooling fish and suitable for community aquaria. Adults maintain their schooling behavior but are predators, which limits tankmates to equal-sized fishes.

possible. Always keep plenty of free swimming space. B: Unknown. Its mature size is probably the only reason breeding has been unsuccessful.

EXC

50}

S: See the similar Brycon falcatus in Vol. 1, p. 244, and Brycon melanopterus in Vol. 2, p. 246. This is the type species for the subgenus Megalobrycon.

M: House in a large, strongly filtered aquarium. Cover the aquarium well, since this species is an excellent jumper. Water: pH 5.5 to 7.5; hardness up to 20° dGH. Plants, if sufficiently robust, are T: 22°-26°C, L: 22 cm, A: 120 cm, R: m, D3

Chalceus erythrurus

COPE, 1870

Yellow-finned chalceus Syn.: Brycon erythrurus, Chalceus macrolepidotus, Plethodectes erythrurus. Hab.: South America: Amazon

Basin.

F.1.: 1913 (2). Sex.: There are no external between the two sexes.

differences

Soc. B.: A schooling fish whose appearance deceives one into believing it is a predator. However, it is only predacious towards significantly smaller fishes, making it easy to house with other, somewhat larger fishes.

S: This species is a particularly relished food fish in its native land; their meat is reputed to be better tasting than that of trout.

C. erythrurus is easily confused with C. macrolepidotus, see Vol. 1, p. 244; however, C. erythrurus is easily identified by its yellow ventral fins. If more irrefutable methods are called

for, the two species can be identified by their dentition.

M: Use a large aquarium that has sufficient free swimming space and a good cover to prevent it from leaping out. Plants can be included in the decor. B: Unknown. F: C, O; hardy foods such as earthworms, beef heart, or shrimp (frozen) are necessary to satisfy its voracious appetite. T: 22°-26°C, L: 25 cm, A: from 100 cm, R: m, t, D: 3

108

American Characins

Chalceus_

erythrurus

Fam.: Characidae

True American Characins

Subfam.: Bryconinae

STEINDACHNER,

Gymnocharacinus bergi Patagonian characin Syn.: None. Gymnocharacinus “fugi” is a trade name for dd. Hab.: South America: Argentina. Endemic to the headwaters of Valcheta Creek in northern Patagonia, south of the Rio de la Plata.

F.l.: 1978 by Dr. K. H. LULING, Bonn, Germany. Sex.: dd are smaller than 2° 2. The upper and lower edges of the 6 d's forked caudal fin are outlined in white. Soc. B.: Nimble, even hectic characins which are often found swimming against the current and jumping rapids like trout to gain access to other water regions. Does not form pairs or schools. M: Use a substrate of sand or finegrained gravel with a few flat stones or large pebbles on top. This fish needs a long aquarium with a lot of swimming space and a fast current. Maintain a low

The Valcheta Creek originates in a volcanic region and has a temperature of 22°C throughout the year, even in winter as snow falls (period of no food). The Patagonian characin is in danger of extinction, since trout have been introduced into the creek; currently there are only about 250 specimens!

water level that allows clearance between it and the cover (“jumping space’). Correspondingly, an effective cover is needed to keep the fish from leaping out. Plants that rise above the water surface can be included in the decor. Because of the fish's predilection for swimming countercurrent, air-driven interior filters are inappropriate, since the fish swim into the tube.

B: G. bergi spawns in gravel substrates below stones. First the gravel is removed and then, after spawning, the spawn is covered using the same gravel. Suction the gravel up with the spawn and hatch in a container. The larvae emerge after 36-48 hr and are free-swimming after an additional 6 days. Feed with plankton. Growth is slow. Water values do not seem to be important, but the temperature should neither be below 18°C nor above

22°C.

F: O; omnivore with a seasonal, voracious appetite. For about 3 months of the year it, needs little nourishment. S: G. bergi has the southernmost distribution of any South American characin. T: 22°C, L:

110

6

1903

4cm, 2 6 cm, A: from 60 cm, R: b, D: 4

American Characins

ap

Gymnocharacinus bergi 3

Gymnocharacinus

bergi °

True American Characins

Fam.: Characidae Subfam.: Characinae

MENEZES,

Acestrorhynchus altus Red dog characin Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: Amazon and Paraguay Basins, predominantly in large rivers. F.I.: Has not been imported alive(?). Sex.: Unknown. Soc. B.: A true predator that can only be

1969

F: C; small fishes, meat, earthworms, and large insects and their larvae.

S: In Paraguay, this is an appreciated food fish. Its appropriateness as an aquarium specimen is rather limited; more suited for large show aquaria.

kept with equal-sized fishes.

M: Subdivide the tank with wood and rocks and plant dense vegetation along the edges to prevent this very nervous fish from swimming against the glass. The surface should be partially covered with floating plants. Strong filtration and good water movement are required. Water: pH 5.5-7.2; hardness up to 18° dGH. B: Unknown.

T: 22°-26°C, L: 35 cm, A: 120 cm, R: m, D: 4 (C)

(GUNTHER, 1864)

Charax pauciradiatus Glass headstander Syn.: Anacyrtus pauciradiatus, Characynus pauciradiatus, Cynopotamus pauciradiatus, Epicyrtus pauciradiatus.

B: Unknown, but it should be similar to Charax gibbosus; see Vol. 2, p. 252. F: O.

Hab.: South America: Amazon Basin and

S: Though not a predator, its size and sporadic import make it a rarely kept species.

Paraguay. F.I.: Ca. 1910. Sex.: dd have gold patches during the spawning season (see picture). 22 are larger and have a rounded ventral area.

Soc. B.: C. pauciradiatus is a peaceful, somewhat timid species which readily retires among water plants. Wanes when associated with active fishes. Small fishes and tender plants are unceremo-

niously eaten M: Dense vegetation consisting of robust, fast-growing species. Roomy aquaria, While water movement is not

necessary, good filtration is. Water: pH 6.2 to 7.5; hardness up to 25° dGH.

T: 22°-27°C, L: 15 cm, A: 100 cm, R: m, D: 2

112

American Characins

Acestrorhynchus

altus

REL

Charax pauciradiatus

3

113

True American Characins

Fam.: Characidae Subfam.: Characinae

EIGENMANN,

Roeboides meeki Meek’s predatory characin

1922

Syn.: None.

among

Hab.: South America: Colombia, Rio Cauca.

a temperature of 25°C. Young hatch after 2 days and require live plankton. Juveniles are very cannibalistic if their di-

F.1.: Ca. 1950.

Sex.: dd

plants near the water surface at

etary needs are not met.

are slender;

22

are deeper-

bodied.

F: C; live foods, foods.

Soc. B.: This predaceous species is unsuitable for community aquaria because of its diet of scales and eyes of larger fishes.

cies that are difficult for even to differentiate.

M: Needs

S: There

fish scales,

are several

and flake

very similar spescientists

clear, oxygen-rich water and

a strong filter. Good nutrition is important. No particular demands are placed on water quality. This small, delicatelooking species is capable of devouring all its tankmates within a few weeks. B: Unknown; other species of this genus are open spawners that spawn T: 22°-26°C, L: 6 cm, A: 60 cm, R: m, D: 3

Roeboides paranensis Paraguayan predatory characin Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: Paraguay.

F.l.: Ca. 1970. Sex.: Unknown.

Soc. B.: Predator. Only equal-sized conspecifics make suitable tankmates. M: See Roeboides meeki. B: Unknown;

see R. meeki.

F: C; live foods. Flake foods are occasionally accepted. T: 22°-26°C, L: 6.5 cm, A: 60 cm, R: m, D: 3

114

UJ, 1987

American Characins

2 Roeboides

Roeboides

ae meeki

paranensis

True American Characins

Fam.: Characidae Subfam.: Cheirodontinae

GERY, 1965

Brittanichthys myersi Myers’ blood tetra Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: Rio Negro and Rio Xeriuni, in sluggish black waters over shallow sand banks.

F.1.: 1964. Sex.: dd have hooklets on the first rays of the anal fin and modified rays in the caudal fin. Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish. Makes a good tankmate for other small, peaceful fishes. Very sensitive to stress. M: A lot of free swimming space and resting places among plant thickets are needed. Plant the edges with natant creeping-shoot vegetation, and limit plants in the front quadrant to low-growing specimens. Hiding places among bogwood are important. As per its natural biotope, this sensitive species must T: 22°-24°C, L:

be kept in black water: pH 4.5 to 6.0; hardness up to 8° dGH; carbonate hardness immeasurably low. Either add peat extract or filter over peat. Keep illumination moderate; use water values that fall between the fish's requirements and those of the plants.

B: Unknown; probably difficult. F: C, O; small live foods, Artemia, and flake, freeze-dried, and frozen foods.

S: B. myersi is very sensitive to transport-related stress and demands much attention when imported. Brittanichthys axelrodi and B. myersi have unusual shaped anal and caudal fins which assumedly play a role in reproduction. Fin morphology is used to identify this species.

4.cm, A: 80 cm, R: m, D:

Holoshestes pequira Orange spot characin Syn.: Cheirodon pequira, pequira, O. trementina.

(STEINDACHNER, Odontostilbe

would make good aquarium fishes, but they are rarely imported.

Hab.: South America: Rio Guaporé and Rio Paraguay. F.1.: Unknown.

Sex.: dd are more slender and colorful.

Soc. B.: Friendly schooling fish. M: House in a large aquarium that is equipped with a filter strong enough to provide a constant current and, at the same time, maintain the water clean and clear. Use a dark substrate. Filtering over peat is advantageous. Water: pH 6.2 to

7.5; hardness up to 20° dGH. B: Unknown, but it should be similar to that of Paracheirodon innesi; see Vol. 1,

p. 307. F: C, O; flake foods, Artemia, FD foods, and small live foods.

S: Fishes of the genus Holoshestes and the very similar genus Saccoderma T: 22°-26°C, L: 5.5 cm, A: 80 cm, R: m, D: 2

116

1882)

American Characins

Brittanichthys

Holoshestes

myersi

pequira

117

True American Characins

Fam.: Characidae Subfam.: Cheirodontinae

COPE, 1870

Odontostilbe fugitiva Fugitive characin Syn.: Cheirodon fugitiva, Odontostilbe caguetae, O. drepanon, O. madeirae. Hab.: South America: Amazon Basin and Colombia. F.1.: Unknown.

Sex.: 6¢ are slender, whereas full through the ventral area.

Soc. only have cies.

°°

are

B.: This peaceful schooling fish is suitable for community tanks that a population of small, tranquil speMaintain in groups of at least 6;

individuals

B: Unknown.

F: C, O; live, flake, and FD foods accepted.

are

S: Repeatedly imported into North America; probably has not been kept by European hobbyists. O. fugitiva is the type species of the

genus. FINK & WEITZMAN consider this fish a member of the genus Cheirodon.

wane.

M: This demanding species prefers clear water with a slight current. Its oxygen requirement is slightly above average. Peat filtration is beneficial. It can be slowly acclimated to slightly harder water. Water: pH 5.8 to 7.5; hardness up to 20° dGH. T: 22°-26°C, L: 5 cm, A: 60 cm, R: m, D:

Phenacogaster pectinatus Pectinatus Syn.: Astyanax pectinatus, Tetragonopterus pectinatus, T. bairdii, T. tabatingae, Phenawgastier bairdii. Hab.: South America: quite common in the upper and central regions of the Amazon Basin.

(COPE, 1870) red-brown, the golden band on the lateral line becomes more pronounced, and the two black spots become more intense than those seen on the picture. Water: pH 6.0-7.8; hardness up to 25° (12°) dGH.

F.|.: Uncertain, since this fish has often been imported as by-catch. Definitely imported before 1968.

B: Has not been described. It is probably similar to Hemigrammus species.

Sex.: The anal fin of the @ is slightly concave; the anterior part of the 3's anal fin is either strongly curved or a long lobelike entity—or something in between.

S: Phenacogaster megalostictus, a similar fish from the Rio Negro and the Guianas, has a larger black spot on its side. P. pectinatus is the type species for the genus. Two rows of unusual genus-typical scales run ventrally along its sides. These scales form a double protruding keel that extends on both sides.

Soc. B.: Very peaceful schooling fish. It swims with its head slightly inclined. Greatly similar to the Roeboides characins. M: This relatively undemanding species exhibits a humble amount of color when placed in tanks having sufficient vegetation to dim light penetration, a dark substrate, and good filtration. Fins turn T: 23°-27°C,

118

L:

8cm, A: 80 cm, R: m, D: 1

F: O; flake, FD, and frozen foods.

American Characins

Odontostilbe

fugitiva

me?

es Oi .

Phenacogaster

pectinatus

agee oe:

eee

es

oe

pe seieeies

ee

Oe

True American Characins

Fam.: Characidae Subfam.: Glandulocaudinae

(STEINDACHNER,

Coelurichthys microlepis Croaking tetra, small-scaled tetra Syn.: Mimagoniates microlepis, Paragoniates microlepis. Hab.: South America: Joinville.

southeast

Brazil,

F.I.: 1907 by O. KITTLER, Hamburg, Ger-

many. Sex.: d¢ are larger, more colorful, and have elongated fins. 2 2 are somewhat fuller through the ventral area. Sexual differences are frequently difficult to impossible to see in animals that are not full-grown. Soc. B.: Not a marked schooling animal, but it does like to live in a group. M: Easily kept, even in community aquaria. Although soft, slightly acid to slightly alkaline water is probably preferred, water values seem to play a subordinate role. The blue iridescence of the fish is more pronounced when the illumination is not excessively bright. The aquarium should have plenty of vegetation along the edges, but also open areas since the animals are tireless swimmers.

1876)

B: These animals spawn on plants or similar substrates. The following method has been successful: In a 60 cm aquarium with soft, slightly acid water, a large bundle of loose, green synthetic floss is introduced. Two pairs are placed into the tank. If the animals do not spawn within 2 days, an intense diet of mosquito larvae should be instigated. After spawning, the parents have to be removed. The whitish eggs are distributed throughout the floss. Young hatch after 2-3 days and are fed with infusoria after they become free-swimming. Later, Artemia nauplii and other small foods are fed. F: C; live, frozen, and flake foods.

S: This species is constantly confused with C. tenuis and Glandulocauda (= Coelurichthys?) inaequalis. Even the animal pictured in Vol. 2, p. 255, isa d C. microlepis. Caudal fin morphology can

be used to identify the species.

T: 18°-23°C, L: 6 cm, A: 80 cm, R: t, m, D: 3-4

NICHOLS, 1913

Coelurichthys tenuis Barberos characin Syn.: “Mimagoniates

barberi;” not RE-

GAN. Hab.: South America: southeast Brazil, Paraguay, and northern Argentina. F.I.: 1907 Germany.

by Oskar

Kittler, Hamburg,

Sex.: 2's dorsal fin is rounded, whereas that of the ¢ is elongated. The anal fin of the ¢d reaches beyond the caudal peduncle (elongated into a tip), while that of the @ is rounded and terminates at the center of the caudal peduncle. Soc. B.: This peaceful schooling fish is suitable for cool community aquaria.

M: Difficult to maintain. It comes from small, swift, shady creeks in hilly terrain. The water is clear, slightly peat-brown, and oxygen-rich. These conditions can only be simulated in tanks that are slightly heated (cooled during the sum-

mer). Water: pH 5.5-6.5; hardness up to 4° dGH. The tank should be immaculate and dimly lit with pronounced water current.

B: 24°C. Fertilization is internal. The semen package is transferred after intense courtship and the d's unflagging trials to embrace the 2. Once insemination is successful, the 2 can, even weeks afterwards, lay fertilized eggs. The underside of water plants or grasses is preferred. Larvae hatch after 1 day, but are difficult to raise because of their diminutive size. The smallest freshwater plankton is necessary for even moderate suc-

cess. S: This species has been discussed under the name “Mimagoniates barberi." However that is a totally different, yet to be imported, species.

T: 19°-22°C, L: 5 cm, A: 80 cm, R: t, D: 3-4 (C)

120

American Characins

Coelurichthys

Coelurichthys

microlepis

tenuis

True American Characins

Fam.: Characidae Subfam.: Glandulocaudinae

MYERS & MIRANDA-RIBEIRO,

Xenurobrycon macropus Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: Rio Paraguay. F.1.: Unknown. Sex.: dd have conspicuously anal and tail fins.

shaped

Soc. B.: This peaceful schooling fish is suitable for community aquaria containing small tranquil fishes. A species tank is better, however, since X. macropus is somewhat prone to diseases. M: Floating plants provide the cover this species requires. Water: pH 6.0 to 7.5; hardness up to 20° dGH. B: Unknown.

F: O; live and flake foods. S: The vitreous X. macropus is readily identified by the uncommon shape of its fins. Fishes of the genus Tyttocharax are very similar. 22°=28°

122

CE SiciwAw Orem

Raniia Dae

1945

American Characins

Fam.: Characidae

True American Characins

Subfam.: Paragoniatinae

Rachoviscus crassiceps Thick-head characin

MYERS,

1926

Syn.: None.

B: Unknown.

Hab.: South America: Brazil, near Rio de

F: C, O; flake, FD, and small live foods, including water fleas and mosquito larvae,

Janeiro,

Parana.

F.I.: Ca. 1940. Sex.: dd have nooklets and whiteedged fins. 2 2 remain smaller than dd. Soc. B.: This peaceful schooling fish is well suited for community aquaria stocked with small fishes. However, single specimens are reputed to be aggressive and will not live long.

S: This small and, unfortunately, rarely imported species makes a good aquarium fish, even for beginners. Rachoviscus |s closely related to the genera Aphyocharax and Prionobrama.

M: Good swimmer, so be sure to leave plenty of swimming space. Insure that the water is well-filtered and the tank is bright and heavily planted. Water: pH 5.6 to 7.2; hardness up to 18° dGH. Always keep a small school of at least 8. R. crassiceps is rheotactic, often found in front of the filter discharge. T: 20°-25°C,

L: 4.5.cm, A: 70 cm, R: m, D: 1-2

123

Fam.: Characidae

True American Characins

Subfam.: Tetragonopterinae

Tetras

Astyanax fasciatus fasciatus

(CUVIER, 1819)

American stripe tetra, silvery tetra Syn.: Anoptichthys fasciatus, Poecilurichthys fasciatus.

Hab.: South and Central America: from Argentina up to Mexico. Widely but sporadically distributed. F.1.: Ca. 1920.

Sex.: do are slimmer than °°.

Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish. Good addition for community tanks containing large fishes. M: This relatively undemanding species requires little attention. Water values are not particularly important, but soft water is advantageous. A lot of open swimming space is important for these active fish. Since flora is not eaten, the aquarium can contain plants.

breeding tank. These characins spawn on plant bundles. A mesh over the bottom is beneficial, since the parents are distinctly predacious towards their spawn. Remove the parents after spawning is concluded. Young hatch after 1-2 days, but 6 days pass before the young are free-swimming. Larvae can be immediately fed Artemia nauplii. Copious feedings and frequent partial water exchanges are important factors when rearing this species. ExG.O!

S: Nine subspecies of A. fasciatus have been described. The blind cave form was presented in Vol. 1, p. 256. Astyanax bimaculatus and A. schubarti are very similar.

B: Easy to breed. Either pairs or, more naturally, schools should be placed in a T: 20°-25°C, L: 14 cm, A: 100 cm, R: m, D: 1

Astyanax giton Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: eastern Brazil. F.I: Ca. 1980. Sex.: Unknown.

Soc. B.: Schooling fish. M: See Astyanax fasciatus fasciatus.

B: Unknown.

Probably similar to that of

the above species.

FaiGn©! S: This species is difficult to identify. The pictured animal could be Hemigrammus schmardae (STEINDACHNER, 1882). See Vol. 2, p. 274. T: 20°-25°C, L: 8 cm, A: 80 cm, R: m, t, D: 1

124

EIGENMANN,

1908

American Characins

Astyanax

Astyanax

fasciatus

giton

True American Characins

Fam.: Characidae

Tetras

Subfam.: Tetragonopterinae

EIGENMANN,

Astyanax guianensis Guyana tetra Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: Guyana and Venezuela.

1909

F: C, O; flake, frozen, and FD foodstuffs.

S: Rarely imported because of the nondescript appearance of juveniles.

F.1.: Unknown. Sex.: 66 are slimmer, and their anal fin iS more curved.

Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish. Suitable for any community tank of sufficient size.

M: Cover part of the water surface with floating plants and make sure there is plenty of free swimming space below. Dense edge vegetation. Peat filtration is preferred, but not necessary. Water: pH 5.8-7.5; hardness up to 20° (8°) dGH. B: Spawns in schools among fine-leaved plants. T: 23°-27°C,

L: 6 cm, A: 80 cm, R: m, D:

(JENYNS, 1842)

Astyanax scabripinnis Rough-finned tetra Syn.: “Astyanax fasciatus,” terus scabripinnis. Hab.: South east Brazil.

America:

Tetragonop-

east and

south-

F.1.: Unknown.

Sex.: 22 are noticeably fuller through the ventral area.

Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish that are suitable for community tanks containing hardy plants. Tender plant shoots are nibbled on. M: Offer plenty of free swimming space. Provide good filtration and water movement. Water: pH 6.5-7.5; hardness up

S: The genus Astyanax encompasses most species within the subfamily Tetragonopterinae. They are probably the most typical and basic of all tetras. The scales are clearly reminiscent of cyprinids. One subspecies of A. scabripinnis has been described by EIGENMANN, 1914: A. scabripinnis paranae from the Rio Parana and the Rio Grande. Both of these rivers drain south into the junction between Brazil, Paraguay, and Argentina through the legendary Iguazu Waterfalls.

to 18° dGH. B: Open spawner. Schools as it lays its eggs among plants. F: O; omnivore that consumes plants as well as any live foods it can catch. Vegetable flakes.

T: 22°-26°C, L: 10 cm, A: 100 cm, R: m, D: 2

126

American Characins

Ks

Astyanax

scabripinnis

True American Characins

Fam.: Characidae

Tetras

Subfam.: Tetragonopterinae

Bryconamericus

sp. aff. stramineus

Syn.: None; since the species name could not be unequivocally determined, perhaps it is still an undescribed species.

Hab.: South America: Paraguay. F.1.: Not Known. Sex.: Unknown.

Soc. B.: Schooling fish. M: Demands plenty of peace and quiet, particularly when only a few specimens are kept. Therefore, do not house with lively fishes. Dense vegetation increases their coloration, especially if part of the surface is also overgrown. A dark substrate and filtering over peat, while not necessary, are certainly helpful. Water: pH 5.5 to 7.2; hardness up to 25° (10°) dGH; not above 8° dKH.

EIGENMANN,

1908

B: Unknown, but probably similar to Nematobrycon lacortei and N. palmeri.

See also N. “amphiloxus” palmeri. F: C, O; small live foods are its preferred choice. S: Rarely do fishes from the speciesrich genus Bryconamericus, which GERY says require an urgent our aquaria. Additionally, unidentifiable. Fishes of quire high oxygen levels, in fast-flowing creeks.

revision, reach they are often this genus resince they live

T: 22°-26°C, L: 6 cm, A: 70 cm, R: m, D:

EIGENMANN,

Ceratobranchia obtusirostris

Syn.: Ceratobranchia binghami.

C. ela-

tior belongs to a different genus. The genus Microgenys has a similar body morphology, but totally different dentition. Hab.: South America: Peru, Colombia.

F.I.: Has not been imported into Europe

alive; the picture was taken in the United States. Sex.: Unknown.

Soc. B.: Schooling fish. M: As for Bryconamericus. B: Unknown. (O);

S: The genus Ceratobranchia is monotypical; hence, the only species contained therein is C. obtusirostris. Ceratobranchia and Microgenys are very hard for the layperson to distinguish. See Syn. T: 20°-24°C, L: 7 cm, A: 80 cm, R: m, D: 2

128

1914

American Characins

Bryconamericus

Ceratobranchia

sp. aff. stramineus

obtusirostris

~

True American Characins

Fam.: Characidae

Tetras

Subfam.: Tetragonopterinae

STEINDACHNER,

Hemigrammus bellottii Dash-dot tetra Syn.: Hemigrammus agulha, H. bellottii, H. orthus, Tetragonopterus bellottii. Hab.: South America: the Amazon region.

the Guianas

and

F.1.: Unknown. Sex.: dd are smaller and thinner in com-

parison to ripe 2°. Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish that are suitable for community tanks housing active fishes. M: In order for it to display its beauty, this species must be kept in schools and housed in tanks whose light is filtered through floating plants or leaves. Peat filtration and a slight water current are advantageous. Water: pH 5.8 to 7.5; hardness up to 15° dGH, but less than

1882

B: Spawns in bunches of fine-leaved plants at 27°C. Either breed in pairs or schools. The breeding tank should have a spawning mesh and soft, peat-filtered water. Feed the young live plankton and rotifers.

F: C, O; small live foods and flake foods. Feed small portions several times a day. S: This fish might actually be a Hyphessobrycon.

10° is better. T: 23°-27°C, L:

4cm, A: 60 cm, R: m, D:

GERY, 1986

Hemigrammus bleheri Brilliant rummy-nose Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: Colombia, Rio Vaupes; Brazil, Rio Negro.

F.l.: 1965

by Heiko

BLEHER,

Kelster-

bach, Germany. Sex.: d is slimmer. 2 is fuller and has a rounded ventral area at spawning time. Soc. B.: Peaceful, nimble schooling fish. Easily associated with similar species. M: Not always easily maintained because of the attention to water quality it demands. Keep nitrate concentrations low with frequent water exchanges. Use a good water conditioner. Tap water that contributes a nitrate concentration above 30 mg/l is detrimental.

B: 25°-28°C; soft, peat-filtered water; pH 6.0-6.5; hardness less than 4° KH. Schools in large tanks are easier to spawn than pairs. Small-leaved plants are the substrate of choice. Eggs are

frequently eaten. The fry hatch after 3036 hr and are free-swimming after the fourth day. Feed the smallest freshwater plankton at first, since the fry are very tiny. F: C, O; flake foods with FD components, FD tablets, and small live foods.

S: Compare to Petite/la georgiae and Hemigrammus rhodostomus (Vol. 1, pp. 308 and 272, respectively. H. bleheri was previously identified as H. rhodostomus AHL, 1924. However, after further consideration, the differences in coloration and cranial bone morphology established this fish as an autonomous species. H. bleheri and H. rhodostomus are black water fishes, while Petitella prefers white waters.

T: 23°-26°C, L: 4.5 cm, A: 80 cm, R: m, D: 2-3

130

American Characins

Hemigrammus

bellottii

Hemigrammus bleheri

Fam.: Characidae

True American Characins

Subfam.: Tetragonopterinae

Hemigrammus micropterus

Tetras

MEEK, 1907

Syn.: None. It is possible that Hemigrammus boesemanni micropterus.

is a subspecies of H.

Hab.: South America: Venezuela. F.1.: Unknown. Sex.: dd are smaller and slimmer.

Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish. M: See Hemigrammus bellottii. B: Unknown, but probably similar to other Hemigrammus species.

F: C, O; an omnivore that is particularly appreciative of small live foods. S: Hemigrammus species with a spot on the caudal peduncle are unusually difficult to identify. T: 23°-27°C, L: 35cm, A: 50 cm, R: m, D: 2

Hemigrammus tridens Cross-spot tetra Syn.: None. Hab.: South America:

EIGENMANN,

Rio Paraguay,

Paraguay.

F.I.: Ca. 1980. Sex.: dd are smaller and slimmer. Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish. M: See Hemigrammus bellottii. B: Unknown, but probably similar to other

Hemigrammus

species.

F: C, O; flake and live foods.

S: According to GERY, this is a very colorful species. T: 23°-25°C, L: 3.5 cm, A: 50 cm, R: m, D: 2

132

1907

American Characins

Hemigrammus

Hemigrammus

micropterus

tridens

3

~

True American Characins

Fam.: Characidae Subfam.: Tetragonopterinae

Tetras

Hyphessobrycon compressus

(MEEK, 1904)

Syn.: Hemigrammus

compressus.

Hab.: Central America: Guatemala, Honduras, and Mexico. F.1.: Ca. 1970.

Sex.: Full-grown and slimmer.

66

are slightly larger

Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish. M: See

140).

Hyphessobrycon

werneri

(p.

B: Unknown, but probably similar to other Hyphessobrycon species. F: C, O; flake and live foods. S: Hyphessobrycon milleri is a very similar species from the same geographic area. T: 23°-26°C, L: 3.5 cm, A: 50 cm, R: m, D: 2

WEITZMAN,

Hyphessobrycon elachys Reed tetra Syn.: None. Frequently seen in books as Cheirodon kriegi. Hab.: South America: Brazil, Paraguay. In the Rio Paraguay Basin, upper Rio Guaporé, and the Laguna Blanca. Usually found along reed-choked shores.

F.I.: Ca. 1935 as Cheirodon kriegi. Sex.: dd have very elongated dorsal and ventral fins, a larger anal fin, and a noticeably white adipose fin. 2 ° are normally thicker than 3d.

Soc. B.: A peaceful, active schooling fish which makes a good addition to the community aquarium. M: Clean, well-filtered water with little current is‘best. Water: pH 6.0-7.2; hardness up to 15° dGH. The shy demeanor of this fish can be overcome to a large extent by using floating plants and dim lighting.

T: 24°-27°C,

134

L: 5 cm, A: 80 cm, R: m, D: 2

1985

B: Like most characins, these animals prefer to spawn among fine-leaved plants. F: C, O; flake, live, and frozen foods.

S: The black spot on the anal area only appears in 22, despite indications to the contrary. However, it does not imply

ripeness.

H. elachys

°°

were first de-

scribed as an autonomous species. Unfortunately, Vol. 2 contains this error. MAHNERT (1987) exhaustively described the Paraguayan habitat of H. elachys and its fellow species in Das Aquarium, 11, 221.

American Characins Eee

ee

§

Hyphessobrycon

Hyphessobrycon

compressus

elachys

True American Characins

Fam.: Characidae

Tetras

Subfam.: Tetragonopterinae

Hyphessobrycon Firefin tetra

MIQUELARENA,

igneus

Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: Argentina and Paraguay, in mountain creeks. F.1.: 1984.

MENNI, LOPEZ & CASCIOTTA,

1980

be housed with scavengers such as catfishes so leftovers will be eaten.

S: An interesting and beautiful new import for the hobby.

Sex.: ¢¢ are colorful and slim.

Soc. B.: An active, peaceful schooling fish. M: The water should be slightly cool, meticulously clean, with a swift current. Good water quality is important, requiring good filtration and frequent partial water exchanges. Healthy, profuse plant growth helps insure low levels of dissolved metabolites. Water values play a subordinate role in maintaining this fish. B: Unknown.

F: C, O; live and flake foods. If flakes are frequently fed, this characin should T: 20°-24°C, L: 5 cm, A: 80 cm, R: m, D:

EIGENMANN & OGLE, 1907

Hyphessobrycon inconstans Fickle tetra Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: east Brazil, Para-

guay, and Colombia, in flood plains of the Magdalena. Thanks to MORTH, its presence in Clemencia, Arjona, Repelon, Magdalena, Gambote, and Lake Cinga de Gambote has been determined. F.1.: Unknown.

as follows: pH 6.5; hardness 7° dGH; temperature 26°C. The young hatched after 24 to 30 hr. For an additional 3 days they hung on the glass and plants or laid on the substrate. After they were free-swimming, they could eat Artemia nauplii. This very fecund species lays about 600 eggs per set-up and per ¢.

Sex.: With the exception of the more convex ventral profile of °°, there are no differentiating characteristics.

Soc.

B.: This peaceful

schooling

fish

makes an appropriate addition to community aquaria.

M: Undemanding, somewhat shy fish. Good vegetation is necessary. Water: hardness of 2°-20° dGH; temperature 20°-28°C. B: Only possible in aquaria at least 50 cm long. BOHM was the first to successfully breed this fish. His conditions were T: 22°-28°C, L: 4.5 cm, A: 60 cm, R: m, D: 1

136

F: C, O; small live foods as well as flake foods.

S: There are several geographical variants.

American Characins

Hyphessobrycon

igneus %

True American Characins

Fam.: Characidae

Tetras

Subfam.: Tetragonopterinae

BOULENGER,

Hyphessobrycon luetkeni Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: southeast Brazil.

Paraguay

and

Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish. M: See Hyphessobrycon inconstans (previous species).

F.1.: Ca, 1980.

B: Not known.

Sex.: d¢ are slimmer.

FHORC

T: 22°-26°C, L:

4cm, A: 60 cm, R: m, D: 2

LADIGES,

Hyphessobrycon peruvianus Peruvian tetra, blue Loreto tetra Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: Peruvian Amazon region around Iquitos and Tabatinga. F.I.: 1938 by Aquarium Hamburg, Ger-

many. Sex.: dd are slimmer than niles cannot be sexed.

22. Juve-

Soc. B.: Lively, peaceful schooling fish. Other small tetras, Corydoras species, small labyrinth fishes, dwarf cichlids, and similar fishes make fitting tankmates.

M: Aquaria with dim lighting, peat filtration, and a dark substrate are ideal. Fineleaved plants can be included in the decor. Partially covering the water surface with floating plants enhances the fish's well-being. Water: pH 6.0-7.0; hardness 5°-10° dGH. Regular water ex-

changes with the addition of peat extract every 3-4 weeks are recommended. B: Reports on successfully reproducing this species are sparse. WOLF wrote about Hyphessobrycon metae in DATZ 1963, pp. 33 ff. According to this report, these fish have a notoriously bright red tail fin. However, this is only the case with H. loretoensis. In contrast, H. peruvianus has a colorless, translucent caudal fin. Furthermore, H. metae’s tail fin is only reddish along the base; the rest is colorless, WOLF's breeding report is of interest, since H. peruvianus and H. loretoensis are closely related. It can therefore be assumed that breeding methods would T: 24°-26°C,

138

1887

1938

be similar: A suitable breeding pair was selected from a school. The 3 spread his fins and commenced to intensely court his chosen 2. WOLF used a “trial” combination of water parameters to breed this fish, which happened to be the same he uses to breed cardinal tetras. Exact specifications are not given. However, it was probably soft water (2° 4° dKH) with a pH of around 5-6. Peat filtration and deionized water are surely advantageous. The 2 spawned among fine-leaved

plants. Considering

the animal's timid

nature, the breeding tank should be dark. Use Enchytraeidae and glassworms to ripen the animals. Two days after spawning, the larvae hatched and were fed small infusoria from the 5" day. After another 5 days, Artemia can be fed. These fish are not very fecund, which is why this species is rarely encountered in pet shops. Nevertheless, WOLF had 41 young the first spawn and 84 young in the second.

F: C, O; small live, flake, and FD foods. Frozen Cyclops. Bloodworms are only suitable for full-grown specimens. Young glassworms and mosquito larvae are better.

S: GERY assumes that this species is a Hemigrammus. Renaming many Hyphessobrycon species is still pending. Compare this species to H. metae and H. loretoensis (Vol. 2, p. 278 and Vol. 1, p. 290, respectively).

L: 4.5 cm, A: 60 cm, R: m, D: 2-3

American Characins ee ee ee ee

Hyphessobrycon

peruvianus

~

True American Characins

Fam.: Characidae

Tetras

Subfam.: Tetragonopterinae

GERY & UJ, 1987

Hyphessobrycon werneri Werner’s tetra Syn.: None.

strate is preferred, as are a slight current and peat filtration. Water: pH 5.6 to 7.0; hardness up to 20° dGH; up to 7°

Hab.: South America: Brazil. In a forest creek between Maria do Para and Sao

Miguel de Guama, 120 km from Belem (Para), road BR 010. F.1.: In 1986 by A. WERNER, H. BLEHER, and others.

Sex.: ¢¢ have a larger dorsal fin and more intense coloration; 2 2 are usually fuller.

Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish. Suitable for community tanks containing small species.

M: Moderate-sized aquaria with dense vegetation along the edges and sparse vegetation in the center quadrant. Insure that the foreground is free so that courtship and the display behavior of the dd can be observed. A dark subT: 22°-27°C, L:

dKH. B: Unknown.

Presumably similar to Hyphessobrycon bentosi bentosi. Surely soft water with a slightly acid pH will be required for reproduction. F: C, O; all small live foods, including mosquito larvae, Cyclops, and Artemia. Flake and FD foods are also accepted. S: This new species is part of the H. bentosi group, but it is also related to Megalamphoaus. The dentition is species-typical, but aquarists can use its distinctive shoulder spot as an identifying characteristic. The species description can be found in DATZ, 12-1987, p. 546.

4cm, A: 60 cm, R: m, D: 1-2

(KNER, 1858)

Moenkhausia dichroura

Spot-tailed moenkhausia Syn.: Tetragonopterus

dichrourus.

Hab.: South America:

Paraguay, Guya-

na, Brazil. In the Amazon

Basin and the

Rios Paraguay and Paranagua.

F: C, O; small live foods, flake foods, and FD items. Plants are ignored. S: Very similar to Moenkhausia media (Vol. 1, p. 300).

F.1.: Ca. 1980.

Sex.: dd are slimmer and have a ventrally pointed swimbladder.

Soc. B.: Very peaceful schooling fish. Suitable for well maintained aquaria. It can be kept with other fishes. M: Requires soft water with a hardness of up to 12° dGH. It does not live long in hard water. Peat filtration is advantageous. In subdued light—floating plants and a dark substrate will provide this ambient—Moenkhausia species display better.

B: Although as yet unsuccessful, it will probably prove similar to other Moenkhausia species and other characins.

T: 22°-26°C, L: 4.5 cm, A: 60 cm, R: m, D: 2-3

140

inter-

American Characins

Moenkhausia

dichroura

True American Characins

Fam.: Characidae

Tetras

Subfam.: Tetragonopterinae

GERY, 1966

Moenkhausia hemigrammoides

Signal tetra Syn.: None.

F: O; small live foods and flakes.

Hab.: South America: throughout the Guianas. F.1.: Unknown, but identified in 1984 (see G. OTT in DATZ, 6).

S: M. hemigrammoides is difficult to distinguish from Hemigrammus unilineatus unilineatus (GILL, 1858) and H. unilineatus cayaennensis GERY, 1959. Moenkhausia have a complete lateral line. See OTT for details (DATZ, 6-1984); additional references can also be found there.

Sex.: Unknown. Soc. B.: Peaceful and harmless towards all fishes.

M: Relatively hardy. Easily endures a hardness of 15° dGH and a pH of 7.5. Of course, this species is more colorful in soft, slightly acid water. Not a typical schooling fish; nevertheless, keep several specimens. It prefers dim tanks and a layer of floating plants. B: Unknown, but probably similar to other small characins. Tz 22°=25:G,

E3.5.cmeAnoOrcm

Rata

sD

EIGENMANN,

Moenkhausia sp. aff. intermedia False spot-tailed tetra Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: southeast Brazil.

Paraguay

and

F.1.: Unknown.

Sex.: The 3’s swimbladder is more pointed posteriorly, and the anal fin has a white tip and is slightly more elongated. ° does not have a white-tipped anal fin. Soc. B.: Friendly schooling fish. Suitable for lightly- to moderately-stocked community tanks. M: See Moenkhausia

dichroura,

p. 140.

B: Unknown.

F: C, O; live foods as well as high quality flake foods. S: Very similar to M. dichroura and Hemigrammus marginatus, This species has a different design on the caudal fin than M. intermedia and is probably an as yet undescribed species. T: 23°-27°C,

142

L: 4.5 cm, A: 60 cm, R: m, D: 2-3

1908

American Characins

Moenkhausia

sp. aff. intermedia

True American Characins

Fam.: Characidae

Tetras

Subfam.: Tetragonopterinae

(EIGENMANN, 1914)

Piabarchus analis Piaba glass: tetra Syn.: Hemibrycon analis. Hab.: South America: Paraguay, Rio Paraguay and others.

in the

F.1.: Ca. 1984. Sex.: Unknown.

Soc. B.: A solitarily living fish. M: Clear, clean water with reedlike vegetation such as Vallisneria or Sagittaria. B: Unknown.

F: C, O; small live foods, but it can probably be trained to flakes. S: Few specimens have reached scientists. Likewise, only individuals were captured in Paraguay (see MAHNERT, Das Aquarium, 221, 11-1987). For a long time the genus was considered monotypic, but a more slender Piabarchus species has been found. T: 20°-26°C, L: 4.cm, A: 80 cm, R: m, D:

(EIGENMANN, 1903)

Psellogrammus kennedyi Kennedy’s astyanax, Kennedy’s tetra Syn.: Astyanax kennedyi.

Hab.: South America: Paraguay, in the Rio Paraguay and Rio San Francisco.

S: Seldom imported because of the lack of aquaristic interest.

F.I.: Ca. 1984.

Sex.: Unknown.

Soc. B.: Sedate, rather reclusive animals that. predate on very small fishes. Not suitable for community aquaria. M: Small aquaria with a capacity of about 50 | are sufficient. Soft, slightly acidic water is commiserate to its needs (hardness up to 12° dGH and pH 5.5-6.8, respectively). Do not overstock the tank; 5 to 7 animals are optimal. B: Unknown.

F: C; small to large live foods, e.g., mosquito larvae, water fleas, Tubifex, and small fishes. Can also be trained to flakes, but regular meals of live foods will always be indispensable. During the winter, Artemia can be fed. T: 22°-28°C, L: 6.5 cm, A: 50 cm, R: m, D: 3

144

American Characins

Piabarchus

analis

Psellogrammus

kennedyi

Darter Tetras

Fam.: Characidiidae Subfam.: Characidiinae

(WEITZMAN & KANAZAWA,

Odontocharacidium aphanes Syn.: Klausewitzia

aphanes.

Hab.: South America: Rio Negro and the Amazon River. F.I.: 1969 by ESPE, Bremen, Germany. Sex.: Sexes cannot be differentiated by external characteristics. Soc. B.: Pacific loner. Limit tankmates to very small, peaceful fishes. If several animals are being cared for, territories are established. M: Provide a large aquarium that is heavily planted with fine-leaved plants and Java moss. Water: pH between 5.8 and 7.0; hardness up to 12° dGH. B» According

to PINTER,

these fish will

breed in a 200 | aquarium that has plenty of Java moss without the active vention of the hobbyist.

inter-

F: C, O; small live and FD foods, Artemia.

S: Very small member of a recently described genus. The species name of the

T: 22°-26°C, L:

146

2.cm, A: 30 cm, R: all, D: 3

1977)

pictured fish has not been confirmed. K. aphanes is almost identical to Characidium voladorita SCHULTZ, 1944. However, that species reaches a length of more than 4 cm and lives in the Maracaibo Basin in Venezuela. Eye diameter in relation to body length is greater in K. aphanes. See DATZ 1969, p. 100 and TI

6/1989, p. 12.

American Characins Fam.: Crenuchidae

Poecilocharax weitzmani

~



GERY, 1965

Black darter tetra

dinal tetra shipments.

the animal's mineral balance. Ceratopteris thalictroides (Indian fern = water sprite) tolerates these extreme water values and affords the necessary shade for the aquarium. Provide hiding places among bogwood, stones (slate), and floating plants. Immoderate illumination prevents the fish from displaying their marvelous colors.

Sex.: dd are large and slender to “skinny” with beautiful finnage. The above photo shows 2 dd.

B: Not precisely known. The 3d practices broodcare. Read PINTER in DATZ, 1-1988.

Soc. B.: In contrast to Crenuchus spilurus, this is a peaceful schooling fish. It is somewhat shy, which makes it unsuitable for community aquaria. The d cares for the spawn.

F: C; small live foods such as mosquito larvae, water fleas, Cyclops, and Artemia. In the winter they can be fed Tubifex and frozen foods.

Syn.: None, but frequently written incorrectly as Poeciliocharax.

Hab.: South America: the Amazon Basin, upper Orinoco River, and upper Rio Negro. F.1.: Unknown because it is often imported as unidentified by-catch in car-

M: Difficult to keep. It places high demands on water quality and live foods are obligatory. Water: pH 5.2 to 6.5; hardness up to 5° dGH; no carbonate hardness! Totally deionized water filtered through peat is best. A little tap water

must be added, Ne 24°=28°Gl

however, to maintain

4icm, As60icm,

S: Often imported as by-catch among cardinal tetras where it “disappears” unfortunately. Crenuchus: spilurus is similar but unsociable. P. wei/tzmani was

presented previously on p. 279 of Vol. 1, but without accompanying text. An additional species, Poecilocharax bovalli EIGENMANN, 1909, has also been described.

Rim), b, Dis

147

Curimatas

Fam.: Curimatidae Subfam.: Curimatinae

Curimata gilli Gill’s curimata

EIGENMANN

& KENNEDY,

1903

STEINDACHNER,

1882

Syn.: Rivasella gilli. Hab.: South America: Paraguay. F.I.: Ca. 1980. Sex.: Unknown. Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish. M: Similar to Curimata nasa. Provide soft to medium-hard water.

B: Unknown. el ah lO} S: The silver Curimata and Curimatopsis species are especially difficult to distinguish. More information on curimatas can be found in MAHNERT, 1987, Das Aquarium, 11, 221. T: 20°-28°C, L: 10 cm, A: 80 cm, R: m, D: 2

Curimata nasa Nose curimata Syn.: Cruxentina nasa. Hab.: South America: Paraguay.

F.I.: Ca. 1980. Sex.: Unknown. Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish. Possible suitable tankmates for other sedate species.

M: Soft substrate that allows the fish to dig, e€.g., sand. Only tough or hardy, fast-growing plants can be used, preferably potted. A wide range of water values are tolerated. Water: pH 5.5 to 7.5; hardness up to 20° dGH. Since plants are normally chewed on, the decor should mainly consist of rocks and wood. Floating plants and filtering through peat are both advantageous. Strong filtration with little water movement and frequent water exchanges are important. B: Unknown. Normally spawns after the rainy season in its natural habitat. T: 20°-28°C, L: 10 cm, A: 80 cm, R: m, D: 2

148

F: H, O; plant fare, live foods, and flake foods. S: The numerous, very similar members of the family Curimatidae are difficult to differentiate, even for specialists.

American Characins

Curimata

nasa

Curimatas

Fam.: Curimatidae

VARI, 1982 Subfam.: Curimatinae

Curimatopsis myersi Myer’s curimata Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: Paraguay.

F.l.: Ca. 1980. Sex.: Unknown.

Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish. M: See Curimata nasa. B: Unknown, but probably similar to Curimatopsis macrolepis; see Curimata naSa.

Fari@, S: Another new species for the already populous Curimata and Curimatella genera. T: 20°-26°C, L: 5 cm, A: 60 cm, R: m, D:

Prochilodus ortonianus

COPE, 1878 Subfam.: Prochilodinae

Gray prochilodus Syn.: Prochilodes

cephalotes,

Chilodus

cephalotes.

Hab.: South America: Amazon Basin. F.l.: Ca. 1960. Sex.: Unknown. Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish. M: Large aquarium with black water. Provide hiding places among bogwood. Water; pH 6.0 to 7.2; hardness up to 12° dGH. B: Unknown.

iradmhs S: P. ortonianus is very similar to Prochilodus nigricans. The pictured fish is a juvenile.! Adults are solid gray. T: 22°-28°C, L: 25 cm, A: 120 cm, R: m, D: 3 (H)

150

American Characins

Prochilodus

ortonianus

Curimatas

Fam.: Curimatidae Subfam.: Prochilodinae

Py

Semaprochilodus insignis

(SCHOMBURGK, 1841)

Semaprochilodus insignis Flag prochilodus Syn.: Chilodus insignis, Prochilodus insignis. Hab.: South America: the Guianas, in

F: H, O; an omnivore with a predilection for plants. Spinach, lettuce, etc., are accepted.

the Rio Branco.

S: Not as colorful as S. taeniurus site page).

F.l.: Ca. 1960. Sex.: Not known.

Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish for large aquaria. They can be associated with other herbivores. M: A shallow, roomy aquarium with plenty of swimming space is needed. Its high metabolic rate makes a good filtration system compulsory. Water: pH 5.5 to

7.2; hardness

up to 15° dGH.

Waive

plants and center the decor around plastic plants and wood. B: Unknown.

T: 22°-26°C, L: 30 cm, A: 120 cm, R: m, D: 3 (H)

152

(oppo-

American Characins Fam.: Curimatidae

Curimatas

Subfam.: Prochilodinae

eR:

Semaprochilodus

taeniurus

(VALENCIENNES, 1817)

Semaprochilodcus taeniurus Plain-body prochilodus Syn.: Because of uncertain species identification, there are no synonyms to date. Hab.: South America: west Colombia, in the Rio Purus.

Brazil and

F.1.: Unknown.

Sex.: 2 are fuller during spawning season; only distinguishable in large aquaria. Soc. B.: Schooling fish. Its congenial nature towards fishes does not extend to vegetation. M: Because this fish is an adept jumper, a cover is suggested. Provide strong filtration, current, and a substrate of finegrained sand or mulm and mud. Hardly any requirements are placed on water: pH 5.8-7.8; hardness up to 25° dGH. B: Difficult to breed in aquaria. The animals spawn during the rainy season in inundated areas. Like salmon, the fish

migrate upcurrent during the spawning season, ascending rapids and small waterfalls.

F: O, H; algae, plant shoots. Peas (raw or frozen), lettuce, and chickweed are suitable substitutes. This species has two stomachs, one of which is generally full of mud. It seems that detritus is digested from the mud. S: S. taeniurus was previously presented in Vol. 1, p. 320. However, the authors doubt that the color differences between the juvenile pictured in Vol. 1 and the animal pictured here are due to age. They suspect that these are two different species. Aquarists who have had an opportunity to observe these animals are asked to please divulge information concerning any color changes that these fishes may undergo. In their native habitat, they are frequently consumed.

T: 23°-26°C, L: 30 cm, A: 180 cm, R: m, b, D: 2-4 (H)

153

Hemiodids

Fam.: Hemiodidae

Hemiodopsis quadrimaculatus vorderwinkleri Torpedo characin Syn.: Hemiodus

B: Unknown.

quadrimaculatus.

Hab.: South America: upper Amazon, Guyana, and Suriname.

F.I.: 1967 by BLEHER,

Frankfurt

(PELLEGRIN, 1908) Subfam.: Hemiodinae

(Ger-

many).

F: O; flake and live foods and plenty of plant fare (peas, etc.). S: Easily distinguished from H. g. quadrimaculatus. See the drawings in Vol.

2, p. 216.

Sex.: Unknown. Soc. B.: Agile, peaceful schooling fish. M: This very active schooling fish requires a lot of room, oxygen, and tough vegetation. Usually plants are spared. The animals are initially shy and constantly move nervously about. House them with bottom-dwelling fishes such as Corydoras. Use a plastic cuplike container in lieu of a net to catch these animals, as exposure to air quickly proves fatal. While its water chemistry requirements are not stringent, frequent water exchanges are a must. Water: pH 6.0— 7.5; hardness up to 20° dGH.

T: 23°-27°C, L: 10 cm, A: 100 cm, R: m, D: 2-3

Parodon tortuosus tortuosus Blue darter tetra Syn.: Parodon pirassunungae (P. carrikeri and P. gestri may also be synonyms).

Hab.: South America: upper Rio Paraguay, Rio Alto Parana, Rio Apa, and Mato Grosso,

EIGENMANN & NORRIS, 1900 Subfam.: Parodontinae B: Unknown. F: H, O; algae, vegetable fare, small live foods, and flakes.

S: There is another subspecies, P. t. caudalis. Parodon suborbitale is a similar species (Vol. 2, p. 318).

F.l.: Ca. 1985.

Sex.: Mature ventral area.

°°

are fuller through the

Soc. B.: Juveniles are peaceful school-

ing fish, but adults are territorial. M: Requires current and oxygen-rich water. Therefore, well-filtered, clean water is conditional for P. t. tortuosus's continued health. Algae growth is highly beneficial. With the exception of very fineleaved plants such as Myriophyllum, plants are not damaged. Water: pH 6.2

to 7.2; hardness up to 20° dGH (high hardness values are only tolerated after careful acclimation). T: 22°-26°C, L: 10 cm, A: 80 cm, R: b, m, D: 2

154

American Characins

Xe

AF

PEPPER RH ES?

Parodon

tortuosus

tortuosus

PES

$

Pencil Fishes and Pyrrhulinins

Fam.: Lebiasinidae Subfam.: Lebiasininae

Lebiasina

bimaculata

Lebiasina bimaculata

VALENCIENNES,

Two-spot lebiasina Syn.: None. Hab.: South and Peru. F.I.:

America:

Unknown,

since

western most

Ecuador Lebiasina

species are very similar. Sex.: ful.

dd

are slimmer and more

color-

Soc. B.: Predacious. Restrict tankmates to larger fishes; a species tank is best.

M: Undemanding. Water: pH between 6.2 and 7.5; hardness up to 25° dGH. Hiding places created with wood, stones, or plants are appreciated. B: Unknown.

F: C; live and frozen foods.

S: As with most Lebiasina species, this species lacks an adipose fin. In some species, individuals or populations with and without an adipose fin can be found. T: 22°-26°C, L: 20 cm, A: 120 cm, R: m, D: 2-3

156

1846

American Characins Fam.: Lebiasinidae

Pencil Fishes and Pyrrhulinins

Subfam.: Pyrrhulininae

WEITZMAN & COBB, 1975

Nannostomus marylinae Marylin’s penciifish Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: from the same regions as the cardinal tetra, Paracheirodon axelrodi. F.1.: Unknown, since it is usually imported as unnoticed by-catch. Sex.: 63 roundish.

are slender, whereas



are

Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish. ¢ d establish tiny subterritories within the school's territory. Only house with small, peaceful species. M: A densely planted aquarium at least 50 cm in length. Water must be clean with a pH of 5.5-6.5, a hardness of less than 4° dGH, and no dKH. Dark substrate and a few aquatic plants provide a secure, darkened habitat, as preferred by this pencil fish. Avoid fluctuating water values during and after the necessary water exchanges. T: 24°-26°C,

B: Can be bred as a continuous spawner or in a pairwise set-up. A small yield, 20 to 30 juveniles per pair, is to be expected. Very soft water is a prerequisite for breeding. See PINTER, DATZ, 51987, for details. F: C, O; small live and flake foods.

S: Very similar to Nannostomus trifasciatus but without the bright red in the fins. N. marylinae has an adipose fin. Rarely imported, beautiful species which sometimes reaches the aquarium trade as by-catch in cardinal tetra shipments.

L: 5 cm, A: 50 cm, R: m, t, D: 2-3

157

Fam.: Lebiasinidae

Pencil Fishes and Pyrrhulinins

Subfam.: Pyrrhulininae

WEITZMAN,

Pyrrhulina spilota Blotched pyrrhulina Syn.: Copella spilota.

B: As for Pyrrhulina stoll.

Hab.: South America: no specific geographic distribution areas are known.

F: O; live foods are preferred.

F.1.: Ca. 1970.

1960

S: Very similar to Pyrrhulina vittata (Vol. 1, p. 348).

Sex.: $d are somewhat larger with a brighter white fringe on the caudal fin. 2 @ are fuller. Soc. B.: A peaceful species which makes a highly suitable tankmate for equalsized fishes. In nature it is found in groups or schools. Nevertheless, this is not a schooling fish. Keep a group of 6— 8 animals.

M: Large, moderately lit tank with good vegetation and an open swimming area in the foreground. Good filtration and current are important. Filter over peat. Water: pH 5.8 to 7.0; hardness up to 15°

dGH. T: 23°-26°C, L:6 cm, A: 60 cm, R: m,t, D: 3

BOESEMAN,

Pyrrhulina stoli Syn.: Copella stoli.

Hab.: South America: Suriname, Guyana, in the upper Rio Meta. F.1.: Around

1960.

Sex.: 6 ¢ are larger, frequently darker, with more elongated fins; 2 2 are small-

er. Soc. B.: Small groups of these peaceful animals can be maintained in community aquaria. At spawning time, dd establish small territories, becoming intolerant of rivals in their proximity. M: Easily kept species. Large, densely planted tanks that have sufficient swimming space make an appropriate cap-

tive environment.

Since the species is

aquaria. The ¢d guards the spawn and fans fresh water over the eggs. If you mean to reproduce this species, it is best to put a pair in a breeding tank and to remove the eggs (the entire leaf and accompanying eggs). Slight aeration promotes better egg development. F: O; flake, live, and frozen foods. Drosophila and other floating insects play a vital role towards bringing pairs into breeding condition.

S: According to GERY, this species is closely related to Pyrrhulina eleanorae FOWLER, 1940. It can be distinguished by its greater number of predorsal scales, 12-13 vs. 11. P. eleanorae is native to the Rio Ucayali in Peru.

an excellent jumper, the aquarium must be well covered. Soft, slightly acid water.

B: Eggs are laid on large-leaved water plants, sometimes even in community T: 20°-24°C,

158

1953

L: 8 cm, A: 60 cm, R: m, t, D: 1-2

American Characins

Pyrrhulina_

spilota

Pyrrhulina_stoli

Fam.: Serrasalmidae

Silver Dollars, Pacus, and Piranhas

Subfam.: Myleinae

KNER, 1860

Metynnis maculatus* Red-bellied pacu Syn.: Myletes maculatus, Methynnis maculata, Metynnis roosevelti (not EIGEN-

MANN,

1915).

Hab.: South America: Brazil and Bolivia,

in the Rio Guaporé Basin, and Rio Madeira.

F.I.: 1910 by Arthur Rachow. Sex.: 3's anal fin is more intensely colored, and the anterior half is broader (convex); ¢’s anal fin is straight and equally wide over its entire length. Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish, but not an appropriate addition for planted community tanks. Can be kept with Leporinus and other fishes, even small speci-

mens. M: When the diet includes sufficient vegetable fare, most aquatic plants are ignored. Java fern and Java moss are not molested. Otherwise, decorate with roots, plastic plants, and stones. The

aquarium should not be densely stocked, since excessive nitrate concentrations (over 50 mg/l) cause the fins to deteriorate and fungus. Peat filtration or the addition of peat extract is advantageous. Water: up to 10° dGH; pH 6.0Ler.

B: Breeding is typical for characins. After intense pursuit among fine-leaved plants (Java moss, perlon fibers), the approximately 150, nonadhesive eggs are released and fall to the bottom among the spawning substrate. The larvae hatch after 4 days, and 4-5 days later, the young are free-swimming. Remove the parents. Feed Cyclops nauplii, bosmids, Artemia, and finely ground flake foods (MicroMin, etc.). *S: Species identification based on just a photograph is virtually impossible. The species name should therefore read Metynnis sp. aff. maculatus.

T: 20°-28°C, L: 18 cm, A: 100 cm, R: m, D: 2-3

EIGENMANN

Metynnis mola Syn.: Metynnis otuquensis, Myletes mola. Hab.: South America: Rio Paraguay Basin.

Paraguay. Full-grown animals are significantly more colorful than the pictured specimen.

Sex.: dd have a longer, rounded anal fin, whereas 2 2 have a straight anal fin. Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling able for community aquaria.

fish. Suit-

M: Metynnis species require large, shallow aquaria, dim illumination, plenty of free swimming space, and hiding places among bogwood or plastic plants. Filter over peat. Water: pH 5.0-7.0; hardness up to 12° dGH. B: Unknown, but probably like other Metynnis. F: H; all types of soft vegetation such as lettuce, spinach, watercress, chickweed, and vegetable flakes. S: A rarely imported species, since hardly any imports are received from T: 20°-26°C, L: 15 cm, A: 100 cm, R: m, D: 2-3

160

& KENNEDY, 1903

American Characins

Metynnis mola,

juvenile

Fam.: Serrasalmidae

Silver Dollars, Pacus, and Piranhas

Subfam.: Myleinae

STEINDACHNER,

Myleus gurupyensis Syn.: Myleus arnoldi, M. maculatus, loplus gurupyensis.

My-

Hab.: South America: the Amazon Basin.

and

the Guianas

minimal.

Furnish a large aquarium with

rocks, wood, and plastic plants. Real plants will be eaten B: Unknown.

F: H; lettuce, spinach, aquatic

F.1.: Unknown.

Sex.: None.

etc.

M: Proper nitrogen cycle management and high oxygen levels are imperative. Water quality aside, requirements are

S: M. gurupyensis is a member valid subgenus Myloplus.

T: 23°-27°C, L: ca. 25 cm, A: 100 cm, R:

D:3

plants, of the

(SCHOMBURGK in JARDINE, 1841)

Myleus pacu Brown pacu Syn.: Myletes pacu, Myleus setiger, M. doidyxodon, M. divaricatus, M. trilobatus, M. unilobatus. Hab.: South America: the Amazon Basin.

1911

the Guianas

and

F.1.: Unknown. Sex.: None. Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish.

M: Rocks, roots, and perhaps tree bark make suitable appointments for the re-

quired large aquarium. Plants should be waived, since they will be chewed on. B: Unknown. F: H; lettuce, spinach, and fruit. S: Myleus species, like some other char~acins, migrate upriver to spawn in the headwaters of their rivers. At that time, they develop large red spots on their sides. The brown spotted juvenile coloration is beautiful in its own right; it probably serves as camouflage.

T: 22°-26°C, L: 50-60 cm, A: from 100 cm, R: m, D: 3 (S) S

PLATE 22.

Steel engraving of Myleus pacu from JARDINE.

162

American Characins

* epee Metynnis hypsauchen

as

%&

¢, spawning coloration, see Vol. 1, p. 353

Group 3

Cyprinoidei

Suborder

Botia sp. aff. striata = probably a variety of Botia striata. more similar to B. striata as it ages.

Continuation of Abottina rivularis (p. 168): F: H, C; juveniles are herbivores (algae, including diatoms), but-adults are carnivores (small crustacea, aquatic insects). S: Abbottina

mud/sand

rivularis

bottoms

T: 18°-23°C, L:

164

lives on

sand

in slow-flowing

6 13.5.0m,

or

riv-

Becomes

progressively

ers, ponds, and swamps in its natural habitat. This species requires warmer temperatures than any other member of the subfamily Gobioninae from the Amur Basin.

2 8.5 cm, A: 80cm,

R: b, Dr 2-3

Carp-Like Fishes Fam.: Catostomidae

Suckers

(LACEPEDE, 1803)

Catostomus commersonii Commerson’s sucker

Syn.: Cyprinus commersonii, Catostomus alticolus, C. chloropteron, C. com-

munis, C. flexuosus, C. gracilis, C. pallidus, C. reticulatus, C. sucklii, C. teres, Cyprinus teres, Myxostoma trisignatum. Hab.: North America: Canada and the United States, in rivers and lakes of Quebec and from the Great Lakes to Mon-

tana, Colorado, Missouri, and Georgia. It can be found in all types of water. Sex.: Mature dd have a beautiful pinkpurple-orange sheen on their sides. They also have large knots on the anal fin rays and are usually smaller than °°. Soc. B.: Peaceful, active schooling fish. Associating these animals with Notropis species seems logical. M: Use sand or fine-grain gravel as substrate. Some stones and roots should be included in the tank's furnishings. Vegetation such as Fgeria (Elodea) or Myriophyllum can be planted along the

edges, but make sure there is still an open area for swimming. Water must be clear and clean; however, its chemistry is Of secondary importance. B: In nature the animals spawn in April and May. The 364 arrive at the spawning sites first. They are neither nest builders nor territorial. Often two 36 are found side-by-side with one 2. The sperm and more than 20,000 adhesive eggs are released simultaneously. At 10°C, the 8 mm long larvae hatch after 2-3 weeks. and at that time are 8 mm long. First foods are protozoans, diatoms, and minute crustacea. F: O; live foods of all kinds as well as shrimp, scraped meats, algae, and flake and tablet foods. S: C. commersonii

is the most common

species within the genus. It can reach a weight of 3 kg.

T: 4°-20°C, L: 30 (45) cm, A: 120 cm, R: b, D: 2

165

Loaches

Fam.: Cobitidae Subfam.: Botiinae

(from DAY, 1878) HAMILTON, 1822

Botia dario Bengal loach Syn.: Cobitis dario, Botia macrolineata. Hab.:

India: Bengal

and Assam,

Bihar

and Cachar. In the tributaries of the Bramaputra and Ganges Rivers. Eile tose

Sex.: Only full-grown 2 2 can be recognized by their large girth (eggs). Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish that can “be kept in community tanks, even those housing small fishes or large cichlids.

among plants are appreciated. Active during twilight hours, remaining hidden during the day. If associated with unsuitable tankmates (e.g., large predatory catfishes or fishes that dig), B. dario hides in the substrate. B: Unsuccessful.

F: C, O; fine live foods, frozen foods, flake foods, and TetraTips. S: A gorgeous, initially shy fish.

M: Soft water (up to 10° dGH) with a pH of 6.5 to 7.5. Caves and secluded areas T228°-26°C

EG

sem, As 01cm, ReayDss

Botia rostrata Ladder loach Syn.: Cobitis geto, C. geta, Schistura geto, Botia geto, B. histrionica, B. birdi.

Hab.: Asia: Burma and India, in Punjab, the Himalayas, Ganges Valley, Assam, Sind, Sone River. ales etstoy

Sex.: 22 are larger and barely have a light stripe

between

the dark

double

striations. Soc. B.: Contrary to Botia dario, B. rostrata is an absolutely peaceful schooling fish. A group of at least 6 specimens makes an excellent addition to soft water community aquaria.

M: Though maintainable, it, like all Botia, is very sensitive to chemical pollutants in the water. Adapted 8B. rostrata are diurnal and only slightly bashful.

B: Unsuccessful to date, but indications hat water exchanges trigger energetic swimming and courtship behavior could be interpreted to mean that this species is easier to breed than other Botia species. ‘ F: C, O; small live foods are preferred. However, flake and tablet foods are readily accepted as well.

S: The species name, according to HUNTER (1877), is derived from the native name “Gengto” in Goalpara. In Assam, T: 22°-25°C, L:6 cm, A: 70 cm, R: b, D: 1

166

(HAMILTON, 1822) these loaches are generally called “Bottia.” This is definitely the origin of the genus name. Botia dario (HAMILTON, 1822), B. dayi (HORA, 1932), and B. rostrata (HAMILTON, 1822) are only superficially similar. Ichthyologists working exclusively with preserved specimens have classified these species and others as synonymous. From a contemporary viewpoint, this is almost inexplicable. Equally problematic is when an autonomous species is declared to be the juvenile form of another. B. dario has 8 to 10 dark crossbands on the body which may be connected in places by longitudinal bands. The head profile is steeply sloped, clearly convex. B. dayi has about 10 paired crossbands which are only connected in the dorsal region. The species is slightly similar to B. striata and likewise grows to be more than 10 cm long. B. rostrata has 8 to 10 dark crossbands as well with either paired or single, ocelluslike light areas, particularly along the lateral line. The forehead is steep, and the head profile is angular. Identifying live loaches to species is not always simple, even for those familiar with the distinguishing characteristics.

Carp-Like Fishes

Botia rostrata

°

167

Carps

Fam.: Cyprinidae Subfam.: Gobioninae

Abbottina_rivularis

(BASILEWSKI, 1855)

Abbottina rivularis

Syn.: Gobio rivularis, Abbottina sinensis, Pseudogobio rivularis, P. sinensis, gnathus_ sinensis.

Tylo-

Hab.: Asia: former Soviet Union, central Amur Basin; Korea, Khan, Kun, and Suwon Rivers; Japan, with the exception of Hokkaido and the northern half of Hondo; northern China, the drainage basin of the central Yangtse and the Minkiana. F.I.: Has many.

not been

imported

into Ger-

Sex.: dd are larger and have a strongly convex dorsal fin. Nuptial tubercles appear on the first ray of the pectoral fins and the lower half of the head. !! are smaller, have a slightly convex dorsal fin, and do not have nuptial tubercles during the spawning season. Soc.

B.: Agile, peaceful

? practices

168

broodcare.

schooling fish.

M: Roomy aquaria with a sand or gravel substrate, some hiding places among stones, and sparse vegetation along the edges. Water should be clear and clean with a neutral pH and a hardness of up to 20° dGH. The species can be kept with other peaceful fishes. B: Probably has not been bred in an aquarium. In nature, the animals spawn in June and July. Sexual maturity is reached at a length of 4 cm. The round nests the d d construct in the substrate are 5mm deep with a diameter of 12-

43 mm. 22 can spawn several times, laying up to 2,000, 2-2.5 mm eggs. The ? guards the nest. At 18°C, the larvae hatch after 6-8 days. They lay barely moving on the bottom of the nest. Active feeding only starts after the yolk sac has been absorbed.

Continued on p. 164.

Carp-Like Fishes Fam.: Cyprinidae

Carps

Subfam.: Abraminae

Lae

Abramis

bram

(LINNAEUS, 1758)

Abramis brama Bronze bream Syn.: Cyprinus brama.

Hab.: Europe: from the Atlantic to the Urals north of the Pyrenees and Alps. The

species

also

inhabits

the

Dwina,

Volga, and Terek Rivers, as well as Lake Aral. |t is not found

in Iceland,

northern

Scotland, northern Norway, Sweden, Finland, or the western or southern Balkans. Can also be found in brackish Baltic Sea rivers, e.g., the Schlei. F.l.: European

Sex.:

¢¢

bercies

whereas

species.

have pronounced

during

the spawning

nuptial tuseason,

2 2 are much fuller during that

time.

Soc. B.: During the spawning season and winter months, A. brama schools. The rest of the time the animals limit themselves to small groups. M: Requires a roomy, tall aquarium, a substrate of fine sand, and some roots

as decoration. Because the animals relish dense plant growth, the edges and back of the tank should be planted with native species. No special demands are placed on water composition; water values should be similar to those provided for other coldwater cyprinids (hardness ca. 15° dGH, pH 7.0-7.5). While higher temperatures are tolerated, the tank will nave to be well-aerated.

B: Has not been successful in an aquarium. In nature, the bronze bream forms schools during the spawning season (May and June). Spawning usually occurs at night along shallow, vegetated shores. Large ° 2 can lay up to 300,000 eggs which take 3 days to develop at 18°-20°C. The hatching larvae are about 4 mm long and remain motionlessly adhered to plants until their yolk sac is absorbed. Continued on p. 172.

169

~

Carps

Fam.: Cyprinidae Subfam.: Leuciscinae

(FILIPPI, 1863)

Acanthalburnus microlepis Napotta Syn.: Abramis microlepis, Acanthalburnus punctulatus, Alburnus punctulatus. Hab.: Asia: former Soviet Union, drainage basins of the Kura and the Arak Rivers; in rivers and lakes.

S: The monotypic genus Acanthalburnus is closely related to the genus A/burnoides but the last unbranched ray of the dorsal fin is enlarged into a soft spine (genus

name!).

F.1.: Has not been imported to Germany.

Sex.: 2

are fuller during the spawning

season. Soc. B.: Peaceful, lively schooling fish. M: As indicated for A/burnoides gus.

oblon-

B: To the best of our knowledge,

this

fish has not been bred in an aquarium.

Little information is available concerning the reproductive biology of this species. F: C, O; live foods

of all kinds,

flake

foods, and sometimes vegetable fare.

T: 10°-20°C (coldwater fish), L: 25 cm, A: 80 cm, R: m, D: 2

(BULGAKOV,

Alburnoides oblongus Syn.: Squalalburnus

oblongus.

Hab.: Asia: former Soviet Union, basin of the Syr-Darya River.

F.I.: Has not been

imported

in the

into Ger-

many. Sex.: ° 2 are fuller during the spawning season.

F: C, O; live foods of all kinds such as plankton and floating foods. Flake foods are also consumed.

S: A. oblongus

is closely related to Al-

burnoides taeniatus see Vol. 2, p. 360.

Soc. B.: A surface-oriented schooling fish. Associate with other coldwater species that have similar requirements (other cyprinids).

M: Needs a substrate of sand or gravel: plant the edges with coldwater species; preserve sufficient swimming space; provide good aeration for the aquarium. Water: hardness of 10°-20° dGH; pH 7.0-7.5.

B: Probably aquarium.

has not been

bred

in an

T: 10°-20°C (coldwater fish), L: 14. cm, A: 80 cm, R: t, m, D: 2

170

1923)

(KESSLER,

1874);

Carp-Like Fishes

ESS

ears. As

Cee

Acanthalburnus

microlepis

‘i

Alburnoides

y

"

NY Retr

oblongus

171

Carps

Fam.: Cyprinidae Continuation of Abramis brama (p. 169): F: O; live foods of all kinds: benthic insect larvae (particularly chironomid larvae), small crustacea, molluscs, and worms. Flake and tablet foods are also eaten.

cyprinid region = barb region). The bronze bream has a protrusile mouth. When searching for food, the fish plunges its mouth into the substrate, forming “bream holes.”

S: A. brama is the main fish of the metapotamons (= the lower courses of the

Is IOA2 4°C (coldwater fish), L: up to 75 cm, A: from 100 cm, R: b, m, D: 1-2

A scenic oven river. Habitat of bleaks, breams, pikes, etc.

Continuation of Alburnus alburnus

(p. 173): S: The scales of A/burnus alburnus are used to produce artificial pearls (Essence d'Orient). T: 10°-20°C (coldwater fish), L: 25 cm, A: 100 cm, R: t, D: 2

172

Carp-Like Fishes Fam.: Cyprinidae

Carps

Subfam.: Leuciscinae

Alburnus

alburnus

Alburnus alburnus Bleak Syn.: Cyprinus alburnus, dus, A. lucidus

var.

(LINNAEUS, Alburnus luci-

lacustris.

Hab.: Europe: north of the Pyrenees and Alps to the Urals; England, southeast Norway, Sweden, and Finland. Not. found in Ireland or Scotland. Inhabits slow-flowing, static waters. F.I.: Native species. Sex.: Outside of the spawning season, difficult to distinguish. ¢ d have numerous white knots on their head and body (nuptial tubercles) during the spawning season. ? 9 are fuller at that time. Soc. B.: Surface-oriented, lively, amiable schooling fish. Very skittish about shadows thrown from above. M: Offer the largest aquarium possible, a substrate of fine sand, and edge and background vegetation predominately of fine-leaved species (e.g., Myriophyllum).

1758)

Sufficient free swimming space is very important for these active fish. Water should be clear, clean, and well-aerated

with a hardness of about 10° dGH and a pH of 7.0. Associate with coldwater fishes that have similar lifestyles (such as Alburnoides bipunctatus). B: 20°-22°C: possible in aquaria. In nature, the animals spawn from April to June. They form large schools and migrate upriver. Spawning occurs among stones or on twigs that extend into the water. Egg development takes 1 week. Fry feed on zooplankton and grow rapidly. The animals are sexually mature at 2 years of age. F: C, O; in insects and crustacea, Flake foods

nature the animals feed on their larvae, plankton (small glassworms), and worms. are also accepted.

Continued on p. 172.

173

Carps

Fam.: Cyprinidae Alburnus charusini hohenackeri Transcaucasian bleak Syn.: Alburnus hohenackeri, A. alburnus hohenackeri. Hab.: Asia: former Soviet Union, in the Kura and Draks Basins and the rivers of

the Lenkoran region. F.I.: Has not been imported to Germany. Sex.: Outside the spawning season, the sexes cannot be distinguished. During the spawning season, 33d have nuptial tubercles and °° are fuller due to the

KESSLER, 1877 Subfam.: Leuciscinae F: C; in their natural biotope, they feed on organisms that fall onto the water surface, all kinds of insects and insect larvae, and Daphnia. S: The nominate form, A. c. charusini HERZENSTEIN, 1889, inhabits Lake Kamusch-Samarskije between the Volga and the Ural Rivers and the Terek, Sulak, Dagestan, and Kuban Rivers.

eggs. Soc. B.: Active, peaceful, ented schooling fish.

surface-ori-

M: As indicated for Alburnus alburnus.

B: Has not been bred in an aquarium. Likewise, its spawning biology in nature is virtually unknown. T: 10°-20°C (coldwater fish), L: 12 cm, A: 80 cm, R: t, m, D: 2-3

Alburnoides bipunctatus fasciatus Striped tailorfish Syn.: Aspius fasciatus, Alburnus maculatus. Hab.: Asia: former Soviet Union, at the Crimea and the western Caucasus Mountains.

F.l.: Has many.

not been

imported

into Ger-

Sex.:

2 2 are heavier-bodied than

Soc.

B.:

A surface-oriented,

3.

(NORDMANN,

S: There are a number of subspecies of the nominate form A. 6. bipunctatus (BLOCH, 1782). Classification of all the subspecies is under discussion by many ichthyologists.

active

schooling fish. M: A substrate of fine sand, coldwater plants along the edge and background, and plenty of swimming space represent agreeable maintenance conditions. Provide good aeration, since A. b. fasciatus requires a lot of oxygen. This fish can be associated with other coldwater species that have similar requirements. B: To the best of our knowledge, this fish has not been bred in an aquarium. T: 10°-20°C (coldwater fish), L: 12.5 cm, A: 80 cm, R: t, m, D: 2-3

174

1940)

Subfam.: Abraminae F: C, O; flake foods and small live foods such as planktonic organisms, insects, and mosquito larvae.

Carp-Like Fishes

ee 2 All Alburnoides bipunctatus

as fasciatus

Carps

Fam.: Cyprinidae Subfam.: Leuciscinae

Aristichthys nobilis p. 226 Aspius aspius aspius Asp Syn.: Cyprinus aspius, Aspius rapax, CyPrinus rapax. Hab.: Central Europe and west Asia: prefers the barb region of flowing waters, but found in large lakes as well. Sex.: dd have nuptial tubercles. Soc. B.: Social fish when young. Older specimens are territorial predators that lead a solitary lifestyle. M: Place the tank in a cool local so the aquarium’s temperature always stays below 20°C, even during the summer. Decorate with roots, stones, and reeds. Background vegetation is possible, but maintain plenty of swimming space. Good filtration, aeration, and regular water exchanges are needed. Generally, only juveniles are suitable aquarium specimens.

(LINNAEUS, 1758) substrate. Fish living in lakes or bays migrate into tributaries to spawn. Courtship is intense. The eggs sink to the bottom and adhere to stones. Large ° ? can lay up to 100,000 eggs. They hatch in 10-16 days at 8° to 12°C. Hatching larvae hide among stones; later they migrate

upriver.

Four

to five years

are

needed before the animals are sexually mature. F: C; all kinds of live foods. Adults almost exclusively feed on small fishes. Amphibians and young water birds are also eaten. S: Due to man altering the water courses and the accompanying decline in the populations of tailorfish, bleaks, and other small fishes, A. aspius, which depends on these fishes as a source of nourishment, has become scarce.

B: A. aspius spawn from April to June in swiftly flowing creeks having a gravel

T: 4°-20°C, L: 100 (55) cm, A: from 120 cm, R:m, t, D2

Aspius aspius taeniatus

Caspian asp Syn.: Cyprinus taeniatus, Aspius erythrostomus, A. transcaucasicus. Hab.: Asia: former Soviet Union, the southern section of the Caspian Sea and the Kura and Araks Rivers. Occasionally found at the mouth of the Volga and Terek Rivers.

F.1.: Has not been imported. Sex.: ¢ 3 have dermal knots (nuptial tubercles) during the spawning season. Soc. B.: A predatory cyprinid. Juveniles live in schools, while larger specimens become progressively more solitary. M: As indicated for Leuciscus cephalus. Perhaps sea salt should be added (brackish water). B: Has not been bred in an aquarium. In its natural biotope, A. a. taeniatus be-

(EICHWALD,

gins to migrate into rivers in the autumn. Once there, it proceeds far upriver. Spawning occurs from March to April in fast-flowing river segments over stone bottoms at temperatures of 4.5° to 15°C. The number of eggs fluctuates between 58,000 and 483,000. At 12°C, egg development takes 11 days. In July and August, the 5-10 cm long juveniles migrate to the sea. F: C; all kinds of live foods. Juveniles feed on planktonic and benthic organisms. Older specimens almost exclusively eat fishes.

S: This fish is of great economic importance in the southern waters of the former Soviet Union where it is an important food fish.

T: 10°-20°C (coldwater fish), L: 77 cm, A: from 120 cm, R: m, t, D: 2-3

176

1831)

Carp-Like Fishes

177

Fam.: Cyprinidae

Barbus semifasciolatus, SSR,

Barbus

178



Carps

see Vol. 1, p. 399

=

sp. cf. bimaculatus

from west Africa

Carp-Like Fishes Fam.: Cyprinidae

Carps

Subfam.: Cyprininae

Barbodes altus

Barbodées altus Tall barb Syn.: Puntius altus,

(GUNTHER, 1863) bocourti,

F: O; peaceful omnivores. Live foods of all types, dry commercial foods

Laos, Cambodia,

S: Not particularly attractive. To date, this fish has only been imported to central Europe as by-catch.

Barbus

Barbus altus Hab.: Asia: Thailand, Vietnam.

F.I.: Ca. 1980 as by-catch.

Sex.:

Unknown.

2

are significantly

fuller during the spawning season.

Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish M: Undemanding, congenial charges. No special demands are placed on water composition. However, maintain in large aquaria to provide sufficient swimming space. The species does not burrow, and according to current experiences, it does not bother water plants. B: Has not been breed. eee

= 2/720 Neel

oromaANe HOOlChieraiin, Dy Drie

9

Fam.:

Cyprinidae

Subfam.: Cyprininae

Barbus

sp.

p. 182 180

Carp-Like Fishes

Fam.: Cyprinidae

Carps

Subfam.: Cyprininae

Barbus amphigramma

BOULENGER,

1903

Syn.: Barbus thikensis, B. longicauda (partially), B, macropristis meruensis, B. helleri.

their entire body and have little color or design; B. amphigramma from clear waters have more contrasting colors.

Hab.: East Africa: Kenya, Uganda, Tanzania.

B: Has probably not been achieved in an aquarium. But since this species has little aesthetic appeal, there is little demand, which makes an attempt at breeding a rather uninteresting proposition. Those who desire to maintain these fish will probably have to either import the fish themselves or wait for an opportune by-catch.

F.1.: Unknown.

Sex.: 66 are slimmer.

2 2 have a nota-

bly fuller anterior body. Soc. B.: Active, amiable fish which prefers to school. Some water holes may contain hundreds of B. amphigramma.

M: Care is totally unproblematic, even in community aquaria as long as overly aggressive fishes are excluded. The aquarium should be well-planted, espe-

F: C; live foods of all types as well as frozen, dry, and flake foods.

cially around the edges. Maintain plenty of free swimming space. In nature, B. amphigramma is frequently found in plant-free water holes, along shores of drying bodies of water, and in muddy waters. When found in the latter, the fish are usually a yellowish silver color over T: 19°-26°C, L: 7.5 cm, A: 80 cm, R: m, t, D: 2

181

Carps

Fam.: Cyprinidae Subfam.: Cyprininae

BOULENGER,

Barbus apleurogramma

1911

lumination is not appreciated, so cut light penetration with floating plants; its colors are more pronounced during twilight hours. Cover the tank well. Water: hardness up to 12° dGH; pH 6.0-6.5.

Syn.: Agrammobarbus babaulti, Barbus aphantogramma, B. babaulti, B. lapsus, B. mohasiensis, B. rufua, B. scheemanni, B. zanzibariensis var, paucior.

Hab.: Africa: Uganda, widely distributed in Lakes Victoria and Edward; Rwanda and Burundi, in Lakes Kivu and Mohasi; Tanzania.

B: To the best of our knowledge, this species has not been bred in captivity. Breeding is probably similar to other Af-

F.1.: Not known.

rican barbs.

Sex.:

None

known.

22

are

F: O; small live, frozen, and flake foods.

probably

S: B. apleurogramma lateral line.

fuller during the spawning season.

Soc.

B.: Active,

extremely

peaceful

does not have a

schooling fish. M: Dark substrate (e.g., Lavatit). The aquarium does not necessarily have to be very large or very deep. Always keep a school of at least 6-8 specimens. Plant Anubias and Crinum species. Bright ilT: 28°-26°C, L:5 cm, A: 60 cm, R: m, b, D2

Puntius asoka

Syn.: Barbus asoka. “Barbus kuda” is a trade name. Hab.: Asia: Sri Lanka.

(KOTTELAT & PETHIYAGODA,

F: O; live and flake foods of all kinds as well as vegetable fare (lettuce, spinach, etc.).

E:lis 1976r

Sex.: No external differentiating characteristics. Soc. B.: Usually lives in small groups. Scuffles may occasionally occur, but they are generally not injurious (most likely only 3 fight). M: Offer an aquarium that has swimming space and secluded areas among roots and plant groups. No particular water chemistry requirements have to be met: hardness 1°-18° dGH; pH 6.5-

KS)

;

B: Probably has not been successfully bred in a captive environment. Tx25°=30°C; Le 15cm, A: 100.cm= Raby mDse=s

182

1989)

Carp-Like Fishes

Puntius

asoka

~

Carps

Fam.: Cyprinidae Subfam.: Cyprininae

DAGET,

Barbus atakorensis Syn.: None. Hab.: Africa: Ghana, coastal rivers; north Benin, Oti River; Nigeria, Ogun and Kaduna Rivers.

1957

F: O: small live and frozen foods as well as freeze-dried and flake foods. S: None.

F.1.: Not known.

Sex.: No external distinguishing features. Soc. B.: Very peaceful, active schooling fish. M: As indicated for Barbus apleurogramma, but this species likes very soft, moderately acid water (2°-6° dGH and pH 5.5-6.0, respectively). Due to their diminutive size, caution must be observed when adding it to community tanks. B: There is no information available concerning breeding this barb. T: 22°-25°C, L:

4cm, A: 60 cm, R: m, b, D: 2-3

Barbus candens Red three-spot barb Syn.: None. Hab.: Africa: Zaire, in the central Zaire

River and the Lualaba River System. F.I.: 1986. Sex.: d ¢ are slimmer, somewhat larger, and more intensely colored (especially the fins).

NICHOLS & GRISCOM, 1917 25°C, the young hatch after about days. Not a prolific species.

F: O; all kinds of very small live foods as well as frozen and flake foods. S: See B.

Soc. B.: An active, very amiable schooling fish. M: As indicated for Barbus amphigramma, but a soft substrate should be offered (e.g., peat or fine sand). A species tank is optimal. B: Reproductive behavior deviates from most Barbus species in that the eggs are laid on’a soft substrate. To meet these needs, place several centimeters of peat along the bottom. The water should be very soft and acid (1°-2° dGH and pH 5.0-6.0, respectively). The pairs dig into the peat while spawning. At T: 24°-26°C, L: barely 4.cm, A: 50 cm, R: b, m, D: 2-3

184

6

Carp-Like Fishes

Barbus

candens

~

Carps

Fam.: Cyprinidae Subfam.: Cyprininae

BOULENGER,

Barbus caudovittatus

Striped tail barb Syn.: Barbus chilotes sakaniae, B. euchilus, B. lestradei, B. miochilus, B. pojeri, Varicorhinus

stappersii.

Hab.: Africa: in the basins of the Zaire and Luapula Rivers and some tributaries of Lake Tanganyika. F.|.: Not known.

Sex.: No definite external differences known. 2° are probably fuller during the spawning season.

1902

B: Has not been achieved in an aquarium. Probably impossible in normal aquaria because of its size. F: O; all kinds of large live, frozen, freezedried, vegetable, flake, and tablet foods. S: Without exception, B. caudovittatus has a pharyngeal dentition of 2.3.5-5.3.2. The species has a characteristic dark band on the upper and lower lobe of the tail fin (species name)).

Soc. B.: Active schooling fish. Older animals may become aggressive. M: Offer B. caudovittatus a roomy tank with a sandy bottom and plenty of robust vegetation, but preserve ample swimming space. Water: hardness up

to 15° dGH; pH around neutral (pH 6.5-

7.5).

T: 24°-27°C,

L: 80 cm, A: from 120 cm, R: m, b, D: 2

(HAMILTON, 1822)

Barbus chola Cola barb

Syn.: Cyprinus

chola,

Capoeta

chola,

Puntius chola, P. perlee, Systomus chola, S. immaculatus.

Hab.: Asia: India, from Malabar through Orissa, Punjab, Bengal to Assam; Bangladesh; Burma. Inhabits creeks, rivers, and static bodies of water.

F.1.: 1904 by H. STUVE, Hamburg. Sex.: dd are slimmer and have reddish fins at spawning time; ° 2 are fuller, and their fins are yellowish during the spawning season.

Soc. B.: Peaceful, active schooling fish. M: Needs a dark substrate, dense vegetation around the edges, floating plants to-dim the light, and plenty of swimming space. Cover the tank well, since the animals are excellent jumpers. No particular demands are placed on water chemistry; however, regular water exchanges should be performed (every 2 T: 20°-25°C,

186

weeks '/, to '/3 of the tank's volume). Excellent fish for a community tank. B: 23°-25°C; reproduction is possible in tanks as small as 30 |. One ¢ and two 22 is the best combination. Water: 8°15° dGH; pH 6.0-6.5. Since all Barbus consider their eggs a delicacy, the substrate should consist of coarse gravel or a plastic grid should be placed over the substrate that allows the eggs to fall through and escape being devoured. Spawning is preceded by elaborate courtship. Several hundred eggs are adhered to water plants. It is best to remove the parents after they have spawned. Juveniles hatch in 30-48 hr, depending on water temperature,

F: O; live, frozen, freeze-dried, and vegetable foods.

S: In some regions of Burma, these fish are used spawning

L: 15 cm, A: 90 cm, R: m, b, D: 1-2

as a source condition.

of oil while

in

Carp-Like Fishes

Barbus

Fam.: Cyprinidae bfam.: Cyprininae

Barbus

188

eburneensis

Carp-Like Fishes Fam.: Cyprinidae

Carps

Subfam.: Cyprininae

Barbus

eburneensis

POLL, 1941

Barbus eburneensis Syn.: Barbus camptacanthus, B. flomoi, B. trispilus, B. trispilus var. quinquepunctata.

Hab.: Africa: coastal rivers from Guinea to the western Ivory Coast.

about the height of the to the variable design, also been described as sometimes still traded onym.

lateral line. the species B. trispilus. under that

Due has It is syn-

F.1.: Unknown. Sex.: No definite external differences are known to date. Soc. B.: Agile, peaceful schooling fish.

M: As indicated for Barbus amphigramma, but water values vary slightly: 3°-

8° dGH; pH ca. 5.5. Suitable for community tanks. B: No known breeding successes. F: O: live, frozen, freeze-dried, flake, and tablet foods. S: B. eburneensis has three to five small black spots on each side of its body at T: 22°-25°C, L: 9 cm, A: 80 cm, R: m, b, D: 2-3

189

~

Carps

Fam.: Cyprinidae Subfam.: Cyprininae

KOTTELAT,

Barbus foerschi Forsch’s barb Syn.: None.

Hab.: Southeast Asia: Indonesia (Kalimantan = Borneo), in the Mentaya Basin. F.1.: 1978 by Edith KORTHAUS.

1982

F: O; all types of live foods as well as frozen, freeze-dried, and flake foods. S: B. foerschi has a complete lateral line with 24 perforated scales.

Sex.: No indisputable external differences are known. Usually @ 2 are fuller and slightly deeper-bodied.

Soc. B.: Active, peaceful schooling fish. Always keep between 6-8 specimens. Individuals are shy and skittish. M: Provide a dark substrate (Lavatit), dense vegetation around the edges, and plenty of swimming space. Offer some hiding places (e.g., roots). Water: hardness up to 10° dGH; pH 6.0-6.5.

B: No known breeding successes. T: 24°-28°C, L: 6 cm, A: 60 cm, R: m, b, D: 2

Barbus guirali

THOMINOT,

Syn.: Barbus camptacanthus nipterus, B. melanipterus. Hab.: Africa: Gabon.

southern

var. mela-

Cameroon

and

F.1.: Unknown.

Sex.: No known distinguishing features. Soc. B.: Active, nonaggressive ing fish.

school-

M: Similar to that of Barbus amphigramma a Barbus apleurogramma, but the water can be even softer and more acid (pH 5.5-6.0). B: Has probably never been bred in an aquarium. F: OQ; all types of live foods as well as frozen, tablet, and flake foods.

S: The tip of the dorsal fin is either black or dark (see photo). T: 22°-26°C, L: 17 cm, A: 100 cm, R: m, b, D: 2-3

190

1886

Carp-Like Fishes

Barbus

foe

Barbus

guirali

~

Carps

Fam.: Cyprinidae Subfam.: Cyprininae

PETER,

Barbus kerstenii kerstenii Kersten’s barb Syn.: Barbus akeleyi, B. lumiensis, B. minchinii, B. mohasiensis var. Ppaucisquamata, B. nigrolineata, B. zanzibaricus Var. Paucior. Hab.: Africa: Kenya, in rivers and lakes; Uganda, in the basins of Lakes Edward and Victoria; Tanzania, Lake Tanganyika; Rwanda, Lake Kivu. F.I.: Probably in 1925 as Barbus usambarae. Sex.: No definite differences are known. 2 @ are fuller during the spawning season.

1868

B: To date, there are no reports concerning successfully spawning this species in an aquarium. F: O; all kinds of live foods as well as frozen, freeze-dried, flake, and tablet foods.

S: Besides the nominate form presented here, the subspecies B. k. /uhondo PAPPENHEIM & BOULENGER, 1914, known only from Lake Luhondo in northwestern Rwanda, has also been described.

Soc. B.: Very agile, peaceful schooling fish.

M: As stated for Barbus apleurogramma (p. 182). Water hardness: up to 18° dGH; pH 6.5-7.5. Suitable fish for community aquaria. T: 23°-26°C, L: 9 cm, A: 80 cm, R: m, b,

BOULENGER,

Barbus miolepis miolepis Reticulated barb Syn.: Barbus decioi, B. nicholsi, B. squamosissimus,

B. treadwelli.

Hab.: Africa: in the Zaire River basin, but not in the Luapula River or Lake Moero.

1902

jumping out of the water. B. miolepis does not seem to be very fertile. Feed juveniles newly hatched Artemia nauplii. F: O; all types of live foods as well as frozen, tablet, and flake foods.

F.I.: In 1970 a few specimens were imported into former East Germany.

S: Besides this nominate form, there is also the subspecies B. m. rubrostigma

Sex.: Difficult to differentiate. 29 area lighter color. The first ray of the 36's dorsal fin seems to always be dark (see photo).

POLL & LAMBERT, 1964. That subspecies inhabits coastal rivers of southern Cameroon to Zaire and, with a total length of 83 mm, is somewhat smaller than the subspecies presented here.

Soc. B.: Very agile, peaceful schooling fish. M: Follow recommendations given for Barbus apleurogramma. Since the animals are accomplished jumpers, cover the tank. Shady, darkened areas, which should be provided, are eagerly sought by the animals.

B: 36 strongly pursue 22. Unripe 2° escape the d's intense courtship by T: 24°-28°C, L: 11 cm, A: 80 cm, R: m, b, D: 2

192

Carp-Like Fishes

§

Barbus

kerstenii kerstenii

Barbus miolepis miolepis

—~

Carps

Fam.: Cyprinidae Subfam.: Cyprininae

FISCHER, 1884

Barbus neumayeri Neumayer’s barb Syn.: Barbus carpio, B. luazomela, B. nairobiensis, B. percivali, B. percivali var. kitalensis, B. portali, B. serrifer. Hab.: Africa: widely distributed in the eastern African countries of Kenya and Uganda. Also found in Lakes Tanganyika and Basuto. F.1.: Unknown. Sex.: No definite sexual differences are

known. During the spawning season, 2 2 are fuller.

Soc. B.: Nonaggressive, active schooling fish. M: As stated for Barbus apleurogramma. B: No reported successes.

F: O; all types of live foods as well as frozen, freeze-dried, tablet, and flake foods. S: None. Ti: 238°=27°G, I: 12cm, Az 80 om, Rom) by; DE2=3

FOWLER, 1934

Barbus partipentazona Partially banded barb Syn.: Barbus sumatranus (not BLEEKER), Puntius partipentazona, P. sumatranus (not BLEEKER).

Hab.: Asia: Thailand, Laos, Cambodia, Westmalaysia. F.1.: 1933 by the company O. WINKELMANN, Altona, Germany.

Sex.:

dd are slimmer, whereas 2 @ are

more compact and deeper-bodied.

Soc. B.: This schooling fish may occasionally turn aggressive

towards

small

fishes. Peaceful towards equal- or largersized fishes. B. partipentazona may nip the tips of elongated fins. M: Requires

plenty of free swimming

space as well as hiding places among roots and plants.

B: Has been successfully bred at 23°— 25°C in medium-hard (12° dGH), neutral to slightly acid water. Does not seem to have a preference about what time of

the day to spawn. Fine-leaved plants such as Myriophyllum and Nitella are an important part of the breeding tank's furnishings. ¢ 3 strongly pursue 2 2 and entice them into the plant thickets. The fish press against each other, and the @ releases several eggs which adhere to the plants. In total, up to 500 eggs are laid. The larvae hatch after about 30 hr and are free-swimming after 6 days. Feed them plankton. The parents have to be removed following spawning, before they eagerly consume the spawn.

F: O; all kinds of live and flake foods. Not a finicky eater. S: Imported in 1933 as B. “sumatranus,” which today is the Sumatra barb, Barbus tetrazona. |n 1935, after the “real” Sumatra barb was imported, the error was discovered.

Ti 22°=25°@) ee 4S .cmi, Ay GOlcms Really Danie

194

Carp-Like Fishes

Barbus

partipentazona

Fam.: Cyprinidae Subfam.: Cyprininae

Barbus binotatus, spotted barb

Barbus

196

sp. “Ethiopia”

Carp-Like Fishes

Bandulla

barb,

Barbus bandula

3

Bandulla barb,

Barbus bandula

°

Py:

~

Carps

Fam.: Cyprinidae Subfam.: Cyprininae

KESSLER, 1877

Barbus plebejus tauricus Crimea barb Syn.: Barbus tauricus. Hab.: Europe: former Soviet Union, the freshwaters of the Crimea.

in

F.I.: Probably has not been imported into Germany. Sex.: dd have nuptial tubercles during the spawning season; @ 2 are fuller during the spawning season.

Soc. B.: Sedentary, twilight-active schooling fish. Peaceful. M: B. p. tauricus should be given a sub-

B: To the best of our knowledge, the Crimea barb has not been bred in cap-

tivity. Spawning behavior similar to that of Barbus Vol. 2, p. 364).

in nature is barbus (see

F: O; all types of live foods as well as frozen, freeze-dried, plant, flake, or tablet foods. S: The nominate species, B. p. plebejus VALENCIENNES, 1842, is distributed in the Balkan region. There are several subspecies.

strate of sand or fine-grained gravel, a few refuges among rocks and/or roots, free swimming space, and coldwater plants along the tank’s fringes. Water should be medium-hard (12°-15° dGH) and neutral to slightly alkaline (pH 7.07.5). Always

keep several

specimens.

T: 10°-22°C (coldwater fish), L: 34 cm, A: 100 cm, R: b, D: 2

(HAMILTON, 1822)

Oreichthys cosuatis Syn.: Cyprinus cosuatis, Barbus cosuatis, Leuciscus cosuatis, Oreichthys parvus, Rohtee pangut, Systomus malacopterus.

Hab.: Asia: Pakistan, India, Bangladesh, Burma, and Thailand. F.1.: Unknown.

B: Not very difficult. If possible, the water should be soft, not above 8°-10° (5°) dGH, with a slightly acid pH of around 6. Dense vegetation and a spawning screen on the bottom are needed because the breeders are sometimes pre-

dacious

towards

their eggs.

Feed

the

Sex.: No definite differences known. 2 2 are fuller during the spawning season

parents well and remove them after spawning. The smallest plankton is needed to rear the fry.

Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish. Associate with nonaggressive fishes.

F: O; all kinds of small live foods and flake, frozen, and freeze-dried foods.

M: Caring for this fish is not difficult; even small aquaria are suitable. Use a dark substrate and plant the edges and background heavily. Always keep a small school. Water: pH 6.0-6.5; hardness up to 15° dGH; sometimes peat filtration is advisable. Ti: 24°=28°C; Lz 75cm, Av 60 cms Rall, Dal=2

198

Carp-Like Fishes

Oreichthys

cf. cosuatis

Carps

Fam.: Cyprinidae Subfam.: Cyprininae

Discherodontus

halei

Discherodontus halei Somphong barb Syn.: Barbus somphongsi, Puntius halei. Hab.: Asia: Thailand, in the Mekong River and its flood plains, including surrounding rice fields; Malay peninsula. F.l.: 1958 by BENL through phong Aquarium, Bangkok.

the Som-

Sex.: 2 2 are fuller during the spawning

season, Soc. B.: This peaceful schooling fish is hectic and often shy.

M: Aquarium with free swimming space and refuges among roots or dense vegetation. B:-There is no information available concerning successfully breeding this species in a captive environment. F: O; all kinds of animal and plant fare as well as flake foods commiserate to its size. Ti: 28°=26°C, L: 10.5 em, A: 80cm) Re all, Dr 2

200

(DUNCKER,

1904)

Carp-Like Fishes Fam.: Cyprinidae

Carps

Subfam.: Abraminae

=

ge

Blicca bjoerkna

(LINNAEUS, 1758)

Blicca bjoerkna Silver bream Syn.: Cyprinus bjoerkna, Abramis blicca, Blicca argyroleuca, B. laskyr, Cyprinus blicea, C. gibbosus, C. laskyr.

Hab.: Central Europe to western Asia. Most successful when it colonizes small, shallow lakes, where it usually remains near the shore close to the bottom among plant growth. In rivers, it prefers the bream region to brackish water. F.1.: European species.

Sex.: 66 acquire nuptial tubercles; grow significantly larger.

2 2

Soc. B.: Peaceful, benthic schooling fish. Found in large schools during the spawning season. Winter months are spent hibernating singly. M: Tall roomy tanks are best. Use fine sand as substrate and some bogwood and a few rocks as decoration. Keep in mind that dense vegetation is neces-

sary. Water chemistry is not of foremost importance. B: In its native habitat, this species spawns from May to June. During the spawning season, these animals school. Amidst much splashing, the yellowish eggs are released at night along shallow, vegetated shores. The hatching larvae remain along the shores. This species grows slowly, attaining sexual maturity at a length of 10-12 cm (3 to 5 years of age). F: O; all types of live foods such as plankton, small crustacea, insects and their larvae, and molluscs. Flake and tablet foods. S: Silver bream are very similar to bream. They are unwanted by-catches in fishermen’s nets, since their meat, as opposed to that of the bream, is not appreciated.

T: 4°-20°C, L: 25 (35) cm, A: 80 cm, R: all, D: 1

201

iio

Carps

Fam.: Cyprinidae Subfam.: Cyprininae

(VALENCIENNES,

Capoeta damascina

1842)

Syn.: Scaphiodon fratercula, S. peregrinorum, S. socialis, Chondrostoma syriacum, Capoeta syrica. Hab.: Eastern Europe and western Asia: Levante and Mesopotamia. F.1.: Unknown. Sex.: Unknown.

Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish. M: Needs a large tank with plenty of plants, yet sufficient free swimming space. B: Has not been bred in an aquarium. F: O; plant fare and flake foods. S: Most common species found in the waters of the Levante and Mesopotamia regions. Morphologically variable. T: 15°-26°C, L: 40 cm, A: from 150 cm, R: b, m, D: 3

(KESSLER, 1872)

Capoetobrama kuschakewitschi Syn.: Acanthobrama kuschakewitschi, A. bogdanovi. Hab.: Asia: former Soviet Union, rivers of the Aral Sea region (Syr-Darya, AmuDarya), Lake Karakul, and the Zeravshan River. F.I.: Has not been imported into Germany. Sex.: None known (7); bust (note the photo).

2 are more

ro-

Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish. M: As for Abramis brama. C. kuschakewitschi can be housed with European species (Abramis brama, Chondrostoma nasus,

Vimba

F: O; in nature, this species feeds on detritus and mud and its associated microbes.

S: The primary difference between

kewitschi (KESSLER, 1872) and C. k. orientalis NIKOLSKI, 1934, from the river Chu.

vimba, etc.).

B: Information on breeding coulda not be found in western aquarium magazines. In nature, the species spawns from midApril to the end of June. On average, a 2 will lay 3,000-4,000 adhesive eggs in regions having a sluggish current. T: 16°-20°C, L: 21 cm, A: 100 cm, R: m,t

202

Ca-

poetobrama and related genera lies in the strong unsegmented ray of the dorsal fin. C. kuschakewitschi has a very long (ca. 4x the body length) intestine. The genus Capoetobrama is monotypic—that is, it only contains one species which is further divided into 2 subspecies: the nominate form C. k. kuscha-

D: 2-3

Carp-Like Fishes

Capoetobrama

kuschakewitschi

Carps

Fam.: Cyprinidae Subfam.: Cyprininae



N

FESS

Carassius auratus gibelio

(BLOCH, 1783)

Carassius auratus gibelio Prussian carp Syn.: Syprinus gibelio, Carassius gibelio,

weekly water exchanges ('/, of the tank's

C. vulgaris var.

volume).

kolenty.

Hab.: Originally distributed from eastern Asia to Siberia. Today, this species is found in eastern, central, and northern Europe. F.I.: Cannot be determined.

Sex.: No definite external differences are known. 2? 2 are fuller during the spawning season. Soc. B.: Relatively sedate and peaceful cyprinids. M: Provide a substrate of sand, and plant the tank with hardy coldwater species.

Do not use fine-leaved plants. The fine sediments the fish constantly stir up will prove detrimental to these plants. Decorations should include roots, bamboo, reeds, and round rocks. The animals prefer clear, medium-hard, slightly alkaline water (hardness around 12° dGH and pH 7.1-7.5, respectively). Perform

B: Though this would be an interesting fish to breed, it has not been bred in captivity. Once accomplished, we would then know whether or not this species needs 3 of its own species to breed. According to observations in nature, 2 ° of this species are part of spawning schools of related species and spawn with 3 in this school. All offspring are said to be 2°.

F: O; all types of live foods as well as plant, flake, and tablet foods. S: Parthenogenetic (asexual) reproduction is a unique (?) characteristic of this fish. 63 of other species (Cyprinus carpio, Carassius carassius) are used as spawning partners for this species. Fertilization in the traditional sense does not take place. Egg “fertilization” merely triggers egg development.

T: 10°-20°C (coldwater fish), L: up to 45 cm, A: 100 cm, R: m, b, D: 1

204

Carp-Like Fishes Fam.: Cyprinidae

Carps

Subfam.: Abraminae

i

Chelaethiops

rukwaensis

9

(RICARDO, 1939)

Chelaethiops rukwaensis Syn.: Engraulicypris congicus rukwaenSis. Hab.: Africa: Tanzania, endemic to Lake Rukwa.

S: Besides C. rukwaensis, there are five additional Chelaethiops species.

F.I.: 1987 by KILIAN and SEEGERS. Sex.: 22 are significantly fuller during the spawning season.

Soc. B.: A peaceful schooling fish that prefers the upper water column.

M: No information is available concerning captive maintenance. The water of Lake Rukwa is very turbid and muddy with an average pH of 8.5 and a high concentration of sodium.

B: To the best of our knowledge,

this

fish has not been bred in an aquarium. There is no information available.

F: C; all kinds of small live foods, including floating insects. T: 24°-28°C,

L:

8cm, A: 80 cm, R: t, m, D: 2

205

Carps

Fam.: Cyprinidae Subfam.: Cyprininae

Cyclocheilichthys janthochir

(BLEEKER, 1853)

Cyclocheilichthys janthochir Pretty-finned river barb Syn.: Systomus janthochir, thochir. Hab.: Southeast Asia: mantan (Borneo).

Barbus jan-

Indonesia,

Kali-

F.1.: Unknown.

B: Has not been aquarium.

S: None.

Soc. B.: Peaceful species.

M: C. janthochir is a relatively adaptive species which places no particular demands on water composition, yet soft, slightly acid water (hardness around 5°

dGH and pH 6.0-6.5, respectively) should prove to be the most favorable, since these values correspond to those of its native habitat. Follow recommendations made for other Cyclocheilichthys species in regard to the aquarium’s fur-

nishings (see Vol. 1, p. 412).

206

in an

F: O; all types of live foods as well as frozen, freeze-dried, and flake foods.

Sex.: Not certain; 22 are probably larger and, at least during the spawning season, more rounded.

T: 24°-26°C,

accomplished

L: over 20 cm, A: 80 cm, R: b, D: 1

Carp-Like Fishes Fam.: Cyprinidae

Carps

Subfam.: Leuciscinae

°c

~~

Erythroculter mongolicus

(BASILOWSKI,

Erythroculter mongolicus Syn.: Culter mongolicus, C. rutilus. Hab.: Asia: Mongolia, former Soviet Union, and China; the Amur (to its mouth), Ussuri, and Sungari Rivers, Lakes Chanka and Hwangthe, the Yangtse Basin, and the Chientang River.

F.I.: Has not been imported into Germany. Sex.: No definite external differentiating characteristics are known. Soc. B.: This lively peaceful schooling fish should be housed with fishes that behave similarly. M: Needs a roomy tank that has densely planted borders. Use sand or finegrained gravel as substrate. Decorate with bogwood, reeds, and roots. Provide good aeration and filtration, Exchange up to '/; of the water weekly.

Water: hardness of 20° dGH;

1855)

pH up to

7.0. B: Has not been successful in an aquarium. The scant information available suggests that spawning occurs in June in Lake Chanka. The resulting eggs are pelagic. F: C; floating foods (insects: caddisflies and mayflies), insect larvae, and zooplankton (small crustacea, etc.); fullgrown animals chiefly feed on small fishes. S: While E. mongolicus is not of great economic importance, its relative, Erythroculter erythropterus, is. In the years prior to WW Il, the annual catch was 270 tons (NIKOLSKI 1957).

T: 10°-20°C, L: up to 60 cm, A: from 150 cm, R: m, b, D: 2-3

207

~

.

Carps

Fam.: Cyprinidae Subfam.: Rasborinae

Esomus longimana Longfin flying barb Syn.: None. Hab.: Asia: Thailand. A common fish, particularly in stagnant waters. F.1.: Unknown.

Sex.: 66 are slender, whereas robust and full.

¢ 2 are

Soc. B.: Lively surface-oriented fish. Peaceful towards conspecifics as well as heterospecifics. Frequently shy and skittish. Good jumpers; therefore, cover the tank well. M: Heavy vegetation, including floating

F: C; primarily floating insects in nature. These should also be provided in captivity. Additionally, it consumes mosquito larvae, large Artemia, Daphnia and, sometimes, flake foods. S: E. longimana is often confused with Esomus danricus, but according to H. M. SMITH, that species cannot be found east of the mountains of Burma.

plants, is favored. Do not house with excessively lively fishes, as this species fairs badly when forced to compete for food! B: Probably similar to Esomus malayensis; see Vol. 2, p. 384. T: 22°-26°C, L: 8.5 cm, A: 90 cm, R: t, m, D: 2

Esomus lineatus Striped flying barb

AHL, 1925

Syn.: Nuria daurica var. malabarica.

F: O. An undemanding omnivore.

Hab.: Asia: India, along the delta of the Ganges.

S: Fluctuations of pH values are not always tolerated. Regular water exchanges are important. Avoid elevated nitrate concentrations.

F.I.: 1911 by P. MATTE, Lankwitz, Germany

Sex.: No sexual dichromatism. Only the 36’s slender body shape is indicative of sex. Soc. B.: Active schooling fish if the aquarium permits. Other fishes are not bothered. Can be housed with much smaller species.

M: Provide space

plenty of free swimming

in the upper third of the aquar-

ium. Refuge is sought under plant leaves when

disturbed; therefore, there should

be plenty of vegetation along the edges. Excellent jumpers. Cover the tank well! B: Probably has been successfully bred in aquaria, but there is no information concerning such in the literature. T: 22°-25°C, L: 6

208

5cm, 2 6 cm, A: 70 cm, R:t, D: 1-2

Carp-Like Fishes

Esomus longimana (?) oder E. metallicus

Esomus

lineatus

Carps

Fam.: Cyprinidae Subfam.: Rasborinae

Esomus

metallicus

$

Esomus metallicus Silvery flying barb, metallic flying barb Syn.: Nuria daurica. Hab.: Asia: Thailand and Laos. Common in its native habitat. F.1.: Unknown.

Sex.: dd are more stouter and taller.

slender;

22

are

Soc. B.: Nonaggressive fish of the upper water column. Occasionally timid, especially in new environments. jumper, so cover the tank well.

A good

M: A section of the tank should be densely planted; floating plants are also necessary. Do not associate with overly lively fishes, since this fish will be unable to successfully compete for food! B: Probably like other Esomus (Vol. 2, p. 384).

species

F: C; primarily feeds on floating insects in its natural biotope. These should be T: 22°-26°C, L: 7.5 cm, A: 80 cm, R:t, D: 2

210

AHL, 1924 provided in captivity. Mosquito larvae, large crustacea, and water fleas as well as flake and frozen foods are also consumed.

Carp-Like Fishes Fam.: Cyprinidae

Carps

Subfam.: Garrinae

BLEEKER,

Garra ceylonensis ceylonensis Ceylon log sucker Syn.: Crossochilus reba. Hab.: Asia: Sri Lanka (Ceylon), in both

RANIYAGALA,

1933,

which

been found in the Gammaduva

1863

has only region.

small and large rivers.

F.I.: Probably only after 1980. Sex.: None known.

Soc. B.: Peaceful fish which constantly explores roots and glass panes in its

search for food (suckermouth). M: Spacious tank decorated with plants, roots, and rocks. Water: pH around 7; hardness up to 15° dGH, but lower values are better. B: Has not been captivity.

successfully

bred

in

F: O; any live or flake foods of appropriate size. S: Besides the nominate form, there is also the subspecies G. c. phillipsi DET: 24°-26°C,

L: 15 cm, A: 100 cm, R: b, D: 2-3

211

Carps

Fam.: Cyprinidae Subfam.: Garrinae

POLL, 1959

Garra congoensis Congo log sucker

B: Has not been bred in an aquarium.

Syn.: None. Hab.: Africa: River.

Zaire,

in the lower Zaire

F.I.: Unknown; the species has probably not been imported into Germany. Sex.: No external differentiating characteristics are known, Soc. B.: Nothing is known about the social behavior of G. Ccongoensis. M: The substrate should either be of sand or fine-grained gravel. Offer refuges among rocks or roots. The edges

F: O; all kinds of live foods as well as frozen, freeze-dried, flake, and vegetable foods.

S: G. congoensis is a typical inhabitant of the rapids of the lower Zaire River (formerly the Congo River).

and back of the aquarium can be planted. Aerate the water well; perhaps water movement would be advantageous. The water should be mediumhard and slightly acid (hardness up to 15° dGH and pH 6.5, respectively). T: 23°-25°C, L: 10 cm, A: 80 cm, R: b, D: 2-3

(RUPPELL, 1836)

Garra dembeensis Cameroon log sucker Syn.: Chondrostoma dembeensis, Discognathus blanfordii, D. chiarinii, D. dembeensis, D. giarrabensis, D. hindii, D. johnstonii, D. quadrimaculatus, D. vinciguerrae, Garra giarrabensis, G. hindii, G. johnstonii, G. vinciguerrae.

F: H, O; commercial dry foods are readily accepted. Algae are grazed. Insect larvae and similar foods are also eaten.

Hab.: Africa: from east Africa to Cameroon, in flowing waters. F.1.: Not known. Sex.: dé have orange-tipped fins. Soc. B.: Most at ease when a group is kept. Other fishes are ignored.

M: Adaptable species. Although these fish are found in flowing, even turbulent, waters in their natural habitat, in the aquarium they can be seen resting on a leaf over long periods of time. They are much less restless than Crossocheilus (previously Epalzeorhynchus) species which live in similar habitats. B: Has not been bred in an aquarium. T: 22°-26°C, L: 11 cm, A: from 50 cm, R: b, m, D: 2-3

212

Carp-Like Fishes

Garra congoensis

PORE Bee At

Garra

dembeensis

eae

INE

Dy SRO

RE

en

Carps

Fam.: Cyprinidae Subfam.: Garrinae

(Mc CLALLAND, 1839)

Garra nasuta Nose log sucker Syn.: Platycara nasuta. Hab.: South and (Assam), Burma, Vietnam.

southeast Asia: India southern China, and

B: Has not been bred. Pairs are scarce, since the animals have only been imported sporadically as by-catch. F: O; flake and frozen foods.

F.1.: After 1980 as by-catch. Sex.: Unknown. Soc. B.: Little is known about the social behavior of this species. Although they pass their time rasping algae from the glass and the decorations, they are not very effective cleaner fish.

M: This species seems

S: Identification based on the head profile is relatively straightforward (note the species name and the photo).

to have a high

oxygen requirement during its acclimation phase. Insure that the aquarium has strong filtration, current, and a moving water surface. Temperatures should be moderate. After acclimation, the animals are hardy and undemanding. Water: pH 6.5-7.5; hardness 10°-20° dGH. T: 20°-25°C, L: 20 cm, A: 80 cm, R: b, m, D: 2-3

Garra ghorensis Jordanian log sucker Syn.: Garratibanica

ghorensis.

Hab.: Asia: springs in the area around the southern Dead Sea.

F.1.: 1980. Sex.: See Garra rufa. Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish. M: Unknown. Its habitat around the Dead Sea seems to indicate that this species,

as opposed to the log suckers from Thailand and Africa, should be kept in hard saline water. B: As for G. rufa. F: H, O; plant fare and flake foods.

S: This relict species is found in very few springs, around the Dead Sea. T: 25°-28°C,

214

L: 9 cm, A: from 80 cm, R: b, m, D: 2

KRUPP,

1982

Carp-Like Fishes

ghorensis

ie

Fam.: Cyprinidae

Carps

Subfam.: Garrinae

Garra rufa

(HECKEL, 1843)

Reddish log sucker Syn.: Discognathus obtusus, Hab.: Asia: Levante and Mesopotamia.

F.1.: Unknown.

Sex.: dd more

have longer pectoral fins and

pronounced

nuptial tubercles.

Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish. M: Always keep a school. Appoint the tank with fine sand, hiding places, and robust vegetation. Though it will occasionally eat plants, it is otherwise undemanding. B: Open

spawners.

Eggs are immedi-

ately eaten. Raising the fry with plankton is unproblematic. Dense vegetation is

advantageous

(e.g., with Java moss).

F: H, O; plant fare and flake foods. T: 15°-28°C, L: 16 cm, A: from 100 cm, R: m, b, D: 2

216

Carp-Like Fishes Fam.: Cyprinidae

Carps

Subfam.: Gobioninae

BERG,

Gobio gobio soldatovi Soldatov’s gudgeon Syn.: Gobio soldatovi. Hab.: Asia: former Soviet Union and China, in the Ussuri and Sungari Rivers and the Amur Basin upriver from Chabarowsk. Mainly lives in stagnate waters, but also found in slow-moving waters. It does not inhabit mountain streams.

F.I.:; Has not been imported into Germany. Sex.: Sexes are difficult to distinguish. At spawning time, ¢ 3 have cranial nuptial tubercles. Soc. B.: Peaceful, social schooling fish. Can be housed with European species that have similar requirements. M: As for Gobio gobio tungussicus. B: There is no information concerning successfully breeding this species in an aquarium. Although we are largely igno-

1914

length of 46 mm and ? 2 spawn 3 times per spawning season. Between 1,550 and 5,300 eggs are laid on a sandy or rocky bottom. F: C; live foods, especially bloodworms. S: In most Russian fish books, this subspecies is listed as an autonomous species. However, in the newest revision of the subfamily Gobioninae by BANARESCU and NALBANT (1973), this animal was classified as a subspecies.

rant in regard to exact spawning data, it is known that the animals rnature at a

T: 4°-18°C (coldwater fish), L: 12 cm, A: 80 cm, R: b, D: 2

217

~

~

Carps

Fam.: Cyprinidae Subfam.: Gobioninae

BORISOV,

Gobio gobio tungussicus Syn.: Gobio sodatovi tungussicus. Hab.: Asia: former Soviet Union, in the drainage of the Lena and Vitima Rivers (east Siberia) and the upper part of the Amur down to Chaborowsk. F.I.: Has not yet been imported into Germany. Sex.: Sexes are difficult to distinguish; during the spawning season, dd have nuptial tubercles.

Soc. B.: Peaceful, social schooling fish. Can be associated with European species that have similar requirements (e.g., Gobio gobio, Nemacheilus barbatulus, Cobitis taenia). M: Provide a roomy aquarium with coarse sand or gravel as substrate, offer some hiding places among rocks, T: 10°-18°C,

1928

and aerate the tank well. Clear, clean water with a hardness of up to 20° dGH and a pH of 7.0-7.5 is best. B: Has probably not been accomplished in an aquarium. In nature, these animals spawn during the summer. Eggs are laid in shallow water over a sand substrate. F: C; live foods. Primarily feeds on bloodworms in its natural habitat. S: This subspecies almost exclusively lives in static waters. Of the four gudgeons of the genus Gob/o found in this region, this is the most limnophilic. Ac-

cording

to BANARESCU

& NALBANT

(1973), these animals have an average life expectancy of 4 years.

L: 11 cm, A: 80 cm, R: b, D: 2-3

Gobio tenuicorpus White-finned Amur gudgeon

MORI, 1934

Syn.: Gobio albipinnatus taenuicorpus, G. coriparoides tenuicorpus, G. gobio tenuicorpus.

sexual maturity during their third summer. The reproductive biology of this fish is still unknown.

Hab.: Asia: China and the former Soviet Union, in the Amur and Huang Basins.

into Ger-

F: C; live foods. In nature, these fish primarily feed on black fly larvae (Simuliidae),

Sex.: External differences between the sexes are very slight. d ¢ probably have nuptial tubercles during the spawning season.

S: Most authors consider G. tenuicorpus a subspecies of Gobio albipinnatus, but a number of characteristics speak in favor of G. tenuicorpus being an autonomous species.

F.l.: Has many.

not been

imported

Soc. B.: This lively, peaceful schooling fish relishes current.

M: As for Gobio gobio tungussicus. However,

a moderate

to strong

current

should be provided, since G. tenuicorpus is one of the most rheophilic (current-loving) members of the genus Gobio. B: Has probably not been bred aquarium. In nature, the animals T: 12°-22°C,

218

in an reach

L: 10 cm, A: 60 cm, Rib, D: 2=3

Carp-Like Fishes

Gobio gobio tungussicus

Gobio

tenuicorpus

Carps

Fam.: Cyprinidae

van HASSELT, 1823 Subfam.: Cyprininae

Hampala macrolepidota Silver and red barb Syn.: Barbus hampal. Hab.: Southeast Asia: the Sunda Islands, Burma, and Thailand (widely distributed throughout the latter two). F.1.: Unknown.

Sex.: Sexes based

cannot

be distinguished

on external characteristics.

F: O; all typical foods, including plantbased foods. S: Juveniles of H. macrolepidota and Hampala dispar are difficult to distinguish. However, adults can be differentiated, since H. macrolepidota has longer barbels.

Soc. B.: Unknown. Though rare, single specimens are occasionally imported as “by-catch.” Only juveniles are suitable because the animals grow too large for the average aquarium. Typical social behavior can hardly be displayed in the confines of an aquarium.

M: As for other large Barbus or Osteochilus species. B: A home aquarium is an inappropriate breeding environment. T: 22°-25°C, L: 70 cm, A: 100 cm, R: m, b, D: 2-3

BLEEKER,

Hemibarbus maculatus Spotted Amur barb Syn.: Acanthogobio maculatus, tscheuskii, Barbus semibarbus, barbus

labeo

var.

maculatus,

A. palGobioHemi-

barbus joiteni, H. labeo maculatus, longibarbis.

H.

Hab.: Asia: former Soviet Union and China, throughout the Amur and Yangtze Basins to the eastern Sikang. F.I.: Has not been imported to Germany. Sex.: dd are slightly larger than 9°. Otherwise, there are no definite sexual differences.

Soc. B.: Very peaceful, active, rheophilic (current-loving) schooling fish. M: Only roomy tanks with sand or finegrained gravel substrates are appropriate. Secluded areas among rocks or roots should be provided. Coldwater vegetation can be planted densely along the edges of the tank. Water should be clear and neutral with a hardness of 20° dGH. Perhaps a slight current produced

B: Has natural mature season

not been bred in Germany. In its habitat, these fish are sexually at 3 years of age. The spawning extends from the middle of May

to the end of June. During these months, the water temperature is 19° to 24°C. The 2 mm eggs are laid on aquatic plants and hatch after 4 days. The larvae lack adhesive organs and are pelagic for 6 days posthatching. Afterwards, they adopt a benthic lifestyle and actively feed. F: C; in nature, these animals feed on benthic invertebrates such as insect larvae, small crustacea, and molluscs.

S: In some regions, H. maculatus slight economic importance.

T: 10°-24°C, L: 36 cm, A: from 120 cm, R: b, D: 3

220

1871

Subfam.: Gobioninae with a powerhead would prove beneficial.

is of

Carp-Like Fishes

4

Hampala

macrolepidota

Hemibarbus

maculatus

~

~

Carps

Fam.: Cyprinidae Subfam.: Rasborinae

Hemigrammocypris lini Garnet minnow

WEITZMAN & CHAN, 1966

Syn.: Aphyocypris pooni.

After about 3 months the animals can be placed with other small species.

Hab.: Southern China: Kweiang System (mountains with white clouds, north of Hong Kong). F.|.: Ca. 1958 to the USA.

Sex.: 2 2 have a dark longitudinal band. 36 are slightly more colorful. See photos.

Soc. B.: Peaceful

schooling fish which

can be kept in unheated community tanks with any nonpredatory species.

F: O, C; small flake foods and FD Menu. Offer Tetra Conditioning Food, Artemia, and small live foods, particularly bloodworms,

M: Few demands are placed on water composition. Vegetation can consist of Vallisneria, Elodea, Sagittaria, and other species capable of tolerating cooler waters. However, always keep enough free swimming space for these lively fish. When kept at temperatures above 22°C, good filtration and water circulation become important. If stones are used as decoration, place them so that there are no crevices where the fish can become stuck or abrade their scales.

B: Water with a temperature of 24°-26°C, a pH of 7.5-7.8, and a hardness of ca. 13° dGH is appropriate for reproduction. Filter the water through the finest filter materials, and insure that it is oxygen-rich. Separate the breeding pair before placing them together in the breeding tank. The tank can be as small as 40 x 25 x 25 cm. Since the parents will eat the eggs, a coarse plastic mesh or a coarse gravel substrate are recommended. Between 15 and 30 eggs are

released daily for several days. They have an approximate diameter of 0.8 mm and are crystal clear. The 4 mm

larvae

hatch after about 60 hr. After 48 hr they are free-swimming and need small foods such as infusoria (e.g., squeeze the foam

filter). Fine MicroMin, egg yolk, and liquifry can also be fed. However, feeding these foods makes it imperative that

*/, of the tank’s volume

is exchanged

every 3-4 days (siphon the bottom). Af-

ter 6 days, Artemia can be fed. At that time, the juveniles turn golden yellow and develop their characteristic black stripe. T: 18°-22°C, L: 5.cm, A: 60 cm, R: m, t, D: 1-2

222

for variety.

S: This species is often confused with T. albonubes when imported as by-catch (Vol. 1, p. 446). Both inhabit the same region. Source: Tl 85 (1988).

Carp-Like Fishes

Hemigrammocypris

Hemigrammocypris

ir

lini 2, see page 257

ie

Carps

Fam.: Cyprinidae Subfam.: Cultrinae

(BASILEWSKY,

Hemiculter leucisculus Syn.: Culter leucisculus, Cultriculus kneri, Hemiculter dispar, H. kneri, H. schrenki, H. varpachovskii. Hab.: Asia: former Soviet Union (Amur Basin), western and southern Korea, and

China south to Hong Kong, Annam, and Taiwan.

F.I.: Has many.

not been

imported

into Ger-

Sex.: 2 2 are fuller; see photo. Soc. B.: This is a peaceful, surface-oriented schooling fish. M: Needs a large tank with plenty of swimming space, vegetation along the back and edges, and water with a hardness of up to 15° dGH and a pH of ca. 7.0. Always keep a small group of at

1855)

least 6 animals. Can be housed with other peaceful species that have similar requirements. B: Probably has not been bred in an aquarium. In nature, the animals spawn during the summer. F: O; all kinds of live foods. Juveniles consume zooplankton, whereas adults mainly eat insects. S: In addition to the nominate form, H. /. leucisculus (BASILEWSKY, 1855), there is another subspecies, H. /. /ucidus (DYBOWSKI, 1872) from the Ussuri River and Lake Khanka. H. /eucisculus is an important part of the food chain for predacious fishes of the Amur.

T: 18°-22°C, L: 18 cm, A: 100 cm, R: m, t, D: 2

DERANIYAGALA,

Horadandia atukorali

Ceylon dwarf barb Syn.: None.

Hab.: Southeast Asia: Sri Lanka (Ceylon). Lives among aquatic plants in freshwater lakes of the coastal plains. F.I.: Individually as by-catch. only since 1985.

Probably

Sex.: None known.

F: O; small live foods are preferred: Artemia nauplii, water fleas, cyclops, rotifers. S: H. atukorali is the smallest cyprinid of Sri Lanka. This species was named after the person who first captured the animals, V. ATUKORALI.

Soc. B.: Very peaceful schooling fish. Maintain in a species tank or keep with small Rasbora species, e.g., R. maculata. M: Even the smallest tanks suffice for H. atukorali. Use a dark substrate (e.g., Lavatit), dense vegetation, decorations riddled with hiding places, and a few floating plants to dim the illumination. Groups of more than eight fair better than individuals. Water: pH 6.0-6.5; hardness to 12° dGH. B: No information could be found. T: 24°-26°C, L: 2.8 cm, A: 40 cm, R: m, t, D: 3

224

1943

Carp-Like Fishes

Hemiculter

leucisculus

Horadandia

atukorali

@

~~

~

Carps

Fam.: Cyprinidae Subfam.: Cyprininae

(VALENCIENNES,

Hypophthalmichthys molitrix Silver carp Syn.: Leuciscus molitrix, Hypophthalmichthys dabryi, H. dybowskii, Onychodon debryi. Hab.: Originally distributed in east Asia, but it has been introduced into many parts of Europe. Lives in eutrophic, shallow lakes and warm rivers. Sex.: 22 are significantly fuller. Soc. B.: Peaceful fish that schools in the open water. Frequently cultured with carp and grass carp.

1844)

of 22° to 24°C. Up to 500,000 pelagic eggs are laid by each @. Juveniles migrate into rivers after their yolk sac is absorbed and feed on zooplankton found there. At a length of 5 to 10 cm, their dietary needs change and they begin feeding on phytoplankton. Their intestines grow to be 6-7 times their body length! Silver carp mature in 3 to 4 years in their native habitat, but sexual maturity is not attained in Hungarian waters

until 5-6 years of age.

M: Only juveniles can be kept in aquaria. See Cyprinus carpio for further information.

F: H; suspended algae. Normally plantbased foods are required. Feed flake foods as a dietary supplement.

B: Like grass carp, breeding is impossible without hormone treatments. Juveniles are imported or come from breeding stations. In their natural habitat, H. molitrix spawn in flood plain lakes during the summer at water temperatures

S: Frequently stocked in large lakes to control algae blooms. This species is very sensitive to chemical water pollutants. Insecticides and overfertilization are not tolerated.

T: 6°-24°C, L: 100 (80) cm, A: from 120 cm, R: m, D: 2

Hypophthalmichthys nobilis Big head

(RICHARDSON,

1845) -

Syn.: Leuciscus nobilis, Aristichthys nobilis.

needed spawn.

Hab.: Asia: originally inhabited

F: H, O; juveniles primarily feed on zooplankton. As they grow, the fish begin to incorporate other items such as phytoplankton into their diet, becoming able to subsist entirely on it. Soft plants can be given as a supplementary food.

and

south

Asia.

However,

introduced into many parts and can therefore now be Mediterranean region and rope. Inhabits warm, deep, ters.

central

it has

been

of the world found in the eastern Euflowing wa-

Sex.: Difficult to distinguish. stouter and usually larger.

292

are

Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish that does not bother other tankmates. M: Only juveniles make suitable aquarium specimens. House in large, coldwater aquaria that have clear, oxygenrich water. lt remains timid and will refuse to feed when kept in confining environments. B: See Hypophthalmichthys molitrix. Elevated temperatures exceeding 25°C over an extended period of time are

to stimulate

to

S: Big head carp feeds on phytoplankton throughout its life. But small animals such as worms, snails, insects, small crustacea,

and fishes may

be eaten

at

lower temperatures. Only at water temperatures above 19°C will it feed on phytoplankton like silver carp. The big head's intestine is 4-5 times its body length. H. nobilis has been released to control phytoplankton in many parts of the world, including central Europe. The pictured animal is a juvenile. Older specimens, in contrast to H. molitrix, are mottled.

T: 10°-26°C, L: 100 (60) cm, A: form 120 cm, R: m, b, D: 2

226

this species

Carp-Like Fishes

Hypophthalmichthys

nobilis,

silver coloration

Fam.: Cyprinidae

Say

lotichthys phlegethontis

228

Carps

Carp-Like Fishes Fam.: Cyprinidae

lotichthys phlegethontis

Carps

3

(COPE, 1874)

lotichthys phlegethontis Syn.: Clinostomus phlegethontis,

phiegethontis,

Leuciscus

Gila

phlegethontis,

Phoxinus phlegethontis. Hab.: North America: USA, in the Bonneville River Basin in Utah. Found in clear, shallow rivers, springs, lakes, and

swamps

with exuberant vegetation.

F.1.: 1988 to Holland.

Sex.: 63

have a red abdomen

during

the spawning season. Soc. B.: Robust schooling fish. M: Provide a fine sand substrate, dense

length of ca. 2.5 cm, which corresponds to approximately one year of age. In its native waters the spawning season extends from April to August with a peak in May. F: O; all kinds of live foods, but also frozen, freeze-dried, and flake foods. S: In some regions, this species has adapted to harsh environments of highly little dissolved oxygen, and temperature fluctuations of 15°C within a 24 hr period. Live expectancy in their natural biotope is 3 years. alkaline water,

vegetation along the back and edges, a few hiding places among roots, and an open swimming area. quirements are made sition or temperature. B: Has probably not rope. Sexual maturity

No particular reon water compo-

been bred in Euis attained at a

T: 10°-26°C, L: 6.5 cm, A: 70 cm, R: b, m, D: 1-2

229

_

~.

Carps

Fam.: Cyprinidae Subfam.: Cyprininae

PETERS,

Labeo cylindricus Cylindrical shark

1852

Syn.: Labeo darlingi, L. kilossae, L. loveridgei, L. parvulus, Tylognathus cantini, T. montanus.

The pictured animal from Wami, Tanzania, in contrast, lived 4 harmonious years in a community aquarium.

Hab.: Africa: in the rivers of eastern and southern Africa from Ethiopia to the Sambesi, Limpopo, and Pongolo Rivers. Also present in Lakes Tanganyika and Malawi.

M: As for L. ruddi.

F.1.: Unknown.

Sex.: No known

external differences.

Soc. B.: No information is available at this time, but probably very similar to other Labeo species (see Labeo rudd/). Animals from Lake Baringo (Kenya) have proven to be very predacious. Other fishes, including cichlids, are ambushed at night and their mucus layer is scraped off.

B: Has not been bred in an aquarium. F: O; all kinds of live foods and plant, flake, and tablet foods. S: L. cylindricus's closest relatives are Labeo ansorgii and L. forskalii. The latter species does not have a dark lateral band or a red iris.

T: 24°-28°C, L: up to 40 cm, A: from 120 cm, R: b, m, D: 3

RUPPELL,

Labeo forskalii Plain shark Syn.: None (7). Hab.: Africa: in tributaries Nile and the Blue Nile.

of both

the

FeRSA9S5; Sex.: In 3d, the first and last ray of the dorsal fin are elongated.

Soc. B.: While aggressive and quarrelsome among themselves, they are peaceful towards heterospecifics. Large individuals are territorial loners.

B: No information could be found. Breeding is probably only possible in large aquaria. F: O; live, freeze-dried, flake, and frozen foods as well as plant fare (algae, lettuce, spinach).

S: ELIAS (1972) reported that L. forskalii “nibbles” on its tankmates at night, inflicting minor wounds (Aquarienmagazin 6, 14).

M: Requires a large tank with a fine sand substrate. Decorate with roots, flat rocks, and a plenitude of plants. Arrange the decor so that the animals can establish territories without having their neighbor in direct visual contact. Maintain free swimming space. The water should be medium-hard (12°-15° dGH) and around neutral (pH 7.0). Be wary of placing large specimens in community aquaria.

T: 18°-25°C, L: 35 (20) cm, A: 120 cm, R: b, m, D: 2

230

1853

Carp-Like Fishes

Labeo

a" cylindricus

ae

Labeo

forskalii

J

~

Carps

Fam.: Cyprinidae Subfam.: Cyprininae

BOULENGER,

Labeo ruddi Limpopo shark Syn.: None. Hab.: Africa: South Africa, Mozambique, and Zimbabwe, endemic to the LimpopoIncomati River system. Inhabits mud-bottomed bodies of water. F.1.: Unknown.

Sex.: No definite external differences are known. During the spawning season, some dd supposedly have nuptial tubercles.

Soc. B.: May become aggressive and quarrelsome among themselves, but usually peaceful towards heterospecifics. It is unknown if large specimens are gregarious or solitary. If the latter is the case, do they claim territories like Labeo forskalii? M: House in roomy tanks that have a fine sand substrate; provide hiding places among roots and pieces of slate;

1907

plant the sides and back densely; arrange the decor so that the animals, if they find the need, can establish territories out of direct visual contact with their neighbors; preserve an open area for swimming. Water: hardness of 10°-15° dGH; pH around 7.0. This fish can be kept with fishes which have similar requirements B: No information could be found. F: O; live foods

(insects, insect larvae,

small crustacea, worms), and plant fare (algae, lettuce, spinach) as well as frozen, tablet, and flake foods. S: L. ruddi differs from other members of the Labeo niloticus group by, among other characteristics, the absence of a longitudinal stripe, a more ventral lateral line, and a short, blunt snout.

T: 23°-27°C, L: 26 cm, A: 120 cm, R: b, m, D: 2-3

Labiobarbus leptocheilus Syn.: Dangila leptocheila, D. cuvieri. Hab.: Southeast Asia: Thailand, Malaysia, and Indonesia (Sumatra, Borneo, and Java).

F.I.: 1967 by the name

FOWLER,

Osteochilus lini

1935.

Sex.: No definite external characteristics are known. During the spawning season, 2 2 are fuller (eggs).

(van HASSELT,

aquarium. Breeding is probably similar to other large Barbus species and not too difficult. Typical home aquaria are likely to be too small for breeding. F: O; vegetable matter (algae, lettuce, spinach) and all types of live foods as well as frozen, freeze-dried, and flake foods.

Soc. B.: Active, peaceful schooling fish. M: Give them a roomy tank with dense vegetation along the edges and back and refuges among roots and/or stones. Maintain ample swimming space. Good filtration and regular water exchanges are recommended. No major demands are placed on water composition. Only juveniles are suitable for normal home aquaria. B: To the best of our knowledge, this species has never been bred in an

T: 24°-26°C, L: 25 cm, A: 120 cm, R: m, b, D: 2-3

232

1823)

Carp-Like Fishes

%

le Mystus armatus

1

Mystus

vittatus (left) and

te

Mystus bleekeri (right)

Bagrid Catfishes

Fam.: Bagridae

GROMOW,

Mystus mica Dwarf bagrid Syn.: None, but frequently confused with Leiocassis brashnikowi. Hab.: Asia: Amur Basin.

lz

lO Sia

Sex.: 22 attain a larger mature size. The genital papilla of the ¢ is similar to other Mystus and Leiocassis species. 36 have less rays in the anal fin, a thinner body, shorter maxillary barbels, and a more elongated tail fin than 2 @. Soc. B.: These peaceful animals can easily be kept in groups. Well suited for community tanks that contain moderatesized fishes.

M: Medium-sized tank with vegetation around the edges. See Leiocassis brashnikowl. B: Unknown; in nature, it spawns among roots of swamp plants. Fry hatch after 3 days and begin feeding ca. 1 week post-

1970

hatching. In adult 2 2, the 1mm, greenish eggs can be seen through the anal periphery. F: C; live foods such as Daphnia, Cyclops, and various types of mosquito larvae as well as flake and tablet foods. These catfish dig among detritus (mulm), as they search for food items.

S: According to STERBA, these catfish have special embryonic breathing organs. M. mica is occasionally confused with two other catfishes, Leiocassis brashnikowi and Pelteobagrus fulvidraco. M. mica is smaller than L. brashnikowi and has a white stripe below the lateral line. M. mica is likewise smaller than P. fulvidraco, and its dark central line extends from the posterior edge of the operculum to the caudal peduncle.

T: 16°-24°C, L: 6 cm, A: 60 cm, R: b, D:

Hemibagrus. wyckii Syn.: Bagrus wyckii, Macrones Mystus wikii, M. wykii.

(BLEEKER, 1858) wykii,

Hab.: Southeast Asia: Java, Sumatra, Borneo, and the Malay Archipelago as well as Sri Lanka, Burma, and Thailand. Inhabits lakes, creeks, and rivers. F.1.: Unknown.

Sex.: Unknown; @ 2 are probably smaller and fuller.

Soc. B.: H. wyckii is a social yet predacious species. Predominately nocturnal. Associate only with large fishes. Best kept in a species tank. According to SANDS, this species attacks anything near its own stature, making it one of the most aggressive catfishes. M: Large, planted aquaria rich in hiding places are recommended. These catfish are found in a broad range of water chemistries in nature, but neutral to slightly acid, soft to medium-hard water is preferred.

B: Unknown. FRANKE bred one Hemibagrus species: The fish spawned in the open water, with the ¢ embracing the head and neck of the @ like a ring. During one pairing, 50 to 100 eggs were released. Approximately 8,000 to 10,000 eggs were laid by the time the animals had finished spawning. The adhesive eggs were about 1.2 mm in diameter. Young were fed finely chopped Tubifex at first; later the diet consisted of rotifers. While the specimens FRANKE bred were not Hemibagrus wyckii, they may have been Hemibagrus malabaricus.

F: C; all types of live and frozen foods commiserate to its size, including live fishes. S: It is.hard to differentiate the various Hemibagrus species. Various variants can be found in the extensive distribution area of H. wyckil, such that different species or subspecies may have been

pooled. In nature, H. wyckii attains a total length of 50 cm, possibly even 80 cm. T: 22°-25°C, L: 45 cm (possibly 80 cm in nature) cm, A: 150 cm, R: b, m, D: 2

320

Catfishes

Hemibagrus wyckil

Bagrid Catfishes

Fam.: Bagridae

(RICHARDSON, 1846)

Pelteobagrus fulvidraco Tawny dragon catfish

B: Spawns in pairs along protected sites. After the up to 2,000, 2.5 mm eggs are laid, they are guarded by the 6. The young hatch after 3 days and can be fed planktonic foods as well as finely grated Tubifex.

Syn.: Pimelodus fulvidraco, Bagrus calvarius, Pseudobagrus fulvidraco, Fluvidraco fluvidraco, Silurus calvarius, Pseudobagrus changi. Hab.: Asia: in the Amur Basin. F.1.: Unknown.

F: C; live foods such as worms, small fishes, and insect larvae. Flake foods and FD tablets are also accepted. While they prefer to take their food from the bottom, these catfish dig relatively little.

Sex.: ¢2 are smaller and clearly fuller when ripe. Soc. B.: Territorial species which is relatively peaceful towards conspecifics when kept in large groups, but unfortunately that demands a gigantic aquarium. Unlike Leiocassis brashnikowi, the tawny dragon catfish grows very rapidly in the aquarium, reaching lengths of about 20 cm. In its natural habitat, it grows up to 35 cm in length. M: Create hiding places bogwood in a large tank with robust vegetation. should cover part of the

with rocks and densely planted Floating plants surface. Water

chemistry is of secondary

importance,

but

best.

moderate

values

S: Of the 5 species of smaller catfish found in the Amur region, only Mystus mica and P. fulvidraco reach pet stores in significant numbers. The other three species are Leiocassis brashnikowi, L. herzensteini, and L. ussuriensis. All species have similar requirements, reach about 20 cm in size, and are difficult to bred. JAYARAM places this fish—for reasons not specifically explained—into the genus Pelteobagrus instead of Pseudobagrus.

are

Water

must be rich in oxygen. T: 16°-25°C, L: 35 (20) cm, A: 150 cm, R: b, Muse

Pelteobagrus ornatus Ornate bagrid Syn.: Pseudobagrus

(DUNCKER,

ornatus.

up to 18° dGH. Slight filtration, plenty of light, and a dark substrate are recommended.

Hab.: Southeast Asia: Malaysia and I|ndonesia, in the Muar River.

B: Has not been accomplished. The color of the eggs indicates that the animals spawn among plants. Sexual maturity is reached as the animals attain a length of 2.5 cm.

F.I.: 1982 into England. Sex.: dd have a small genital papilla directly in front of the anal fin. 22 are almost transparent, which allows their light green eggs to be seen in their abdominal cavity.

F: C; live and frozen foods commiserate to its size. Flake and freeze-dried foods are eaten, but must be fed in small, fre-

Soc. B.: This extremely congenial species prefers to be associated with conspecifics. Very similar to Corydoras pyg-

quent portions (4-6 times per day).

S: In nature, there is a species of barb that mimics this catfish: Crossocheilus pseudobagroides. |t seems that this barb seeks protection within schools of spiny catfish.

maeus in behavior. Unlike most catfishes, which prefer to sit quietly along the bottom, this catfish prefers to school in the water column. M: A well-planted tank is best, but not necessary. Water: pH 6.6-7.2; hardness Ti: 21°=25°C,

322

4 cm, Ay50'cms

Rabsm)

1904)

Da

Catfishes

Pelteobagrus

fulvidraco y

Pelteobagrus

ornatus

>

~

Fam.: Callichthyidae

Armored Catfishes

Subfam.: Corydoradinae

NIJSSEN & ISBRUCKER,

Aspidoras fuscoguttatus Spotted aspidoras Syn.: None. Hab.: South America:

Brazil, Peru.

F.1.: 1988. Sex.: Sexes are difficult to distinguish; 2? 2 have a slightly larger girth. Soc. B.: Very peaceful species that is rarely active during diurnal hours. Keep in a school of at least 6 animals. A.

1976

F: O; live foods such as TJubifex and mosquito larvae are its foods of choice. Flake and tablet foods will be eaten from the substrate. S: This armored catfish likes a layer of floating plants to dim the light. Numerous new armored catfishes have been imported recently. Most, including this species, make excellent aquarium fishes.

fuscoguttatus makes an excellent tankmate for small, peaceful, soft-water fishes.

M: Densely-planted, sand-bottomed aquaria are relished. A sand substrate allows the animals to root in their search for worms. Sensitive to abrupt changes in water conditions. Water: pH 5.5-6.8; hardness up to 12° dGH. B: Not Known, but probably Aspidoras pauciradiatus. T: 22°-25°C, L:

similar to

4cm, A: 60 cm, R: b, D: 2

Aspidoras rochai Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: Brazil. F.1.: Not known.

Sex.: 2 2 are fuller during the spawning

season. Soc. B.: A. rochai is a peaceful schooling fish and an excellent addition for community tanks containing small characins and dwarf cichlids. Do not associate with large fishes. M: House in tanks that are richly planted yet still have an open area in the foreground. That area should have a sand or fine-grained gravel substrate, allowing this armored catfish to dig for food. Water: pH 6.0-7.5; total hardness up to 14° dGH; carbonate hardness up to 6° dKH. Aspidoras species like oxygen-

rich water. Strong filtration with surface movement is important.

B: No information concerning breeding this species was found, but it should be T: 21°-25°C, L: 4.5 cm, A: 60 cm, R: b, D: 2

324

v. IHERING, 1907 similar to other small cies.

Corydoras

spe-

F: C; small live, flake, FD, and tablet foods are readily eaten.

S: A. rochai is the type species for the genus Aspidoras. Aspidoras have two fontanelles, while Corydoras has but one. A. menezesi, a similar species, is usually sold under the name A. rochai. This species is occasionally confused with A. fuscoguttatus (see previous fish).

Catfishes

Aspidoras

Aspidoras

fuscoguttatus

rochai

“2

~

Armored Catfishes

Fam.: Callichthyidae Subfam.: Corydoradinae

Brochis britskii Giant brochis Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: upper Rio Paraguay.

NIJSSEN & ISBRUCKER, 1983

Brazil, Paraguay,

F.I.: 1984 by Heiko BLEHER,

TODD, a British aquarist, has successfully bred B. splendens. F: C; small worms, mosquito larvae, and

Frankfurt/

Main. Sex.: Have not been described.

Soc. B.: This peaceful, diurnal bottomdweller likes to dig as it searches for food. M: As for the following species. See also B. splendens in Vol. 1, p. 458. Young Brochis often swim in mid-water, while adults are almost exclusively benthic. B: Due to the limited number of imported specimens, this species has not been bred in captivity. The spawning behavior of Brochis species is said to be similar to that of large Corydoras. Brian

Tubifex (well purged!) as well as flake and tablet foods (TetraTips, etc.).

S: Although B. britskii and Brochis multiradiatus are closely related, there are significant visible differences. Both have a large number of dorsal fin rays, but their coloration and head and mouth profiles deviate. B. britskii has a more convex head profile and a bony shield that covers the entire ventral side of the head.

T: 20°-24°C, L: 8 cm, A: 60 cm, R: b, m,

(CASTELNAU,

Brochis splendens Common brochis Syn.: Brochis coeruleus, B. dipterus, Callichthys splendens, Chaenothorax bicarinatus, C. eigenmanni, C. semiscutatus, Callichthys taiosh, Corydoras semiscutatus. Hab.: Amazon Basin of South America: Peru, at Iquitos and in the Rio Tocantins; Ecuador, in the Rio Ambiyacu and Rio Napo.

F.l.: 1938 by the Munchener AG, Hellabrunn, Germany.

Tierpark

1855)

are very sensitive to deteriorating water quality during the initial stages of life. Water: pH 6.0-6.5; hardness up to 4° dGH. Pairs separate from the school. The 3 swims above the &. Pairing occurs slightly above the substrate. Eggs are collected by the 2 in a cup formed by the pectoral fins as they leave her body. They are then adhered singly to plants

and

other

items.

In total,

over

Sex.: 2 2 are larger and, when carrying eggs, fuller.

1000, 1.5 mm eggs may be laid. At 24°C the young hatch after 4 days. Feed them zooplankton and finely chopped Tubifex.

Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish that makes a suitable tankmate for all small

F: O; prefers live foods, but leftovers off the bottom will also be consumed (flake

to medium-sized fishes.

foods, tablets, and fresh live foods).

M: There are no particular requirements. See the species description in Vol. 1, p.

S: To differentiate between Brochis and Corydoras, see the previous species and the species description in Vol. 1, p. 458.

458. B: As for Corydoras. However, many losses ensue, since the eggs and fry

T: 22°-28°C, L: 7 (9) cm, A: 70 cm, R: b, D: 1

326

Cattfishes

Brochis_

britskii

Brochis splendens,

juvenile

~

~

Armored Catfishes

Fam.: Callichthyidae Subfam.: Corydoradinae

BURGESS, 1982

Corydoras adolfoi Adolfo’s cory Syn.: None. Hab.: South America:

Brazil, in the Rio

Negro and Rio Uaupés. F.1.: 1982 by Adolfo SCHWARTZ

to the United States; described in his honor. Imported into Europe shortly thereafter. Sex.: Unknown.

Soc. B.: Schooling fish. Keep at least 6 specimens.

ral habitat and lasts about two weeks; then the fish spawn again. Reproduction is not very fecund, particularly when a small number of animals are bred. Fry can be raised using mashed Tubifex— only small pieces—and rotifers. After one week, they can handle small pieces of flake foods off the bottom. According to EVERS, Hamburg, who has bred this species, a low water level and a water hardness below 6° dGH are obligatory

M: As for all Corydoras species. Lives in schools and must be maintained as such in the aquarium. A sand bottom is preferred. Whichever substrate is used, it must have smooth edges. Plant the tank densely about the edges, leaving an open sandy surface in the foreground

for the catfish to dig. B: According to D. SANDS, breeding follows that of Corydoras aeneus. A group of 63 and 2 2 swims actively up and down the glass pane. Parts of the glass will be cleaned. Eggs are usually adhered

to sites other than

the glass

panes, including water plants. Each 2 lays about 25-30 eggs. Spawning gen-

requisites to successfully rear the young.

F: O; small live foods are preferred. However, small flake and tablet foods are accepted.

S: In TFH, 9, May 1982, AXELROD gave an anecdote about the discovery of this species. C. ado/foi belongs to the C. aeneus group. Though Corydoras imitator is a very similar fish, it lacks the red-brown coloring in the dorsal region between the two black areas. If the two species are placed side by side (see photo on the back of book jacket), you can easily discern that C. imitator has a longer snout.

erally occurs during the fall in their natuT: 22°-26°C, L:6 cm, A: 60 cm, R: b, D: 2

Corydoras amapaensis

NIJSSEN, 1972

Amapa cory Syn.: None.

F: O; small live foods are preferred.

Hab.:

South

America:

Brazil,

River;

French

Guyana,

in the region

the Rio Oiapoque

Amapari of

(Oyapok).

F.1.: Unknown.

Soc. B.: Schooling fish. Keep at least 6 animals. M: Like most Corydoras. and Vol. 1, pp. 462 ff.

See C. adolfoi

B: According to SANDS, this fish has been successfully bred several times in Great Britain, but detailed reports are not available. However, the coloration of the pictured specimen, which was bred by SANDS, does not coincide with the colors described within the original description. T: 22°-26°C, L: 6.5 cm, A: 60 cm, R: b, D: 2

328

S: One of the most variable Corydoras. The body design not only varies with geographical distribution, but within a single creek as well. For example, the dark wedge on the side can be very faint, while the upper half of the body may be totally dark. Corydoras septentrionalis, though very similar, never has a design on either the dorsal or caudal fin. Corydoras ellisae, another very similar species, does not have any spots in either the caudal or dorsal fin. It is possible that full-grown Corydoras of this group can be distinguished by their size,

since the maximum length of C. amapaensis is 8 cm.

Catfishes

ae

WW

Corydoras

tae amapaensis

=

2

oe

_

Ls

Armored Catfishes

Fam.: Callichthyidae Subfam.: Corydoradinae

NIJSSEN,

Corydoras bondi coppenamensis Bond’s cory, Coppename cory Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: pename River.

Suriname,

Cop-

F.1.: Ca. 1970.

Sex.: Have not been described.

Soc. B.: Calm species that makes an appropriate addition to almost any community aquarium. M: As for other Corydoras species.

1970

body and head. Similar differences exist between C. julii and C. trilineatus.

NIJSSEN and others have discovered the existence of several natural hybrids of C. b. coppenamensis and C. surinamensis, which proves that these two species are closely akin.

B: According to SANDS, these animals have been bred in captivity. F: C, O; does not have a selective ap-

petite. Leftover flake, tablet, and frozen foods are all accepted. S: A long-lived species. C. b. coppenamensis mainly differs from C. b. bondi by the larger dots on its TT: 20°=24°C; Ls '5 cm, A= 50)cm) Reo

D:

NIJSSEN & ISBRUCKER, 1986

Corydoras copei Cope’s cory Syn.: None. Hab.: South

America:

Peru,

Rio Huy-

toyacu.

F.1.: 1985. Sex.: Unknown.

Soc. B.: Peaceful at least 6 animals.

schooling fish. Keep

M: As for most Corydoras. B: Unknown. =e (0), T: 22°-25°C, L: 5 cm, A: 60'cm, R: b, D: 2

330

Catfishes

Corydoras

copei

331

ie]

~

Armored Catfishes

Fam.: Callichthyidae Subfam.: Corydoradinae

BLACK, 1987

Corydoras davidsandsi Sand’s cory Syn.: None. Occasionally confused with Corydoras melini. Hab.: South America: Brazil, the Amazon and the Rio Unini, a white-water river in the Rio Negro Basin at Manaus.

Sex.: 2 ¢ are stouter.

Soc. B.: Schooling fish. Keep at least 6 animals. C. davidsandsi are peaceful bottom-dwellers. Suitable for aquaria that have good water quality and peaceful inhabitants. M: Use coarse sand or fine-grained gravel as the substrate. Plant the edges (any vegetation is appropriate). An open space in the foreground for digging is vital. Clean the filter material often. Water: pH 6.2-7.2; hardness to 20° dGH; carbonate hardness of 8° dKH. B: P. MOYE successfully bred this species in Britain. Similar to other armored catfishes.

F: C, O; small live foods, tablets, and flake foods are eaten from the bottom. C. davidsandsi eats leftovers and likes

to dig. Worms and mosquito larvae are particular favorites and should be fed frequently. S: C. davidsandsi is supposedly part of the C. aeneus group, but this classification is questionable. With the excep-

tion of its shorter body and snout and the faint dots along its sides, C. melini is very similar to C. davidsandi. The longitudinal band is distinctive for C. davidsandsi, although C. melini’s band is almost identical. In the same habitat, a very similar species with similar coloration has been found: Brachyrhamdia rambarani. There are five pairs of Corydoras/Brachyrhamdia species with very similar designs. The reasons behind this mimicry are unknown.

T: 20°-25°C, L: 6.5 cm, A: 60 cm, R: b, D: 2

NIJSSEN & ISBRUCKER,

Corydoras delphax Delphax cory Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: Colombia,

in the

Rio Inirida system.

F.1.: 1986. Sex.: 2 with eggs clearly have a larger girth. ¢3d have a more pronounced design.

Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish. Keep at least 6 specimens. M: Like most armored catfishes. B: Unknown. E20;

S: This beautiful species with its notorious pointed head is presently being studied by ISBRUCKER and NIJSSEN. It is probably a color morph of C. delphax (see Vol. 2, p. 462). T: 20°-26°C, L: 7 cm, A: 80 cm, R: b, D: 3

332

1983

Catfishes

—>~Y

Ro4

Corydoras davidsandsi

Corydoras

delphax

333

Armored Catfishes

Fam.: Callichthyidae Subfam.: Corydoradinae

BOHLKE, 1950

Corydoras fowleri Fowler’s cory Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: Peru, Cano del Chancho near Pebas. F.1.: Unknown. Sex.: 2 2 are slightly stouter and have a larger girth. Soc. B.: A very peaceful species which, like most bottom-dwelling catfishes, likes to live in groups. M: As for other Corydoras species from fast-flowing waters.

published in an aquarium magazine, was incomplete and lacked a photo. Species identification is best done on preserved specimens. The thoracic and abdominal plates are species specific.

B: Unknown, but probably like other Corydoras species. Feed breeders live

foods. F: C, O; tablets and leftover flake foods. S: Redescribed by WEITZMAN, 1964 because the first description, which was Te 21r=23°C, Eo sicm, As ZO cma Rabe Da2

NIJSSEN & ISBRUCKER,

Corydoras imitator Imitator cory Syn.: None. Very similar to adolfoi. Hab.: South America: Brazil.

Corydoras

F.1.: 1984. Sex.: Full-grown 2 @ are larger and fuller. Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish. Keep at least 6 specimens. M: As for all Corydoras species. See C. adolfoi. B: Like C. adolfoi, but less fecund. es. (0), S: The name “imitator’ originated because of its great similarity to C. ado/foi. But, C. imitator has a longer snout, is less common, and is usually found within schools of other Corydoras. T: 22°-26°C, L: 6 cm, A: 60 cm, R: b, D: 2

334

1983

Catfishes

Corydoras

fowleri

Corydoras

imitator

Armored Catfishes

Fam.: Callichthyidae Subfam.: Corydoradinae Se

Corydoras loretoensis Loreto cory Syn.: None. Very similar to

NIJSSEN & ISBRUCKER,

1986

NIJSSEN & ISBRUCKER,

1983

Corydoras

armatus. Hab.: South America: Peru. F.1.: Unknown. Sex.: Unknown.

Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish. Keep at least 6 animals. M: As for most other Corydoras. B: Unknown.

=a (O): S: Compare to Corydoras armatus in Vol. 1, p. 460. C. armatus is larger with striations on the posterior body and an unpigmented caudal fin. T: 22°-25°C, L: 5 cm, A: 60 cm, R: b, D:

Corydoras loxozonus Slant-bar cory Syn.: Corydoras "deckeri” name. See Vol. 1, p. 462.

is a trade

Hab.: South America: Colombia, in the Rio Meta and tributaries of the Rio Guaviare.

F.I.: 1980 into the United States as dekkeri.”

“C.

Sex.: Sexes cannot be distinguished from external features. Soc. B.: This peaceful fish resides in groups. Easily maintained in community aquaria. M: As for Corydoras ornatus. B: Has not been bred? F:.0; small, live foods, tablets, and leftover flake foods.

S: C. loxonus and C. axelrodi are similarly colored and hence often confused. However, C. axelrodi does not have a design on the fins or the ventral half of the body. T: 21°-24°C, L: 6 cm, A: 60 cm, R: b, D: 1-2

336

Catfishes

wr’?4 a =a

Corydoras loretoensis

Corydoras loxozonus

337

~

~

Fam.: Callichthyidae

Armored Catfishes

Subfam.: Corydoradinae

NIJSSEN & ISBRUCKER, 1986

Corydoras napoensis Napo cory Syn.: None. Previously considered color morph of Corydoras nanus.

a

Hab.: South America: Ecuador and Peru, in the Rio Aguarico, Rio Napo, and Rio Nanay. F.1.: Unknown.

very similar to the sympatrically occurting Corydoras elegans. (=O).

S: A member of the C. elegans group. C. elegans and C. nanus are very similar.

Sex.: dd have a more distinct design. Full-grown 2° are larger and usually fuller. Soc. B.: Peaceful

schooling fish. Keep

at least 6 specimens.

M: As for most corys. B: Although there is no information about successfully breeding this species, recommendations made for breeding Corydoras nanus may follow for C. napoensis as well. Otherwise, it can be expected that breeding C. napoensis is

it: 22°-26°C; LE: 65cm, Axi60icm\ Rib) P22

Corydoras orphnopterus

WEITZMAN

Spotfin cory Syn.: Corydoras

orphanopterus.

Hab.: South America: Ecuador and Brazil, in the Rio Bobonaza, Rio Pastaza

C. atropersonatus, a very similar species, by its dark spot on the dorsal fin.

system, and the Mato Grosso.

F.1.: 1984. Sex.: ° 2 are paler, generally fuller, and have smaller dots. 22 can be easily confused with Corydoras atropersonatus.

Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish. Maintain at least 6 specimens. M: As for other corys. See Vol. 2, p. 472. B: Unknown, but it should be similar to other Corydoras of the C. punctatus group. FAO: S: In Vol. 2, p. 472, another color morph with fewer dots is described. Specimens with a lighter ocular band also occur, This species is easily distinguished from T: 20°-24°C,

338

& NIJSSEN, 1970

L: 5.5 cm, A: 60 cm, R: b, D: 1-2

Catfishes

Corydoras

napoensis

Corydoras

orphnopterus

Fam.: Callichthyidae

Armored Cattfishes

Subfam.: Corydoradinae

Corydoras osteocarus Pepper-spot cory Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: Venezuela and Suriname, in the Atabapo and Kabalobo Rivers. F.1.: 1925 by TERNETZ.

Sex.: 2° are larger and fuller. Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish. Keep at least 6 specimens. M: As for other Corydoras. B: When breeding, the ¢ clamps the barbels of the ¢ to his body using his ventral fins. 2-5 eggs are immediately

fertilized. These are carried within the ?’s ventral fin pouch. Up to 300 eggs are laid and then adhered to a plant. At 24°C, the young hatch after 3-4 days and can be fed plankton and finely grated Tubifex. ee Oh S: Despite its body design, C. osteocarus bears a certain similarity to Corydoras aeneus. Corydoras bondi bondi is another comparable species. T: 22°-25°C, L: 5 cm, A: 60 cm, R: b, D: 2

340

BOHLKE, 1951

Catfishes

Corydoras ‘osteocarus

3

Corydoras

juvenile

osteocarus,

Pet

Armored Catfishes

Fam.: Callichthyidae Subfam.: Corydoradinae

WEITZMAN

Corydoras pastazensis Pastaza cory Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: Ecuador and Peru, in the Rio Tigre system (Rio Conambo and Rio Pinto). F.I.: Imported into England in 1983 as by-catch from Iquitos. Sex.: 2 2 are fuller through the anterior ventral area.

Soc. B.: Robust, peaceful fish. Wellsuited for cool community tanks. M: Inhabits the snow melt creeks along the eastern slope of the Andes. Clear, soft, cool water is preferred.

Echinodorus substrate.

can

& NIJSSEN, 1970

serve as a spawning

ExGi@: S: The name tiger cory has been suggested since the species comes from the Rio Tigre (= tiger river) system. Using a little imagination, you can see 5 tigerlike vertical dark bands on the fish's body. C. pastazensis orcesi is one of the two described subspecies. However, due to the broad variability of the species, it has. been withdrawn (NIJSSEN & IS-

BRUCKER,

1986).

B: Attempts to date have proven unsuccessful. If you are lucky enough to acquire a pair, set them up in a 60-80 cm long species tank, add new water, and maybe filter over peat. A large potted T: 20°-24°C, L: 6.5 cm, A: 60 cm, R: b, D: 2

Corydoras polystictus Many-spotted cory Syn.:

Corydoras

Hab.:

South America:

REGAN,

virescens. Brazil, in the Rio

Guaporé (Mato Grosso). F.1.: Unknown.

Sex.:



are slightly fuller and have a

broader white ventral area.

Soc. B.: Peaceful at least 6 animals.

schooling fish. Keep

M: As for other Corydoras. A young specimen is pictured in Vol. 2, p. 474. B: See Vol. 2, p. 474. Fe (0):

S: Very similar to C. punctatus and C. concolor. C. punctatus is spotted, whereas

C©. concolor

hardly

has

any

spots. The picture to the right is of an older specimen with extremely deviant coloration (see Vol. 2, p. 474). T: 22°-28°C, L: 4 cm, A: 60 cm, R: b, D: 1-2

342

1912

Catfishes

Corydoras

polystictus

~

Armored Catfishes

Fam.: Callichthyidae Subfam.: Corydoradinae

ISBRUCKER & NIJSSEN, 1973

Corydoras pulcher White-fin cory Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: western Brazil, Rio Purus. F.1.: Not known.

ever, the cream-colored dorsal and pectoral fin rays can be used to distinguish this species from other corys. Note that the light coloring of these fin rays bleeds into the first soft fin rays.

Sex.: No external differentiating characteristics have been described. Soc. B.: Peaceful bottom-dwellers that do well in clear, well-filtered water. Associate with other amiable species.

M: Soft, brownish, slightly acid water is preferred (peat filtration). Include at least one corner of sand for the fish to root in. B: Apparently this species has not been bred.

F: O; tablets (e.g., TetraTips) over flake foods.

and left-

S: Very similar in color to Corydoras ornatus and Corydoras schwartzi. HowT: 21°-24°C, L: 6 cm, A: 50 cm, R: b, D: 1

NIJSSEN & ISBRUCKER,

Corydoras sodalis Netted cory Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: Peru to the border of Brazil, in the Rio Yavari and Rio

Solimoes. Fale Sate

Sex.: Unknown.

Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish. Keep a group of at least 6 animals. M: As for other Corydoras. B: Unknown; reticulatus.

probably like

Corydoras

lO), S: Differentiating C. sodalis and C. reticulatus is difficult. There are differences in the median longitudinal. line and the

base of the dorsal fin. The body design is variable and is not considered a dependable criterion to differentiate species. T: 22°-27°C, L: 5 cm, A: 60 cm, R: b, D: 2

344

1986

Catfishes

Corydoras

pulcher

Corydoras sodalis

~

Fam.: Callichthyidae

Armored Catfishes

Subfam.: Corydoradinae

Corydoras surinamensis Surinam cory Syn.: Corydoras schwartzi surinamensis. Hab.: South America: Suriname. F.1.: Unknown.

Sex.: No distinguishing external characteristics are known.

NIJSSEN, 1979 over flake foods are also eaten.

S: The pictured animal may be a color morph of Corydoras melanistius brevirostris. \ts barbels are particularly sensitive.

Soc. B.: A peaceful species that likes to reside in groups. M: As for other Corydoras. However, this species is sensitive to nitrates. Keep nitrate levels low by performing water exchanges every 2-3 weeks (1/3 to '/2 of the tank's volume). Use a good water conditioner. Water: pH 6.0—7.2; hardness up to 15° dGH. B: Probably

like other

Corydoras

spe-

cies. F: C, O; small live foods such as Daphnia and well-purged Tubifex. Frozen mosquito larvae, tablet foods, and leftT: 22°-25°C,

L: 6 cm, A: 60 cm, R: b, D:

Corydoras treitlii Long-nosed cory Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: Brazil, in the Rio Parnaiba and Rio Maranhao.

F.1.: 1958. Sex.: Unknown.

Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish. Keep a group of at least 6 animals. M: As for other Corydoras.

B: Unknown; has been successfully bred in Scotland. = @), S: Similar to Corydoras barbatus, but morphologically closer to C. acutus and C. semiaquilus (see Vol. 1, p. 460). Rarely imported. T: 20°-25°C, L: 7 cm, A: 60:cm, R: b, D? 2

346

STEINDACHNER,

1906

Catfishes

~~ oth, an

saans %, P Pini | ei ~

7

td

Corydoras

Beas

a

he ,

6 Othe

a

-

Maat, i

=

a

z

surinamensis



y

Corydoras

treitlii

347

Be

Fam.: Callichthyidae

Armored Catfishes

Subfam.: Corydoradinae

Corydoras prionotus Syn.: Corydoras “triseriatus” (an invalid species). Hab.: South America: southern Brazil. F.I.: 1986 to England. Sex.: Ripe 2 2 are clearly fuller. Soc. B.: Peaceful schooling fish. Keep a group of at least 6 animals.

NIJSSEN & ISBRUCKER,

1980

more pointed head, and lacks the dark spot anterior to the dorsal fin found in C. nattereri. Compare the photo to the right with the one of C. bade/, another similar species, in Vol. 1, p. 471. This species is considered to be part of the Corydoras barbatus group.

M: As for other Corydoras species. B: Unknown. EXO: S: Though described in 1980, it was not imported alive into England until 1987. Hopefully C. prionotus will be imported into Germany promptly. C. prionotus and Corydoras nattereri are two very similar species which were previously considered synonymous, but the former has a slimmer, lighter-colored body, a T: 20°-26°C,

L: 8 cm, A: 80 cm, R: b, m,

Corydoras zygatus Zygatus cory Syn.: None.

Hab.: South America: Peru, Rio Huallaga in the Loreto region. F.I.: Unknown, because C. zygatus has been continuously confused with C. rabauti. Sex.: 2 2 are larger and notably fuller. Soc. B.: Peaceful, gregarious fish which constantly searches for food items. M: Not particular. Conditions demanded by cardinal tetras seem to suit this catfish well, including filtering over peat. Water: pH 6.0-7.0; hardness up to 20° dGH, but 10° dGH is better. Use a dark, fine-grained substrate and floating plants to, subdue light. B: Has been bred in England. Spawning transpires in a typical Corydoras fashion. See C. melanotaenia (Vol. 2, p. 470). ma (;, ©). T: 22°-25°C, L: 5.5 cm, A: 60 cm, R: b, D: 1

348

EIGENMANN

& ALLEN, 1942

S: Although adult C. zygatus and C. rabauti are very difficult to distinguish, juveniles can easily be differentiated by coloration.

Catfishes

Corydoras

zygatus

Fam.: Callichthyidae

Armored Catfishes

Subfam.: Callichthyinae

A sluggish jungle creek during the dry season (Amazon, Brazil). During the rainy season, the water level rises several meters. Such black-water tributaries of the Amazon are home to many catfishes such as Corydoras and Hoplosternum. Continuation of Hoplosternum thoracantum

var. niger (facing page):

Black fry tend to grow slower; hence, the two color morphs are best reared separately. Brooding 363 must be left undisturbed, since they will eat the spawn at the slightest provocation.

F: O; aufwuchs and live, flake, and tablet foods.

T: 18°-28°C,

350

L: 16 cm, A: 70 cm, R: all, D: 1

S: The mottled nominate form was presented in Vol. 1, p. 478.

Catfishes Fam.: Callichthyidae

Armored Catfishes

Subfam.: Callichthyinae

Hoplosternum thoracatum Black port hoplo

var. niger

Syn.: Callichthys thoracatus, C: longifilis, C. personatus, C. exaratus, Hoplosternum thorae, H. longifilis, H. magdalenae,

H. thoracatum catum

surinamensis,

H. thora-

dailly, H. punctatum.

Hab.: South static waters. be found in ments, living creeks.

America: usually found in Hordes of this catfish can waters near human settleoff the trash thrown into the

Fale ike Sex.: dd have a significantly thicker spiny ray on their pectoral fins. Soc. B.: Peaceful species. The d's territorial behavior is limited to the spawning season. M: The black form tends to be more sensitive; nevertheless, this species is quite easy to care for. Offer hiding places and feed during the evening hours. Water: pH 5.5-8.3;

although avoided.

hardness

extreme

values

to 30° dGH,

should

be

(VALENCIENNES,

1840)

B: 36 build a bubble nest beneath large floating leaves. Styrofoam plates can be offered as a substitute. Spawning Is triggered by a drop in barometric pressure. Courtship is frequently elaborate, often extending into the following day. The ¢ guides a ripe @ to the nest and clamps her barbels with his ventral fins for the actual spawning act. The @ ?’s ventral fins form a pouch into which the eggs are laid. Later the 2 places the up to 500 eggs into the bubble nest. Remove the @ after spawning is completed to save her from further pursuit. Young hatch after 4-6 days. Stabilize the water temperature between 26°-28°C. Even though the ¢ guards the eggs, he cannot be trusted with the newly hatched young. Remove him after the eggs hatch. The young immediately accept newly hatched Artemia nauplii. With frequent water exchanges and hardy meals, they grow well. Even if both parents are black, only up to 50% of the young will be black

Continued on page 350.

351

ene

Fam.: Chacidae Subfam.: Chacinae

BLEEKER,

Chaca bankanensis Chocolate frogmouth catfish Syn.: Chaca bancanensis. Hab.: Indonesia and the southern Malay Peninsula, in rain forest creeks and rivers. F.1.: Not known. Sex.: Not known.

Soc. B.: Though it appears to be a peaceful and calm species, it is predacious. Like angler fishes, smaller fishes (less than ‘/, C. bankanensis's length) are ambushed by Chaca and sucked into its jowls. M: C. bankanensis needs hiding places, a soft peaty substrate (perhaps leaves), and a darkened water surface. Water: pH 6.0-7.2; hardness up to 10° dGH. B: Has not been bred. F: C; fishes, tadpoles, earthworms,

and

large aquatic insects and their larvae. After acclimation, tablet food is accepted

(found by smell).

1852

from photographs. The following are anatomical and geographical differences: C. chaca Pectoral rays: |/5 Habitat: India (Ganges and Bramaputra). Virtually always found in large sunny rivers. Lower lip: Normally has numerous hooklets or teethlets. Hooklets on the body: One row above and sometimes also below the lateral line.

C. bankanensis Pectoral rays: |/4 Habitat: Shady waters in the rain forest of Malaysia and Indonesia. Lower lip: Either has very few or no hooklets. Hooklets on the body: None. C. burmensis

BROWN

& FERRARIS,

1988 is a third species. It is only known from Burma. See DATZ 6/89, pp. 327 f.

S: C. bankanensis can barely be differentiated from Chaca chaca, impossible T: 24°-28°C, L: 15 cm, A: 80 cm, R: b, D: 3-4 (C)

Chaca chaca Frogmouth catfish Syn.: Platystacus chaca. Hab.: Borneo (presently Kalimantan), India, Sumatra. F.1.: 1938. Sex.: Unknown.

Soc. B.: Sometimes predacious. Not suitable for community aquaria. M: These nocturnal animals are only active while feeding. Resting fishes as large as 6 cm are not respected. Hardly any demands are placed on water composition. Water: pH 6-8; hardness 4°-25° dGH. Provide hiding places among large rock edifications. Plants are not damaged.

(HAMILTON, 1822) F: C; FD tablets are accepted after acclimation. The large mouth leads one to suspect a predatory lifestyle. According to MEINKEN, the broad mouth serves as a weir for plankton. Generally acknowledged as a predator. S: Only for aquarists who like the weird and unusual. Chaca was considered to be monotypic until a second species, Chaca bancanensis, was described in 1983. A third species was described in DATZ 6/89 (see above).

B: Not known. T: 22°-24°C, L: 20 cm, A: 100 cm, R: b, D: 3

352

Catfishes

Chaca

Chaca

bankanensis

chaca

Fam.: Clariidae

Walking Catfishes

Heterobranchus longifilis Long-fin walking catfish

VALENCIENNES,

Syn.: Heterobranchus

laticeps.

Hab.: Widely distributed western Africa.

in central and

F.1.: Unknown.

Sex.: There may be a slight difference at the anus, but it is not easily noticed without a thorough examination. Soc. B.: Both adults and juveniles are greedy predators. Even large fishes are not exempt from being attacked. Best kept alone. M: Not recommended for home aquaria because of its fast growth and predatory behavior. B: Unknown.

F: C; fishes and substitute foods.

S: Easily differentiated from other Clariidae by its shorter dorsal fin and long adipose fin.

T: 22°-23°C, L: over 70 cm, A: 2 m, R: b, D: 4 (S, C)

354

1840

Catfishes Fam.: Doradidae

Thorny Catfishes

KINDLE,

Hassar wilderi

1894

Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: Brazil, Rio Tocantins. F.1.: 1983 to Great Britain. Sex.: Unknown. Soc. B.: Timid, retiring fish which is sometimes active during the day. Easily frightened. Peaceful towards smaller fishes. M: Clean, oxygen-rich water is a necessity. Prone to infections; wounds should be treated fast and prophylactically. B: Unknown. F: O, C; likes to search the bottom for

worms,

particularly

Tubifex.

S: None. T: 20°-25°C,

L: 20 cm, A: 120 cm, R: b, D: 3-4

355

Thorny Catfishes

Fam.: Doradidae

EIGENMANN,

Megalodoras irwini Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: Brazil, in the Amazon and Maranén; Guianas.

F.I.: Usually these infrequently imported catfish arrive as single specimens;

1925

S: One of the largest Doradidae. Its dark brown plates, strong “spines,” and olive and brown spots make it easy to identify. Only suitable for large show aquaria.

1975

to Great Britain. Sex.: Unknown. Soc. B.: Even colossal full-grown specimens are quite docile, but the restrictive environment of most home aquaria is unsuitable for such large fish.

M: Only juveniles are suitable for the home aquarium, which is a pity since large, well-colored specimens are very attractive. B: Unknown.

F: O; mainly snails, but palm fruits, etc., are also eaten.

T: 22°-25°C, L: 60 cm, A: 2 m, R: b, D: 4 (S)

(KNER, 1855)

Platydoras dentatus Syn.: Doras detantus, D. dentatus.

but lacks the white lateral stripe of the latter (see P. costatus in Vol. 1, p. 484).

Hab.: South America: Suriname. F.I.: In 1978 a single specimen reached Great Britain as by-catch. Sex.: Unknown. Soc.

B.: Not an active predator,

but it

will devour small fishes. It only emerges from secluded hiding places during the night. M: Adaptable in regard to water chemistry. Nevertheless, alkaline water should be avoided. Dim hiding places out of direct light are preferred. B: Unknown.

F: O, C; a plenitude of live foods such as Tubifex.

S: Primarily reaches the trade as single specimens among shipments of Platydoras costatus (LINNAEUS, 1766). P. dentatus is very similar to P. costatus, T: 22°-25°C, L: 13 cm, A: 120 cm, R: b, D: 3

356

Cattfishes

Megalodoras

; ™“

irwini

tg 2

:

Platydoras



es

f

dentatus

rao

Fam.: Helogenidae

GUNTHER, 1863

Helogenes marmoratus Syn.: Helogenes

unidorsalis.

Hab.: South America: common from the upper Amazon (Rio Ucayali) in Peru to

the mouth of the Amazon; Essequibo,

Guyana, Rio

Laas 1keakeh

Sex.: Unknown.

Soc. B.: Almost exclusively nocturnal. Food may entice the fish to emerge during daylight hours. Peaceful among conspecifics and other fishes that cannot be considered bite-size.

F: C; small live foods, particularly insect larvae and small worms; rumors claim that ants are also eaten. Flake foods can be fed occasionally. Feed just prior to turning off the illumination. S: Despite its wide distribution, this catfish is rarely imported because of its nocturnal lifestyle. SCHRAMM wrote an interesting report in “Das Aquarium,” 2/93.

M: Medium-sized tank with plenty of hiding places and plants. It remains hidden among plants during the day. There their coloration ‘provides excellent camouflage. Filter the water, but minimize water movement, since this catfish prefers tranquil zones. Water: DH 6-7; hardness

up to 15° dGH. B: Unknown. T: 22°-26°C,

358

L: 12 cm, A: 80 cm, R: b, D: 2-3

Catfishes Fam.: Ictaluridae

Bullhead Catfishes

Subfam.: Ictalurinae

Ameiurus melas Black oullhead Syn.: /ctalurus melas, Silurus melas. Hab.: North America: United States from Lake Ontario to Wyoming and the Gulf of Mexico. Rio Grande, Sonora, and Kentucky Rivers. F.I.: Uncertain, since this species is often confused with A. nebulosus.

Sex.: Cannot be distinguished from external characteristics outside of the spawning season. At that time, 22 are significantly fuller. Soc. B.: Either lives alone or in schools. Peaceful among conspecifics. Limit tankmates to those either equal to or larger than A. melas. Twilight-active. Predator! M: Keep in a pond or large aquarium. Use a limited number of plants, each of which must be well-rooted in pots then further protected with flat stones. Water conditions are not important. Water: pH

6.5-8.0 (7.0); hardness 4°-25° (10°) dGH. Subdued illumination, a cave of

(RAFINESQUE, 1820) roots and rocks, and a substrate of gravel or coarse sand are suggested. Use a dimmer to observe the fish.

B: Only possible in ponds. A cave is created among shoreline vegetation. The eggs form a ball on the substrate. Depending on temperature (8°-15°C), the young hatch in 10-16 days. Feed them small live foods. F: C, O; omnivores that predominately feed on live foods such as earthworms and fishes. Juveniles can easily be trained to accept tablet foods. Fresh meat, canned dog food, and carp pel- ~ lets are also eaten.

S: A. nebulosus

can

easily be distin-

guished from A. melas by its coloration: A. melas is virtually black, whereas A. nebulosus is brown, dark brown and, depending on the light, iridescent green.

Sometimes eaten in the United but the flavor is poor.

States,

T: 8°-30°C, L: 35 om, A: 200 cm, R: b, D: 1-4, depending on size (C)

359

Fam.: Ictaluridae

Bullhead Catfishes

Subfam.: Ictalurinae

Ameiurus nebulosus Brown bullhead Syn.: Pimelodus nebulosus, Silurus coenosus, S. nigrescens, Pimelodus vulgaris, P. felis, P. catus, P. atrarius, Amiurus nebulosus, A. vulgaris, A. catus, Ameiurus lacustris, A. vulgaris, Ictalurus nebulosus, |. n. nebulosus, |. n. marmoratus. Hab.: Eastern and central North America and coastal provinces of Canada. Although it normally inhabits freshwater, it was found in the Miramichi River (Canada) in 1959 at a salinity of 8-15%. F.|.: Before 1900.

Sex.: At spawning time, 22 are fuller through the stomach region. Sexes cannot be distinguished during the rest of the year.

Soc. B.: Only territorial during the soawning season: Nevertheless, aggressions are sometimes displayed without apparent reason. Only associate with equalsized fishes. Predator! M: At the end of the previous century, this species was one of the few aquarium fishes that could easily be maintained,

(LESEUR, 1819) which explains its popularity and why it was bred by many aquaculture enterprises. Aquarium specimens should be imited to those smaller than 20cm.

Feeding and filtration becomes too complicated with larger fish. Even caring for these animals in a garden pond is not simple. No demands are placed on waer composition. B: Spawns at 21°-28°C from March to ay. The 500 eggs are laid along shalOw shores or under overhanging shore vegetation in depressions that the fish excavate by fanning their fins. 22 fan the eggs, and d¢ guard the spawn. After 5-8 days, the fry hatch and are guided by the parents for an additional 10 days. F: C, O; tablet foods, carp pellets, or any live foods, including small fishes. S: This species hybridizes with A. melas where they occur together in their natural habitat. It is unknown whether or not the offspring are fertile.

T: 4°-30°C (coldwater fish), L: 40 cm, A: 250 cm, R: b, D: 1-4 (S, C)

360

Catfishes Fam.: Loricariidae

Suckermouth Catfishes

Subfam.: Ancistrinae

Acanthicus adonis Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: Brazil and Peru, in the Amazon Basin, Rio Branco, Rio

Huallaga, Rio Purus, and Rio Tocantins. F.|.: By A. WERNER in 1983. Sex.: dd grow larger; ° ° are frequently fuller. See S. Soc. B.: This peaceful species makes an appropriate tankmate for mediumsized, soft water fishes such as cichlids and characins.

M: Very resilient species that does not have any particular demands other than a large aquarium. The presence of bogwood seems to curtail damage to aquatic plants, since A. adonis rasps

ISBRUCKER & NIJSSEN, 1988 F: H, O; an omnivore which primarily subsists on aufwuchs. In the aquarium, they can be fed with tablet foods. Carrots, peas, spinach, and a variety of other vegetables should be tried.

S: A. adonis was originally sold as a spotted form of A. hystrix. The attractive juvenile coloration turns solid brown as the fish ages. Additional species or color morphs of Acanthicus are known, but not yet described. There are A. adonis specimens with and without a spotted head: see Vol. 2, pp. 432 and 503. The type specimen of A. hystrix in Munich was unfortunately lost during the war. This makes species descriptions within the genus Acanthicus problematic.

the bogwood in lieu of the plants. Clear, fast-flowing water that is soft and slightly acid provides a healthy environment for this fish. B: Unknown.

T: 22°-27°C, L: 70 (100) cm, A: 200 cm, R: b, D: 4 (S)

361

Fam.: Loricariidae

Suckermouth Catfishes

Subfam.: Ancistrinae

ues

SCH

Acanthicus

362

hystrix,

ventral

view

Catfishes Fam.: Loricariidae

Suckermouth Catfishes

Subfam.: Ancistrinae

Acanthicus

SPIX, 1829

hystrix

Syn.: None. Hab.:

South America:

Guyana,

Brazil, Peru, and

in the Amazon

Basin and the

Rio Tocantins.

exchanges and strong filtration are important. See Vol. 2, p. 502. B:

Unknown.

Its mature

F.I.: 1987 by A. WERNER.

F: H, O; vegetable

Sex.: 66 are larger; 2 ° are fuller.

diet are important.

Soc. B.: Peaceful species which can be associated with larger fishes as long as they are not too restless.

M: Young do not have specific requirements. Large specimens have to be kept in large tanks. Prior to acquiring A. hystrix, the hobbyist should know where the fish will be housed in years to come (perhaps arrangements can be made with a public aquarium), Bogwood for rasping is a necessity, though its inclusion in the decor will not diminish damage to plants. Create hiding places among rocks and wood. Water values can be moderate, but soft water will surely be appreciated. Frequent water T: 22°-27°C,

size

makes

breeding in an aquarium dubious.

components

in its

S: On pages 432 and 503 of Vol. 2, an as yet undescribed species of the genus Acanthicus or Pseudacanthicus was erroneously presented by the name A. hystrix. Two color morphs of A. hystrix have been introduced to the trade, a brown and a black form. The black form

has a heavy “beard.” The attractive white-spotted species has been described by ISBRUCKER & NIJSSEN, 1988 as Acanthicus adonis. Acanthicus have two characteristic bladders in the roof of their skull that are similar to diving tanks.

L: 70 (106) cm, A: ca. 120 cm, R: b, D: 2-4 (S)

363

Fam.: Loricariidae

Suckermouth Catfishes

Subfam.: Ancistrinae

Lipa

wile bere? cas ead

Unique photos of Ancistrus dolichopterus spawning. Both sexes (2 right, 3 !eft) hold fast to each other for extended periods of time with interopercular hooks. This was interpreted by FRANKE (1985) as minor quarreling.

Fy i

Fas Sout

UR:

y Ae

Ancistrus sp. aff. A bristlenose

364

/eucostictus

3

Catfishes Fam.: Loricariidae

Suckermouth Catfishes

Subfam.: Ancistrinae

Ancistrus dolichopterus Big-fin bristienose Syn.: Xenocara dolichoptera, tomus

KNER, 1854 Chaetos-

dolichopterus.

Hab.: South America: Basin.

Brazil, Rio Negro

F.I.: Unknown.

Sex.: dd nave branched bristles on and along the edge of their head (the pictured animal is a full-grown 3). 22 do not have bristles on the head itself, and those along its edge are less developed.

Soc. B.: Although peaceful towards small fishes such as neons, tetras, etc., sexually active 6d may be aggressive towards conspecifics, particularly as they begin to spawn. Territorial. M: Water: pH 6.7-7.0; variable hardness. Prefers slight water movement. Large pieces of bogwood make ideal decorations. B: Forms pairs. Live foods are needed to ripen the breeders. Eggs are usually T: 22°-25°C,

laid in caves and depressions. Water hardness is not important, but the ideal

pH is between 6.5 and 7.0.

9?

guard

the eggs and care for them by fanning oxygen-rich water over them. Juveniles should be fed ground lettuce leaves and

peas. F: O; primarily omnivores. Small quantities of crustacea such as Daphnia and Cyclops can be added to the diet. Lettuce leaves and peas can provide part of the required vegetable fare.

S: Often confused with Ancistrus hoplogenys (GUNTHER, 1864), but the two are differently colored. A. dolichopterus is chiefly brown, while A. hoplogenys is blue-black.

L: 10 cm, A: 100 cm (max. 2 pairs), R: m, b, D: 1

365

Fam.: Loricariidae

Suckermouth

Catfishes

Subfam.: Ancistrinae

Ancistrus sp. cf. temminckii Temminck’s bristlenose Syn.: Hypostomus temminckii, tomus aculeatus, Hypostomus deri, Xenocara

(VALENCIENNES, Plecosschnei-

temminckii.

1840)

F: O; to ripen the breeding pairs, foods of animal origin should be added to the diet.

Hab.: South America: Guyana.

S: Identifying Ancistrus

F.1.: Unknown.

detailed morphological studies is very difficult. Hence the tentative identification of the pictured specimen.

Sex.: 22 have small, unbranched tentacles along the edge of the head. The pictured animal isa d. Soc. B.: specifics, cies. 36 very large with other serious

Peaceful towards all heteroincluding much smaller speare territorial and demand a tank if they are to be housed territorial catfishes to prevent

confrontations.

M: Small aquaria are inappropriate. Provide hiding places among roots, stones, flower pots, or coconut shells. Avoid extreme water values.

B: This species, like other Ancistrus, relatively easy to breed.

is

M22°=25°Cn Ey Orem, AS lO0'cim Raby Dan

366

species without

Catfishes Fam.: Loricariidae

Suckermouth Catfishes

Subfam.: Ancistrinae

(KNER, 1854)

Dekeyseria scaphirhyncha Flathead suckermouth

B: Unknown. Probably similar to Pecko/tia brevis; see Vol. 2, p. 512.

Syn.: Ancistrus scaphirhynchus, Hemiancistrus scaphirhynchus, Peckoltia scaphirhyncha, Peckoltia scaphyrhynchus. Hab.:

South

America:

F: H, O; algae! Plant fare such as lettuce, spinach, peas, and carrots as well as tablets and sunken vegetable flakes.

Brazil, Amazon

Basin, Rio Negro.

S: These fish can be enticed from their hiding place during the day with food if the aquarium is peaceful and dim. Floating plants can be used to minimize light penetration. Since members of the Peckoltia group do not grow very large,

F.1.: Unknown.

Sex.: Sexes

cannot

be distinguished

from external

characteristics.

Soc. B.: This peaceful species rarely exhibits territorial behavior or participates in intraspecific quarrels. Appropriate tankmates for peaceful fishes. M: Medium-sized aquarium with well-filtered water. Provide this twilight- and

night-active species with hiding places it can retire to during the day, such as below or within wood, rocks, or pipes. Avoid housing it with food competitors,

€.g., algivorous species. Plants are not damaged. Water: pH 5.0-7.0; hardness up to 16° dGH. We 222676)

they are better suited for small aquaria than large Hypostomus and Pterygoplichthys species. Because of their inability to successfully compete for food, special attention must be given to ensure their nutritional needs are met if they are not kept in a species tank. Feed during the evening hours so they do not wane! This species has a notoriously compressed body. See the picture on

the bottom of p. 373.

2 20icmy Anco chipRaOgDs2—3

367

Fam.: Loricariidae

Suckermouth Catfishes

Subfam.: Ancistrinae

Hemiancistrus annectens Syn.: Ancistrus annectens.

Hab.: South America: northwest Ecuador, San Javier and Rio Durango.

F.I.: Into England in 1986. Sex.: Unknown; external differences are probably absent.

Soc. B.: Relatively peaceful; aggressions only develop between 63 in very small aquaria where territories cannot be defended. Peaceful towards heterospecifics, M: See Hemiancistrus landoni. B: Unknown.

F: H, O; aufwuchs and algae. S: Hemiancictrus Peckoltia.

are closely related to

T: 22°-28°C, L: 18 cm, A: 100 cm, R: b, D: 2

368

(REGAN,

1904)

Catfishes Fam.: Loricariidae

Suckermouth Catfishes

Subfam.: Ancistrinae

EIGENMANN,

Hemiancistrus landoni Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: western Ecuador, in tributaries of the Rio Guayas at Naranjito and Babahoyo. F.1.: In 1985 by U. WERNER and R. STAWIKOWSKI. Sex.: Unknown.

1916

F: H, O; though H. /landoni is a specialized algivore and aufwuchs feeder, other foodstuffs, both vegetable and animal based, are not refused. S: H. landoni can easily be thought of as a Hypostomus species; but Hypostomus do not have hook-shaped spines on the interoperculum.

Soc. B.: Like other medium-sized Loricariidae. Occasional intraspecific quarrels of tail beatings and lateral threat behavior occur. Otherwise, these fish are peaceful and totally harmless. Wellsuited for community tanks. M: H. landoni hails from clear, clean flowing waters which are soft and almost neutral. Their colors pale, and they

become lethargic when housed in “old” or medicated water. Include wood and, more importantly, many large, smooth stones in the decor. B: Unknown.

T: 24°-28°C,

L: at least 25 cm, A: 100 cm, R: b, D: 2

369

Suckermouth Catfishes

Fam.: Loricariidae

STEINDACHNER,

Hypoptopoma carinatum Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: the Amazon der.

1879

Subfam.: Hypoptopomatinae Otocinclus paulinus REGAN, 1908. The in a tributary of

River at the Peruvian

bor-

F.l.: 1974.

primary difference between Hypoptopoma and Otocinclus are the ventrally positioned eyes of the former. The presence or absence of an adipose fin does not identify these fishes to genus level.

Sex.: Adult @ 2 are larger and fuller than 3d. Soc. B.: Peaceful animals; Keep a group. M: See Otocinclus leucofrenatus, p. 376.

B: Unknown; see Ofocinclus flexilis, Vol. 2, p. 508. F: H; feeds on aufwuchs (algae and their accompanying microorganisms). Tablet and sunken flake foods are also accepted. S: Similar to Otocinclus notatus; see Vol. 2, p. 508. Repeatedly confused with T: 20°-25°C,

L: 5 cm, A: 60 cm, R: b, all, D:3

Hypostomus regani

(v. IHERING, 1905)

Regan’s hypostomus

Subfam.: Hypostominae

Syn.: Plecostomus regani. Hab.: South America: caba, Sao Paulo.

Brazil, Rio Piraci-

F.1.: Unknown.

Sex.: Unknown. Soc. B.: Peaceful towards other fishes, even if smaller. Since most Loricariidae are territorial, only keep single specimens in average-sized tanks.

M: Decorate the aquarium with tough plants and bogwood. Soft plants are eaten when the diet does not contain enough vegetable matter. Water: pH 6— 7; hardness up to 15° dGH. B: Unknown.

F:H, O; besides algae, vegetable fare and plant based flake foods (Tetra Conditioning Food) should be offered. Feed live foods such as Tubifex and frozen mosquito larvae occasionally.

T: 22°-25°C, L: 30 cm, perhaps larger, A:

370

2m, R: b, D: 4 (S)

Catfishes

Hypostomus

regani

Fam.: Loricariidae

Suckermouth Catfishes (STEINDACHNER,

lsorineloricaria spinosissima Spiny suckermouth catfish Syn.: /sorineloricaria festae, Plecostomus spinosissimus, P. festae. Hab.: South America: Ecuador, west of the Andes in the Guayas Basin, Rio Daule and Rio Peripa.

F.I.: In 1985 by U. WERNER and R. STAWIKOWSKI. Sex.: dd have long needlelike odontodes and long spines on the hard fin rays. Soc. B.: This ful, and shy, ter becoming ment, chiefly tankmates to

1880)

Subfam.: Hypostominae

species is sedate, peaceonly emerging for food afacclimated to its environduring evening hours. Limit peaceful species.

B: Unknown.

F: H, O; though a specialized algivore and aufwuchs feeder, other foods of vegetable or animal origin are accepted. S: In nature, this species grows up to 60 cm in length. At that size, dd are so spiny they cannot be captured with an unprotected hand or a net. The pictured animal is a juvenile with as yet invisible spines.

M: Undemanding and adapting. Water: PH around 7; hardness up to 15° dGH. Use plenty of wood and rocks as decoration. These items should be arranged to form secluded areas. Clear, well-filtered, oxygen-rich water is required.

T: 24°-30°C, L: 60 (30) cm, A: 150 cm, R: b, D: 2-3

Lasiancistrus carnegiei (no photo) Carnegie’s suckermouth Syn.: Pseudancistrus

carnegiei.

Hab.: South America: Colombia, in the Rio Magdalena Basin at Santander. F.1.: Unknown.

Sex.: dd have longer pectoral fin rays; the interopercular spines typically found

in this subfamily are longer on ¢ 2. Soc. B.: Peaceful towards all other fishes. Adult ¢¢3, however, will defend a territory against conspecifics congeners as well.

and

possibly

M: Well-planted aquaria with bogwood and hiding places. When fed an ad-

(EIGENMANN,

S: The genus Lasiancistrus differs from most other similar genera by the greater number of dorsal fin rays (10, rarely 9) and hence its notoriously broader dorsal fin. The thick odontodes along the pectoral spines of Lasiancistrus are a valid characteristic to distinguish members of that genus from the virtually identical Dolichancistrus.

equate diet, plants are left undisturbed.

Water: pH 6-7; hardness up to 20° dGH. Large 6d can only be housed together in large tanks. B: Unknown; however, it should be similar to representatives of the genus Ancistrus (see Vol. 2, p. 502).

T: 22°-26°C, L: 14 cm, A: 80 cm, R: b, D: 2-3

372

1916)

Subfam.: Ancistrinae F: O; plant based foods, including blanched lettuce and vegetable flakes. Feed live or frozen foods such as Tubifex and frozen mosquito larvae once a week.

Catfishes

Isorineloricaria

spinosissima

Suckermouth Catfishes

Fam.: Loricariidae Leporacanthicus galaxias. See p. 386. Lithoxus lithoides Rock suckermouth Syn.: None.

Hab.: South America: Suriname and Guyana, in the Sand Creek and Rupununi River. Lives in fast-flowing waters near waterfalls. F.1.: Unknown.

Sex.: The d's first pectoral fin ray is enlarged and covered with odontodes (see photos). Soc. B.: Peaceful, spawning.

EIGENMANN, 1910 Subfam.: Ancistrinae F: H, O; aufwuchs feeder. Algae, peas, carrots, tablet foods, and blanched lettuce and spinach leaves are accepted. Animal fare must also be offered. S: Sadly, this interesting rheophilic fish is rarely imported. Lithoxus bovalli (REGAN, 1906) is very similar. BOESEMANN described three additional new LithoxuS species in 1983.

but territorial when

M: Requires large aquaria, a current, and cool, oxygen-rich water. Provide vegetation and plenty of hiding places among rocks, bogwood, and coconut shells. Similar to Ancistrus in other regards. B: Unknown.

T: 18°-22°C, D: 2-3

L: 9 cm,

A: 80 cm,

R: b,

Lithoxus lithoides,

°

ISBRUCKER,

Loricaria nickeriensis Nickerie suckermouth Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: Suriname, Nickerie

River and Tjawassi Creek, a tributary of the Nickerie below the Lombok waterfalls. Lives in fast-flowing waters over sand and stone substrates.

F.1.: Unknown.

F: O; aufwuchs feeder.

S: Few specimens of this interesting species have been imported to date.

Sex.: d d have an enlarged lower lip. Soc. B.: Like other members of this fam-

ily, L. nickeriensis

is an amiable

spe-

cies.

M: Do not keep in densely populated aquaria. High oxygen levels, frequent water exchanges, and strong filtration are necessary. Water: pH 6.2-7.2; hardness up to 14° dGH. This nocturnal creature needs plethoric plants and bogwood

to retire to during the day. B: Has not been successful. T: 20°-24°C, Dr2

374

L: 15 cm,

22

prob-

A: 80 cm,

R: b,

1979

Subfam.: Loricariinae ably lay their eggs in one cluster which is sucked up and guarded by the o until the young hatch.

Loricaria

nickeriensis,

ventral

view

Catfishes

Lithoxus

lithoides

Loricaria

nickeriensis

Suckermouth Catfishes

Fam.: Loricariidae

FOWLER,

Monistiancistrus carachama Black suckermouth catfish, carachama Syn.: Pogonopomoides parahybae, nelepis carachama.

Rhi-

Hab.: South America: east Peru, Conta-

mana and the Rio Ucayali Basin. F.1.: Unknown. Sex.: Unknown.

Soc. B.: Peaceful. Adults are loners (see Ancistrus, Vol. 1, p. 486).

M: Requires oxygen-rich, fast-flowing, clean water. While moderate water values are suitable, soft water corresponds the closest to values found in its native habitat. Twilight- and night-active. Hiding places are needed for daylight hours.

Clean water is important, since this catfish is susceptible to bacterial infections. The presence of bogwood seems to curb its appetite for aquatic plants. Feed in

1940

Subfam.: Hypostominae the evening just prior to turning the lights off. B: Unknown. F: H, O; algae,

blanched

lettuce,

and

spinach leaves. Flake foods and tablets will be eaten from the bottom. Animal based foods must be offered occasionally. S: Monistiancistrus is a monotypic genus; that is, it only contains one species, M. carachama. Monistiancistrus, Rhinelepis, and Pseudorinelepis all have a round iris, unlike most of their loricariid brothers which have an omega-shaped iris! However, due to its taxonomic position, M. carachama should not have this deviant feature. It is now known that the iris lobe disappears in the dark, but reappears under intense illumination.

T: 20°-24°C, L: 11 cm, A: 80 cm, R: b, D: 1-2

MIRANDA-RIBEIRO,

Otocinclus leucofrenatus

1908

Subfam.: Hypoptopomatinae Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: Brazil. F.I.: Unknown. Sex.: 2 2 are fuller and larger.

Soc. B.: Adult 3d are solitary abiding animals. Younger animals do best, however, when kept in a small group. An apt companion for small, peaceful fishes.

as well as flake foods will be eaten from the substrate.

S: Mature yet clean aquaria are demanded by this sensitive Otocinclus species. New acquisitions have to be handled with particular care.

M: This small, peaceful. Otocinclus needs a well-planted aquarium with plenty of algae. The water should be strongly filtered and clear. Filtering over peat or adding peat extracts is advantageous. Water: pH 5.0-7.0; hardness up to 16° dGH; carbonate hardness to 6° dKH.

B: Unknown. Probably similar to OtocinClus flexilis; see Vol. 2, p. 508. Compare this species to O. affinis, Vol. 1, p. 492. F: H; aufwuchs (algae and the microorganisms contained therein). Tablet foods T: 20°-25°C,

376

L: 7 cm, A: 60 cm, R: b, all, D: 3

Catfishes

Monistiancistrus

Otocinclus

carachama

/eucofrenatus

Fam.: Loricariidae

Suckermouth Catfishes REGAN, 1904

Otocinclus vittatus

Subfam.: Hypoptopomatinae Syn.: Otocinclus macrospilus, O. mariae. Hab.: South America: Paraguay, in the Rio Paraguay; Peru, in the Amazon River; Bolivia, in the Rio Chimore;

Brazil, in the

Descalvados, Mato Grosso region. Often inhabits heavily vegetated sections of clear, fast-flowing creeks. F.1.: Ca. 1921.

Sex.: 2 2 are notably fuller than 3d.

Soc. B.: Peaceful. Often found with related species in numerous small schools in localized areas. Well-suited for community tanks containing small fishes. M: Plant the tank densely. The substrate should be dark and partially shaded by roots and rocks. Requires clear, oxygen-rich water and current. Water: pH 6.0-7.5; hardness of 2°-18° dGH. If adequate quantities of algae are not of-

fered, young fish may damage plant leaves.

delicate

B: Possible. Eggs are adhered to plants and the glass. The fry hatch after 2-3 days and can be reared on hard-boiled egg yolk, infusoria, rock-encrusting §algae, and Artemia. F: O; algae, tablets, and small flake and live foods (Artemia). S: This cute fish is inactive during diurnal hours, only becoming active during the evening. Unlike Otocinclus affinis, O. vittatus does not have a large black spot on the caudal peduncle. See Vol. 1, p. 492.

T: 20°-25°C, L: 5.5 cm, A: 60 cm, R: m,

Parancistrus aurantiacus Gold-fin suckermouth

(CASTELNAU, 1855) Subfam.: Ancistrinae

Syn.: Acanthodermus aurantiacus, Ancistrus aurantiacus, A. nigricans, Hypostomus aurantiacus, Parancistrus_nigricans, Peckoltia aurantiaca.

Cryptocoryne or extremely fast-growing vegetation. Provide a layer of floating plants. The water should be moderately hard and slightly acid. Homemade feed-

Hab.: South America: Peru, Rio Ucayali. F.1.: Unknown.

ing substrates can be made by encrusting rocks with a paste of vegetables, plant flake foods, etc., and allowing it to

Sex.: Sexes are difficult to distinguish. 3d have thick spines on the first hard ray of the pectoral fins. 22 also have spines.

dry before introducing it to the aquarium. Feed in the evenings.

Soc. B.: P. aurantiacus’s amiable nature makes it an appropriate addition to com-

munity aquaria. d¢ may become aggressive towards each other and other Loricariidae in confining spaces.

B: Unknown.

F: H, O; algae! Tablets and animal fare should also be offered every 2-3 days. Any vegetable can be tried (parboiled). Try as many types of food as possible! P. aurantiacus, like most Loricariidae, readily eats peeled cucumbers.

M: Clean, well-filtered, oxygen-rich water is important. Offer bogwood as a rasping medium, but do not expect this to curb its tendency to chew on tender plants and rasp large leaves. Only use hard-leaved plants such as Anubias or T222=27°C,

378

Li iSiempA: 1O0rem, Re ba Da2=3

Catfishes

Parancistrus

aurantiacus

~

Fam.: Loricariidae

Suckermouth Catfishes

Subfam.: Ancistrinae

Baryancistrus niveatus

(CASTELNAU, 1855)

Snowflake bristlenose Syn.: Hypostomus niveatus, Ancistrus niveatus, Cheatostomus niveatus, “Hypostomus margaretifer", Parancistrus niveatus. Hab.: South America: Brazil, guay, in the Goyaz Province.

Rio Ara-

F.1.: 1981 into Great Britain.

Sex.: Unknown.

Soc. B.: Shy reclusive fish. M: Oxygen-rich water is recommended. Limiting the number of plants will reduce the chance of P. niveatus either eating or uprooting them. Water: pH 6.5-7.0; hardness of 8°-10° dGH. B: Unknown. Ree S: The presence of interopercular spines precludes this fish from being a Hypostomus. T: 22°-24°C, L: 20 cm, A: 150 cm, R: b, D: 2-3

Pseudacanthicus spinosus

(CASTELNAU, 1855)

Syn.: Hypostomus spinosus, Chaetostomus spinosus, Hemiancistrus spino-

sus.

simple.

Hab.: South America: Rio Torbes, noco system in Venezuela.

Ori-

F.1.: By A.WERNER in 1984. Sex.: dd have odontodes on the pectoral fins and elevated eye sockets.

Soc. B.: Peaceful community fish. Adult 3d

B: Breeding successes have been coincidental. Rearing the young is said to be

may sometimes

claim small territo-

ries and aggressively defend them against conspecifics. Largely similar to Chaetostomus.

F: O, H; primarily algae, but plant fare such as blanched lettuce or spinach is also consumed. Tablet and flake foods are eaten from the substrate. Feed animal based foods often.

S: Members of this genus are difficult to impossible to identify to species level by photograph. The type specimen of the genus is P. histrix, which VALENCIENNES described from a drawing he received.

M: House in spacious aquaria that have clear, oxygen-rich water. Hiding places, robust vegetation along the tank’s sides, and floating plants induce a feeling of security for these animals. This catfish, though predominately twilight- and nightactive, will approach food items during the day. T: 20°-24°C, L: 12 cm, A: 120 cm, R:b, D: 3-4

380

Catfishes

Pseudacanthicus

spinosus

Pterygoplichthys

in Hawaii

In 1989 the journal of the Catfish Association of Great Britain contained an interesting article about Pterygoplichthys (probably multiradiatus). In 1986, Pterygoplichthys were discovered in reservoirs in Hawaii, probably having been released by Hawaiian aquarists. Initial attention was drawn to them when anglers caught a 31 cm long specimen in January of 1986 in the Wahiawa Reservoir on Oahu, the largest island of Hawaii. Later, as additional specimens were captured, they were found to be widely distributed. In fact, the young suckermouth cats covered almost all submersed wood and other hard substrates. A light shone into the water at night easily pinpointed the location of the numerous catfish, since their irises reflected red. Their eyes looked like countless underwater lasers. The fish excavate tunnels where they live and spawn. Heiko Bleher took photographs of one such tunnel (Vol. 2, p. 515). The tunnel’s dimensions is indicative of the animal’s size. Spawning occurs at depths of up to 60 cm (2 ft) between the months of June and October on Hawaii. The eggs are laid and fertilized within the tunnel which is constructed by the 3. Here he guards the eggs and hatched fry until they are free-swimming and abandon the tunnel. One clutch can contain anywhere between 400 and 1000 yellow to orange eggs. The egg’s coloration depends on the stage of development. It is said that these eggs are very tasty when salted and prepared according to a Chinese recipe. Most of the animals in the reservoir were 25 to 45 cm long, the longest being 65 cm. Additional catfish species such as Ancistrus and Hypostomus have now been discovered in Hawaiian reservoirs as well. The fish are not appreciated, even though they do not disturb the native population, since they fill a previously unoccupied niche. Despite their tasty meat (bake in foil and carefully break the tail section open), they have absolutely no appeal to sports fishermen. Photos have shown that the larvae of Pterygoplichthys form a sphere inside the cave. We are confident that those of you who wish to read the original article will be able to receive a copy

382

Catfishes through the British Catfish Association, Gian Sandford, 5 Sparrow's Mead, Gb-Redhill, Surrey RH1 2EJ (include return postage). Perhaps some readers would like to try breeding Pterygoplichthys in an aquarium. | would suggest a large tank of at least 500-1000 | and a lateral wall with 30 cm of unfired clay (brickmaking industry). Drill a cave into the clay that corresponds to the size of your captive Pterygoplichthys. Of course, t will be difficult to find a suitable breeding pair, but it should be possible to achieve either through the British Catfish Association or your local catfish association. The water chemistry is probably not overly important. A pH of between 6 and 7 and a hardness of 6° to 12° dGH should be within the tolerance values of these Loricariidae. | offer my Pterygoplichthys sections of drainage pipes which are available in various diameters. One of my Pterygoplichthys has a 30 cm long clay pipe with an inner diameter of 10 cm. The fish itself is about the same length. The clay will increase the water's turbidity, so | do not consider peat-filtered water a necessity. The animals do not seem to be shy in front of bright illumination. My animals emerge during the day for food, even though there are two 125 W mercury lights illuminating the 500 | tank. The high intensity is great for growing algae. In the aforementioned

aquarium,

| also

keep

Sturisoma

aureum.

However,

de-

spite the high light intensity, | do not have any algae growth in this tank. The catfish must be grazing everything. | have fed my Loricariidae exclusively on frozen peas and TetraTips for years, but they also accept mosquito larvae and leftover flake foods. For information concerning rearing the young, see the breeding report given under Sturisoma aureum in Vola2ps.020.

383

~

Fam.: Loricariidae

Suckermouth Catfishes

Subfam.: Hypostominae

(SPIX, 1829)

Pterygoplichthys etentaculatus Syn.: Hypostoma etentaculatum, Hypostomus duodecimalis, Ancistrus longimanus. Hab.: South America: Sao Francisco.

Brazil, in the Rio

F.|.: Unknown.

S: Not all have an adipose fin, as demonstrated by a 40 mm juvenile. cise identification of this species is cult because the holotype that

was Prediffiwas

stored in Munich was destroyed during WWII.

Sex.: Unknown.

Soc. B.: There is no information available, but it should be similar to most other Pterygoplichthys species.

M: House in spacious, well-filtered aquaria that have a current, vegetation around the edges, and a cave, e.g., a section of drainage pipe. B: Unknown.

F: H; vegetable foods such as lettuce and peas and small amounts of animal

based

foods.

T: 22°-25°C, L: 40 cm, A: 150 cm, R: b, D: 2-3

Glyptoperichthys sp. cf. lituratus Spotted sailfin sucker catfish Syn.: None. Hab.: Southamerica, Peru, Cocha Supay and Trueno Cocha, Cafho Supay near Jenaro Herrera at Rio Ucajali. F.I.: This new, undescribed species has not been imported.

S: Juveniles and adults are differently colored. Juveniles have red or orangefringed black spots and bands. In con-

Apparently, Glyptoperichthys do not have much longevity. Six to eight years seems to be their maximum age in an aquarium. They have been successfully bred in an aquarium. The photo was taken at Cocha Supay, Peru. B: Unknown. Fx©}

trast, the upper ray of the caudal fin, the

first ray of the dorsal fin, and the first ray of the ventral fins are intense red-orange on adult specimens (3?). See DATZ Sonderheft Harnischwelse, Sept. 92; UImer Verlag. T: 24°-28°C,

384

L: 40 cm and more, A: 100 cm and more, R: b, D: 3-4

Catfishes

&

Glyptoperichthys

sp. cf. lituratus

Fam.: Loricariidae

Suckermouth Catfishes

Leporacanthicus galaxias Galactical suckermouth Syn.: None.

ISBRUCKER & NIJSSEN, 1989 Subfam.: Ancistrinae S: L. galaxias is capable of extending

Hab.: South America: Brazil, in the Amazon Basin and Rio Tocantins. Lives in

its upper mandible until it looks like a trunk. This suckermouth cat has uncommon dentition: 10 long teeth in the lower mandible and 2 in the upper. Its attractive coloration is reminiscent of Acanthicus hystrix.

roaring rapids. F.I.: 1987 by A. WERNER. Sex.: Unknown. Soc. B.: Peaceful.

M: The

aquarium

has to be at least

120 cm long. Use rocks or, better, bog-

wood to create hiding niches. Mediumhard to soft water with a pH of 6.2-7.2 is best. According to conditions in their natural habitat, oxygen-rich, well- filtered water is necessary. See STAWIKOWSKI, DATZ, 1/1988, p. 44. B: Unknown.

F: H; feeds on aufwuchs, etable fare, and tablets.

algae, veg-

T: 22°-25°C, L: 40 cm (?), A: 120 cm, R: b, D:3

Ricola macrops Syn.: Loricaria macrops. Hab.: South America: Uruguay and Argentina, in the lower Rio Parana and the Rio de la Plata. F.1.: Unknown.

Sex.: The ¢'s dorsal fin spine is slightly thicker than its consort’s. Unlike Rineloricaria, 63 do not have a beard.

Soc. B.: This peaceful species is a good companion for similarly-natured fishes, regardless of size. Sexually mature 3 do not claim territories; confrontations between 3 are rather harmless.

M: Well-filtered, oxygen-rich water is the most important aspect for successful care. Plants can be included in the decor. Place flat stones on a fine-grained gravel substrate. Hiding places are not necessary. Water: pH 6-7; hardness 5° 15° dGH.

(REGAN, 1904) Subfam.: Loricariinae spawners of this subfamily (see Sturisoma), either on stone plates or large plant leaves. The yellowish eggs form an elongated clump which the ¢ picks up with his mouth and carries until they hatch. F: O; besides vegetable fare (algae and blanched spinach), animal based foods are readily accepted.

S: ISBRUCKER and NIJSSEN established the genus Ricola in 1978. Ricola can be distinguished from Loricaria by morphological aspects. Ricola have heavily bifurcated barbels (even more than Loricaria nickeriensis) and larger fins. Its uncommon reproductive behavior combined with its rarity in pet stores makes breeding attempts doubly worth-

while.

B: Has been repeatedly bred in captivity. These fish spawn like other open T: 20°-24°C,

386

L: 27 cm, A: 100 cm, R: b, m, D: 2-3

Catfishes

Leporacanthicus

Ricola macrops

galaxias

~

Suckermouth Catfishes

Fam.: Loricariidae Subfam.: Loricariinae

ISBRUCKER & NIJSSEN, 1985

Rineloricaria castroi Castro’s whiptail catfish Syn.: None.

F: H, O; aufwuchs.

Hab.: South America.

S: Similar species or forms have been repeatedly imported.

F.1.: Unknown.

Sex.:

do have a “beard.”

Soc. B.: Peaceful. M: As for other Loricariinae; see loricaria heteroptera for specific

Rineinfor-

mation.

B: Has been successfully bred in captivity. Pipes or bamboo are preferentially chosen as spawning sites. The approximately 100 eggs are guarded by the d. After about 7 days, the fry hatch and are free-swimming after an additional 3 to 5 days. Feed the young live plankton, algae, and mashed peas. See S. aureum, Vol. 2, p. 520, for details on how to rear the young. T: 20°-24°C,

L: 14 cm, A: 80 cm, R: b, m; D: 2

ISBRUCKER & NIJSSEN, 1976

Rineloricaria heteroptera Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: near Manaus.

Brazil,

in waters

F.1.: Unknown.

Sex.: Older, full-grown od have a “beard” of bristles (odontodes) along the edge of their head and the anterior edge of their pectoral fins. 22 never have a “beard,” Soc. B.: Peaceful, but several dd can only be kept for extended periods of time in large aquaria. Each catfish requires its own hiding place! Only associate with tranquil fishes.

rocks and bogwood should be included in the tank's decor. B: Unknown, but probably similar to that of Sturisoma aureum. See Vol. 2, p. 518. F: H, O; aufwuchs.

S: Very similar to R. lanceolata. See Vol.

2, p. 518.

M: Though a species tank is ideal, it can be maintained in sparsely populated community: aquaria. A strong water current and a high capacity filter help meet this fish’s oxygen demand. Water: pH 6.2-7.2; hardness up to 14° dGH; carbonate hardness up to 6° dKH. Dense vegetation and hiding places among T: 20°-25°C, L: 26 cm, A: 80 cm, R: b, m, D: 2-3

388

Catfishes

Rineloricaria

Rineloricaria

castroi

heteroptera

.

Suckermouth Catfishes

Fam.: Loricariidae Subfam.: Loricariinae

FOWLER,

Rineloricaria morrowi Yellow suckermouth catfish Syn.: None.

1940

Hab.: South America: Peru, Sira Mountains. See FOERSCH and HANRIEDER, Aquarien-Magazin 12/1980, pp. 686 ff.

F.1.: 1980 by FOERSCH and HANRIEDER. Sex.: So far, only “bearded” 3d have been imported. Soc. B.: Peaceful.

M: As for all Loricariinae. See caria heteroptera for details.

Rinelori-

B: Unknown.

F: H, O; aufwuchs.

S: Unfortunately, this attractive species has only been imported once (dd). T: 20°-24°C,

L: 12 cm, A: 80 cm, R: b, D: 2-3

Rineloricaria teffeana Tefe suckermouth catfish Syn.: Loricaria teffeana, L. valenciennesii, L. typus. Hab.: South America: Peru, in fast flowing waters. The type locality is the Amazon River at Tefé. F.1.: Unknown.

Sex.: The 3’s head is broader. Sexing R. teffeana is a difficult task, but only because additional differentiating characteristics are still unknown. Soc. B.: A peaceful species. Keep in a species tank when attempting to breed them. R. teffeana is eminently suitable for community tanks containing small fishes as long as appropriate water conditions are maintained. M: R. teffeana requires hiding places of wood, rocks, bamboo, or plastic tubes (only use the nontoxic gray plastic!), clean oxygen-rich water, and current. When the water is low in oxygen, these animals fasten themselves to the glass T: 20°-25°C, L: 16 cm, A: 80 cm, R: b, D: 3

390

(STEINDACHNER,

1879)

pane just below the water surface. If corrective measures are not taken, they soon perish. At least one meal per day must be given during the evening to guarantee that A. teffeana receives sufficient food. Thin, undernourished fish often go undetected because of the armored body. The aquarium can be wellplanted, since plants are not bothered. Unfortunately for tank maintenance, not even algae are proficiently eaten. A soft, perhaps sandy, substrate permits the catfish to dig. Water: pH 5.6-7.0; hardness up to 16° dGH; carbonate haraness of 7° dKH. B: Unknown.

Probably similar to Rinelo-

ricaria fallax (see Vol. 1, p. 498). F: H, O; plant fare, algae, tablet foods, small live foods, and sunken flakes.

S: Although the black-edged reddish fins are quite appealing to aquarists, these animals are rarely seen in pet stores.

Catfishes

Rineloricaria

morrowi

Rineloricaria

teffeana

391

~

Fam.:

Loricariidae

Suckermouth Catfishes

Subfam.: Loricariinae

Rineloricaria

teffeana

Sturisomatichthys leightoni

392

@

Catfishes Fam.: Loricariidae

Suckermouth Catfishes

Subfam.: Loricariinae

Sturisomatichthys leightoni 3 guarding a spawn

Sturisomatichthys leightoni Syn.: Sturisoma leightoni, Loricaria leightoni, Oxyloricaria leightoni. Hab.: South America: Colombia, Rio Magdalena at Honda. in fast-flowing waters. F.1.: Unknown.

Sex.: The 2's first dorsal fin ray as well as its upper and lower caudal fin rays are very elongated. dd have facial odontodes, whereas °? do not (see photo). Soc. B.: Peaceful.

M: Dedicated hiding places are not required. Average water chemistry values. B: W. FOERSCH has successfully bred

(REGAN, 1912) The eggs darken over time. At 24°C, the young hatch after about one week. Juveniles are dark brown with spotted fins and light stripes along their dorsum. Rear the young with blanched spinach, Artemia nauplii, and pieces of tablet food. After 8 months, the young exceed 8 cm in length and are sexually mature. F: H: aufwuchs, spinach, peas, tablet foods, and sunken flake foods. S: Unfortunately, this beautiful and interesting species has disappeared from the hobby. When imports are renewed, breeders should do their best to assure that the hobby has a steady source of this lovely fish.

this species. It spawns on open Ssurfaces, never in secluded locals. A maximum of 65, 2 mm, yellow-brown eggs are laid by the 2, but guarded by the ¢. T: 20°-24°C,

L: 15 cm, A: 80 cm, R: b, D: 2

393

Fam.: Malapteruridae

Electric Catfishes

Malapterurus microstoma Small electric catfish

POLL & GOSSE, 1969

Syn.: None. Hab.: Tropical Africa: Zaire Basin. F.1.: Unknown.

Sex.: There are no distinguishing external characteristics. Soc. B.: Solitary, nocturnal, predatory fish. Limit care to one individual, since neither conspecifics nor heterospecifics can be housed with M. microstoma. M: Only suitable for show aquaria with a volume of at least 500 |. Juveniles should not be purchased unless you know beforehand what you will do with the colossal fish it turns into. A zoo might be able to help you. Strong filtration is important because of their large dietary intake.

foods can be fed. Juveniles also accept flakes and tablets. S: Although this species does not grow as large as Malapterurus electricus (see Vol. 1, p. 500), it can only be appropriately housed in show aquaria. Impulses of up to 450 volts are produced by this catfish as either a defense mechanism or to stun or kill prey. Caution is advised when handling this catfish. Do not startle the fish!

B: Unknown.

F: C; live foods such as fishes, insects, and worms. Lean meat and commercial

T: 23°-28°C, L: 70 cm, A: 120 cm, R: b, D: 3 (S)

394

|

Catfishes

Fam.: Mochokidae

Mn.

Chiloglanis

cameronensis

Chiloglanis deckenii,

ventral view

Upside-Down Catfishes

ns

~

Upside-Down Catfishes

Fam.: Mochokidae Subfam.: Chiloglanidinae

PETERS, 1868

Chiloglanis deckenii Syn.: Synodontis eurystomus Hab.: East Africa: Kenya and Tanzania, usually in fast-flowing waters.

F.1.: Unknown; SEEGERS.

definitely

Sex.: Sexually mature

by 1985

by

2 & are fuller.

Soc. B.: Peaceful, social fish.

M: Provide good filtration, vegetation, and some bogwood. Water: pH 6.0-7.2; hardness up to 15° dGH. B: Unknown.

F: H, O; algae and aufwuchs as well as flake, live, and frozen foods. S: Species identification of the pictured animal is not definite. There is still significant taxonomic confusion within this genus. T: 20°-26°C, L: 7 cm, A: 60 cm, R: m, D: Zo

Chiloglanis cf. neumanni

BOULENGER,

1911

Syn.: None, since it may as yet be an undescribed species.

F: H, O; aufwuchs (algae), insect vae, flake foods, and tablets.

Hab.: East Africa: Tanzania, fast-flowing waters.

S: Identification of the pictured animal as C. neumanni is still unsure, since exact studies are still missing. Certain features of this animal do not correspond to the original description by BOULENGER, namely the shape of the fins (pointed according to BOULENGER, but clearly rounded in this fish) and the coloration. Not even the number of species within the genus Chiloglanis is known. The

F.I.: Unknown.

However,

mostly

in

this form was

imported in 1987 by SEEGERS. Sex.: Adult 2 2 are fuller. Soc. B.: Amiable social fish. Even smallest heterospecific fishes are molested.

the not

M: Although most Chiloglanis species prefer fast-flowing waters, SEEGERS discovered that this species also inhabited almost static waters and even swamps,

meaning they are very adaptive fish. However,..good filtration and a current are recommended. Bogwood, plants, and a dark substrate should be the basis of the decor. Water: pH 6.0-7.5; hardness to 15° dGH. B: Not known.

T: 20°-26°C, L: 5 cm, A: 60 cm, R: m, D: 2-3

396

lar-

number fluctuates between 13 (SANDS) and 34 (GOSSE, Checklist of Freshwater Fishes of Africa), whereby the latter probably includes all mentioned “species” without further consideration. However, the existence of additional species beyond those described to date is not out of the realm of possibilities.

Catfishes

j

Chiloglanis deckenii,

Athi River, Kenya

Chiloglanis cf. neumanni

Fam.: Mochokidae

Upside-Down Catfishes

Subfam.: Mochokinae

Synodontis caudovittatus White-finned synodontis

BOULENGER,

1901

BOULENGER,

1900

Syn.: None. Hab.: Africa: upper Nile, Sudan, and Uganda. Inhabits large bodies of water. F.1.: Unknown.

Sex.: Unknown.

Soc. B.: Though peaceful, do not house with small fishes, since they could be considered food items. M: Maintenance is nonproblematic. A dark gravel substrate is best. The vegetation along the back of the tank should be dense, perhaps potted, and composed of tough plants. Water: pH 6.57.5; hardness to 18° dGH. B: Unknown.

F: C, O; primarily worms and insect larvae, but tablets and frozen foods are also accepted in captivity. TPe2t°-24°C,

25 cm, A: 120!cm, Reb, m, D2

Synodontis granulosus Granular synodontis Syn.: None, but the name is sometimes erroneously written S. granilosus. Hab.: Africa: endemic nyika. This underwater taken at Kigoma.

to Lake Tangaphotograph was

F.1.: 1983 into England. Sex.: Unknown.

Soc. B.: Peaceful, but generally resides alone in nature. M: See Synodontis multipunctatus, B: Unknown. EKG),

S: One of the world’s most uncommon catfishes. Rarely encountered in its natural habitat. T: 22°-26°C, L: 27 cm, A: 150 cm, R:b, m, D:3

398

Catfishes

Synodontis

caudovittatus

Synodontis granulosus

in its natural habitat

=

~

Upside-Down Catfishes

Fam.: Mochokidae Subfam.: Mochokinae

ABU GIDEIRI, 1967

Synodontis cf. khartoumensis Syn.: None. Hab.: Africa: White Nile.

F.l.: Has not been imported into central Europe. Sex.: Unknown.

Soc. B.: Though peaceful, may be considered prey.

small fishes

M: No particular demands, but each fish should have at least one hiding place. B: Unknown. =e ©

S: The pictured specimen is a 6 cm long juvenile. Since coloration and fin shape may change as the fish matures, species identification is tentative. T: 23°-26°C, L: 30 cm, A: 150 cm, R: b, m, D: 2

Synodontis cf. koensis Syn.: Synodontis tourei. Hab.: West Africa: Guinea and the Ivory Coast, in the Nzo and Ko Rivers. F.1.: Unknown.

Sex.: While sexes normally cannot be distinguished, °° surely have a larger girth during the spawning season. Soc. B.: Peaceful towards heterospecific tankmates. Conspecifics frequently quarrel.

PELLEGRIN, 1933 highly developed stuffs.

S: While the pictured animal was identified by POLL as being S. koensis, its design differs somewhat from others of that species. Furthermore, there are differences in the cephalic armor and nuchal shield morphology between S. cf. koensis and S. koensis, although they seem to be closely related.

M: Found over mud substrates in its natural biotope. Of course, mud makes an unsuitable substrate in the aquarium, so another loose medium must be used,

Provide good filtration. Plants should be potted. Water: soft to medium-hard (up to 18° dGH); pH 6.5 to 7.2. B: Has not been bred in captivity. F: C, O; benthic insect larvae (frozen bloodworms are voraciously eaten) and leftover flake foods. This species has a T: 22°-25°C, L: 15 cm, A: 120 cm, R:b, D: 2

400

ability to locate food-

Catfishes

Synodontis cf. khartoumensis

e.

Synodontis

cf. koensis



~

Upside-Down Catfishes

Fam.: Mochokidae Subfam.: Mochokinae

Synodontis macrops Large-eyed synodontis

GREENWOOD,

Syn.: None. Hab.: Africa: Uganda, Basin.

1963

small dark dots and a shorter body. These differences are enough to make it a species in its own right.

in the upper Nile

F.1.: Not known.

Sex.: Sexes cannot be distinguished by external characteristics. Soc. B.: Peaceful, yet housing this fish with fishes less than 3 cm long is inadvisable. M: As for other Synodontis species. Water: 0H 6.5-7.5; hardness to 18° dGH. B: Not known.

F: C, O; insect larvae, flake foods, and tablets.

S: &. macrops is incredibly similar to Synodontis schall. Their similarities aside, S. macrops is lighter colored with T: 20°-24°C, L: 18 cm, A: 120 cm, R: b, D:2

Synodontis marmoratus Marble synodontis

LONNBERG, 1895

Syn.: None. Hab.: Africa: Cameroon. F.1.: 1988 as Synodontis schoutedeni. Sex.: None known.

Soc.

B.: Aggressive

fishes

are unsuit-

able tankmates for this peaceful catfish.

M: Needs at least one corner of fine sand to root in and subdued illumination. Floating plants car fulfill the latter condition. Water should be soft, slightly acid, and filtered over peat. Moderate filtration, B: Has

not

been

successfully

accom-

plished. F: Cy O; small foods of animal origin: mosquito larvae, Daphnia, and Artemia (even frozen). Flake foods. S: This is one of the smallest Synodontis. 1322°-25°C, Er Gicim Ay a0 cmp Ranma

402

Dse=3

Catfishes

Synodontis marmoratus

Soe

~

Upside-Down Catfishes

Fam.: Mochokidae Subfam.: Mochokinae

BOULENGER,

Synodontis nigromaculatus Leopard synodontis Syn.: Synodontis colyeri, S. melanostictus. Often confused with S. zambesenSIs. Hab.: Africa: found in many southern tributaries of the Zaire River, Lake Tanganyika and its tributaries, the Okavango and Limpopo Rivers, and all of the upper Zambezi Basin. F.1.: Unknown;

surely it has been

fre-

1905

plants should be well-rooted before S. nigromaculatus is introduced into the tank. Clear, oxygen-rich, well-filtered water is a necessity. Water: OH 6.0-7.5; hardness up to 20° dGH.

B: Unknown. Is it possible it has been bred in captivity, but under a different name? Hiding places large enough for two animal should be offered.

incorrect

F: C, O; any food suitable to its size. Chiefly live foods should be fed when trying to ripen the animals.

Soc. B.: Predominately peaceful, twilightactive fish. As for many Synodontis, this fish is slightly territorial, so be sure to include hiding places in the decor. Do not associate with small fishes.

S: Its broad distribution undoubtedly allows for variations in design. In comparison to the pictured animal which is a juvenile, adults have a slightly less pronounced design (smaller dots) and a longer dorsal fin spine (slightly larger than the body height).

quently imported nomenclature.

but

under

Sex.: Unknown.

M: The aquarium should not be cramped. Vegetation can be included, but the T: 22°-26°C, L: 40 cm, A: 120 cm, R: b, D: 2

Synodontis obesus Obese synodontis

BOULENGER,

Syn.: Synodontis hollyi, S. loppei. Hab.: Africa: western Africa, coastal waters of the Gulf of Guinea.

ertheless, it can be maintained on flake and tablet foods awhile.

F.1.: Unknown.

Sex.: Unknown.

Soc. B.: Like many Synodontis, what territorial. Twilight-active.

some-

M: Twilight- and night-active fish. They have been known to eat very small fishes on occasion, Sometimes quarrelsome towards other territorial fishes, predominately congeners. Numerous hiding places will curb aggressions. Fast-rooting plants can be used. Water: pH 6.07.5; hardness of 25° dGH or less. This species can; probably tolerate low sa-

linities. B: Not known.

F: C, O; though an omnivore, a certain proportion of live foods is required; nevT: 24°-28°C, L: 40: cm, A: 120'em, R: b, D? 2

404

1898

S: The contrasting coloration slightly as the fish ages.

fades

Catfishes

ah

Synodontis obesus

~

Upside-Down Catfishes

Fam.: Mochokidae Subfam.: Mochokinae

MATTHES, 1959

Synodontis petricola Even-spotted synodontis Syn.: Synodontis multimaculatus. Hab.: Africa: endemic to the northern sector of Lake Tanganyika. This photo was taken at Kigoma. Fle Car t97s:

Sex.: Unknown.

F: C, O; an omnivore foods.

that prefers live

S: S. petricola is similar to S. multipunctatus and S. polli (Syn.: S. eurystomus). S. petricola is presented again in this volume because of this rare photo taken in its natural biotope.

Soc. B.: Although this species is expressly peaceful, only associate with larger species. Very small fishes may be considered prey. An appropriate addition to a Lake Tanganyika cichlid aquaria.

M: See Vol. 2, p. 546. B: Like cuckoos, these fish introduce their eggs into the clutch of other species (mouthbrooding cichlids) which unwittingly assume responsibility for them. 1222=25°C,

Li 11cm, Az 00cm,

Raby im D22

Synodontis polli Poll’s upside-down catfish Syn.: Synodontis eurystoma, S. eurystomus.

Hab.: Africa: endemic to Lake Tangan-

GOSSE, 1982 was a homonym and, as dictated by nomenclature rules, required a “nomen novum” (new name).

yika,

F.1.: Unknown; it probably has not been imported into Germany. Imported into England ca. 1986.

Sex.: Unknown. Soc. B.: Peaceful, but likes its solitude. M: See Synodontis multiounctatus.

B: Unknown; probably like cuckoos, introducing their eggs into the clutch of other species which unwittingly brood them. En@?

S: Previously known as S. eurystomus. The new name, S. polli, was assigned when it was discovered that S. eurystomus was used in a description by MATTHES, 1959. Hence, S. eurystomus T: 22°-26°C, |: 15 cm, A: 120/'em, R:'b, m, D:3

406

Catfishes

Synodontis petricola

Synodontis

polli

in its natural biotope at Kigoma

Fam.: Mochokidae

Upside-Down Catfishes

Subfam.: Mochokinae

*

Synodontis multipunctatus

408

eae

in its natural biotope at Kigoma

Catfishes

Synodontis soloni Scissortail synodontis Syn.: None.

BOULENGER,

1899

Hab.: Africa: the Zaire Basin, in Stanley Pool and rapids of Libenge. F.I.: To Great Britain in 1975.

Sex.: Unknown.

Soc. B.: Solitary abiding animals; do not house with small fishes.

M: Clear, slightly acid water. B: Unknown. F: C, O; small live foods such as Daphnia and Tubifex are readily accepted.

S: None. T: 28°-25°C, L: 16 cm, A: 120 cm, R:b, D: 3

409

.

Upside-Down Catfishes

Fam.: Mochokidae Subfam.: Mochokinae

Synodontis rebeli Cameroon synodontis

HOLLY, 1926

Syn.: Synodontis hollyi, S. “velifer”. in the Sanaga

F: C, O; insect larvae, earthworms, and large frozen foods. Large flakes and tablets are readily accepted.

Sex.: There are no external distinguishing characteristics. At spawning time,

S: S. rebeli is easily confused with Synodontis velifer. However, the latter has larger spots on the body and, as adults, a dorsal fin that is mare than 2x the height of S. rebeli’s dorsal fin.

Hab.: Africa: Cameroon, River. F.1.: Unknown.

the 3’s genital are stouter.

papilla

protrudes.

2 Q

Soc. B.: Though generally peaceful, small fishes may be eaten. Associate with fishes at least '/. its length. M: Needs a large, well-filtered tank, a large cave, a dark substrate, and peatfiltered water. Water: pH 6.2-7.5; hardness up to 20° dGH. At least one corner

should have a sand the fish to root.

substrate to allow

B: Not known. Tj222°=25°C, | 27 em, A: 150\cm; Rab, m, D: 2-3

Synodontis waterloti Waterlot’s synodontis Syn.: None. Hab.: Africa: Ghana, lvory Coast, Liberia, Sierra Leone.

DAGET, 1962 S: The heavily serrated pectoral fin rays are a good distinguishing characteristic for this species.

F.1.: Not known. Sex.: Have not been described.

Soc. B.: Overall, this is a peaceful species. But once it has attained a respectable size, small fishes might “accidentally” be consumed.

M: A contrasting design appears on animals housed in tanks having light-colored substrates. Though dark substrates are more appropriate, the animals turn a dull black-brown, making them less appealing to aquarists. Strong filtration is necessary. Create caves within rock and root edifications. Water: pH 6.8-7.8; hardness up to 20° dGH. B: Not known.

F: C, O; flake foods, frozen mosquito larvae, large live foods, and earthworms. T: 22°-25°C, L: 18 cm, A: 150 cm, R: b, D: 2-3

410

Catfishes

Synodontis

rebeli

Fes,

Sere

ee

Synodontis. waterloti

411

Fam.: Pangasiidae

Pangasius pangasius Black-finned shark Syn.: Pimelodus pangasius. Hab.: Asia: from Pakistan through India, Bangladesh, Burma, Thailand, Malaysia, and Vietnam to Indonesia. F.1.: Unknown. Sex.: Unknown.

Soc. B.: Despite its size, this is a relatively peaceful catfish, yet it often panics in cramped quarters. Diurnal. M: Good filtration and aeration and a very large aquarium are requisites for successful care. Plants should be waived. Hiding places are not necessary. Water: pH 6-7.5; hardness up to 25° dGH. B: Not known.

F: O; everything from small fishes to plants, fruits, and worms. Predator! S: A commonly eaten food fish in its native land. Only juveniles are imported. T: 23°-28°C, L: 130 (70) cm, A: 300 cm, R: m, D: 4 (S!)

412

Shark Catfishes

(HAMILTON,

1822)

Catfishes Fam.: Pimelodidae

Antenna Catfishes

Subfam.: Pimelodinae

SANDS & BLACK, 1985

Brachyrhamdia marthae Blue imitator catfish Syn.: None; however, it has not been definitely decided if Brachyrhamdia is a genus or subgenus. If the latter is the case, then this fish’s name would be Pimelodella marthae. Hab.: South America: Peru. The exact habitat is unknown. The species description is based on imported specimens. F.I.: Unknown; surely it has been peatedly imported.

re-

Sex.: Not known.

Soc. B.: Territorial towards congeners and other related species. Usually peaceful towards heterogeners. Only very small fishes are eaten. Their territorial behavior can be countered by keeping at least 6 specimens (aggressions are then diluted) and providing numerous hiding places using roots as territorial boundaries. M: House in moderate-sized aquaria. |Include plenty of vegetation and hiding

places in the decor. Water: pH 6-7, hardness up to 15° dGH. B: Not known.

F: C, O; voracious omnivores. Live or frozen foods are occasionally required.

S: SANDS discovered that B. marthae is mainly imported with shipments of Corydoras pygmaeus. Juvenile B. marthae and C. pygmaeus are very similar exteriorly. But the exaggerated size difference between these two species precludes it from the degree of success Brachyrhamdia imitator has achieved in its “mimicry” (see Vol. 2, p. 552). B. marthae mainly differs from B. meesi, a similar species, by its lack of a “mask,” the clear blue sheen on its body, and the dorsal spot, which is limited to the upper anterior part of the dorsal fin in B. meesi.

T: 24°-26°C, L: 9 cm, A: 80 cm, R: b, D: 2

413

Fam.: Pimelodidae

Antenna Catfishes

Brachyrhamdia meesi Mees’ pimelodid Syn.: None; however it has not yet been

SANDS & BLACK, 1985 Subfam.: Pimelodinae Sex.: Not known.

determined if Brachyrhamdia is a genus or subgenus. If the latter is the case, then this fish’s name would be Pimelodella meesi.

Soc. B.: Like B. marthae (previous page).

Hab.: According to information given by the original describer, this catfish was first noticed in a shipment of aquarium fishes that came from Belem at the mouth of the Amazon. However, as has been repeatedly determined, such a habitat description is dubious, since Belem is an export station. Fishes supposedly caught at Belem are often collected in more remote locals and shipped there. Little information can be extracted from the fact that this species has been imported together with Pimelodella lateri-

F: C, O; large live foods are particular favorites, but tablets and leftover flake foods are also accepted.

striga because exporters are apt to combine their catches, especially simi-

lar looking fishes. F.I.: 1985 by GLASER, Frankfurt. Probably imported earlier, just not properly identified.

M: As for B. marthae. B: Not known.

S: See

B. marthae

for species

differ-

ences. The probability that this species mimics Pimelodella lateristriga is small despite SANDS’ suspicions. Unlike B. imitator (see Vol. 2, p. 552), there does not seem to be an advantage to mimicry in this case. As mentioned above, simultaneous imports can be coincidental. Behavioral studies have apparently not been made in its natural habitat. This is a prime example of the problems encountered in making first descriptions from aquarium imports and why they should be limited to exceptional cases (when the habitat can be indisputably determined).

T: 24°-26°C, L: 8 cm, A: 60 cm, R: b, D: 2

Duopalatinus malarmo Malarmo catfish Syn.: Platysilurus malarmo. Hab.: South America: Venezuela, Rio Negro and the area around caibo.

in the Mara-

(SCHULTZ, 1944) Subfam.: Sorubiminae contributing to this catfish’s well-being. Water: pH 6-7; hardness up to 20° dGH. B: Unknown.

F: C; mainly live fishes, but large live

F.1.: 1988.

foods

Sex.: Unknown.

larvae,

Soc. B.: Peaceful towards equal-sized conspecifics and heterospecifics. Significantly smaller fishes (less than 1/3 of its body length), however, are considered food. Primarily twilight- and nightactive, M: Only large tanks with several spacious hiding places (e.g., bogwood) are appropriate. The substrate in its captive environment should be of sand, reflecting that found in its natural biotope. Even delicate plants are left unharmed. Longleaved plants provide hiding places,

such and

meal

worms

are

wax also

moth ac-

cepted. S: D. malarmo has a very distinctive pair of maxillary barbels. They are up to 2x the length of the body and generally held posteriorly. Surely their extreme length is an adaptation to its biotope and lifestyle—lurking in profound holes for prey.

T: 24°-28°C, L: 65 (40) cm, A: 150 cm, R: m, b, D: 2-3

414

as earthworms,

Catfishes

Brachyrhamdia

meesi

&

D uopalatinus malarmo

Antenna Catfishes

Fam.: Pimelodidae Subfam.: Pimelodinae

(BOULENGER,

Imparfinis longicauda Long-tail antenna catfish Syn.: Pimelodus longicauda, Rhamdia longicauda, Nannorhamdia longicauda, Imparfinis longicaudus. Hab.: South America: Ecuador and Peru, in the upper Amazon and its tributaries. F.1.: Unknown. Sex.: Unknown. Soc. B.: This is a relatively peaceful twilight- and night-active catfish. M: Hiding places must be included in the decor. The water should be wellfiltered, slightly acid (OH 6-7), and moaerately hard (to 10° dGH).

1887)

S: BORODIN described another member of this genus as /. longicauda in 1927. Since the same name cannot be used twice within the same genus, the more recent name is a homonym and must be replaced with a new name (nomen novum). G. F. MEES, a Dutch scientist, is presently engaged in this task. MEES' report confirms the preliminary classification by SAUL 1975, which placed this species into the genus /mparfinis.

B: Unknown.

F: C, O; all kinds of small live foods. Flakes and tablets are occasionally accepted. T: 20°-24°C, L: 15 cm, A: 80 cm, R: b, D: 2

(LUTKEN, 1874)

Imparfinis minutus Syn.: Cetopsorhamdia hasemani, C. pijpersi, Imparfinis hasemani, Rhamdella minuta, Rhamdia minuta. Hab.: South America: western Brazil and the Guianas. F.1.: Unknown. Sex.: Unknown.

Soc. B.: Peaceful towards conspecifics as long as they are not overly small.

Territorial in front of congeners.

How-

ever, if a small school is maintained, aggressions are not as pronounced. Primarily twilight- and night-active. M: Moderate-sized aquarium containing plants, bogwood and rock edifications, and hiding places, which are primarily used during the day. Because it lives in rapids in its natural habitat, good filtration and aeration are mandatory. Water: pH 6.0-7.0 (slightly acid); hardness of 15° dGH or less. T: 24°-28°C,

416

L: 12 cm, A: 80 cm, R: b, D: 2

B: Not known,

F: C, O; live and flake foods commiserate to its size. This voracious fish can be acclimated to substitute foods rela-

tively easily.

Catfishes

Imparfinis longicauda “a

Imparfinis

minutus

Fam.: Pimelodidae

Antenna Catfishes

Subfam.: Pimelodinae

(STEINDACHNER, 1880)

Microglanis parahybae Syn.: Pseudopimelodus parahybae, P. charus, P. cottoides, Batrachoglanis parahybae, Microglanis cottoides.

F: C, O; tablet, flake, and frozen foods as well as mosquito larvae and Gammarus.

Hab.:

S: None.

South

America:

southeast

Brazil,

Argentina, Paraguay, and probably Uruguay. F.1.: 1926. Sex.: Have not been described.

Soc. B.: Nocturnal and predatory. not house with small characins.

Do

M: A sandy substrate is best because of M. parahybae’s penchant to bury itself. Undemanding. Water: pH 6.2-7.8 (7.0); hardness up to 25° (12°) dGH. Provide hiding places among bogwood.

B: Has not been bred in captivity. T: 21°-26°C,

L: 9.cm, A: 70 cm, R: b, D:

Pimelodella rambarrani Masked imitator catfish Syn.: Brachyrhamdia rambarrani (this name has to be considered a synonym until it has been established whether Brachyrhamdia is a subgenus of Pimelodella or a genus). Hab.:

South America:

Brazil, in the Rio

Unini, a tributary of the Rio Negro. F.l.: To England in 1987. Into Germany

in 1988 by HIERONIMUS. Sex.: area,

2

are fuller through the ventral

Soc. B.: Peaceful towards heterofamilials. Territorial towards conspecifics and other catfishes of similar stature and design. If the tank lacks hiding places, fatal confrontations may ensue. M: Planted medium-sized aquarium with good filtration and aeration. Perform regular water exchanges and provide sufficient secluded areas among roots. Water: pH 5.5-7.0; hardness up to 15° dGH. T: 24°-26°C, L:

418

7cm, A: 80 cm, R: b, D: 2

AXELROD

& BURGESS,

1987

B: Unknown; it is surely difficult to acquire sufficient animals to attempt breeding since, to date, only single specimens have been found mixed among imported Corydoras davidsandsi (see S). Lack of specimens aside, endeavors to breed these animals are probably most likely to succeed if the attempt is made to breed them in the presence of C. davidsandsi, as British aquarists have shown

with Brachyrhamdia imitator and Corydoras melanistius melanistius. F: C, O; leftovers, TetraTips, FD foods, and frozen mosquito larvae.

S: Not only does this species live within groups of Corydoras davidsandsi BLACK, 1987, albeit in small numbers, it has an almost identical design.

Catfishes

Microglanis

parahybae

Pimelodella

rambarrani

Antenna Catfishes

Fam.: Pimelodidae Subfam.: Pimelodinae

(SPIX, 1829)

Pinirampus pirinampu

Long-finned catfish Syn.: Pimelodus pirinampu, typus, Pinirampus typus.

Pirinampus

Hab.: South America: from Paraguay through the Tocantins region to Venezuela. F.1.: Unknown. Sex.: Unknown.

Soc. B.: This night- and twilight-active predator is territorial towards conspecifics and similar fishes. It should only be associated with very large tankmates.

F: C; live foods. Young animals accept insect larvae, while older specimens need coarser foods such as earthworms. Tablets are occasionally consumed.

S: The long-finned catfish has only been included in this text to warn prospective buyers, since it grows too large and is not attractive enough to be of interest to normal aquarists.

M: Only large aquaria with stable rock or root edifications are appropriate. Limit vegetation to very robust specimens. The filter must be capable of handling the high nitrogenous load these animals produce. Water: pH 6-8; hardness up to

25° dGH. B: Unknown.

T: 22°-28°C, L: 120 (50) cm, A: 200 cm, R: b, D: 4 (S!) Rhamdia laticauda laticauda

(HECKEL, 1858)

Syn.: Pimelodus brachypterus, P. hypselurus, P. laticaudus, P. motaguensis.

Hab.: South and Central America. F.I.: 1984 by K. and M. K. MEYER. Sex.: Not one species of the genus Rhamdia has secondary sexual characteristics. Soc. B.: Relatively shy, enduring thic” fish. Peaceful.

“ben-

M: Needs hiding places, a dark substrate, floating plants to diminish light penetration, and an open area for swimming. The water in its natural habitat has a pH of 7.5 and a hardness of 14° dGH.

B: Unknown F: O; live foods, FD Menu, and flake and tablet foods.

S: Rhamdia laticauda typhla GREENFIELD, GREENS & WOODS, 1982 has also been described. T: 24°-28°C, L: 12 cm, A: 100 cm, R: b, D: 4

420

Catfishes

Pinirampus

pirinampu

¥

Rhamdia

laticauda

laticauda

~

Glass Catfishes

Fam.: Schilbeidae Subfam.: Schilbeinae

Schilbe marmoratus African shoulder-spot catfish

BOULENGER,

Syn.: None. Hab.:

Africa: Zaire, in large bodies

of

water.

F: C, O; all foods that can be swallowed, including small fishes. Flake foods will be eaten for extended periods of time. S: Rare, coincidentally imported species.

F.1.: Unknown.

Sex.: Mature 3d.

¢2

are much

fuller than

Soc. B.: This active diurnal fish is peaceful towards all fishes except those that are significantly smaller. M: Large aquarium with sufficient free swimming space and vegetation around the edges. Hiding places are not needed, but shelter among roots or rocks is occasionally sought. Water must be wellfiltered, aerated, and regularly exchanged. Water: pH 6.0-7.5; hardness up to 20° dGH. B: Not known.

T: 24°-26°C, L: 15 cm, perhaps longer, A: 100 cm, R: m, D: 2-3

422

1911

Catfishes Fam.: Siluridae

Sheath Catfishes

Subfam.: Silurinae

Silurus glanis Wels Syn.: Hab.: Lake gland

None. Europe: from the upper Rhine to Aral in Russia. Not found in Enor Italy.

F.I.: Native to Europe.

Sex.: 22 are fuller through the ventral area during the spawning season. Soc, B.: Juveniles live in schools. Its gregariousness changes into a predacious solitary nature as it ages. Only suitable for large show aquaria. Limit tankmates to fishes larger than itself. M: Species tank with hiding places (large caves), subdued illumination, and a few potted robust plants is best. Nocturnal. At twilight, this fish becomes restless

LINNAEUS,

1758

B: Spawns from May to June, but apparently only in large rivers and lakes. Sexual maturity is reached two to three years of age; at that time the fish weighs 1-2 kg. The d guards the nest (depression) and the spawn. F: C; all types of animal based foods. Tablets and trout/carp pellets are accepted by juveniles. Fishes, particularly cyprinids, are also readily consumed. Animals kept in ponds do not feed during the winter. S: This long-lived species (up to 80 years) happens to be the largest European fish. Considered to be good tasting, 10,000 tons are captured and consumed each year in Russia!

and begins its quest for food. A light dimmer allows better observation. Other than a large filter, there are no special water quality demands. T: 4°-20°C (coldwater fish), L: said to reach 2.5 m, usually up to 1 m,. A: 200 cm, R: b, D: 4 (S)

423

Fam.: Sisoridae

Asian Hillstream Catfishes

Conta conta

(HAMILTON,

Syn.: Pimelodus conta, Hara filamentosa, Hara conta.

Hab.: Asia: India, north Bengal and Assam; Bangladesh. F.1.: Unknown.

Sex.: The photos on the facing page clearly show the d's elongated caudal fin ray and the difference in coloration between 3d and 29—the ¢ is dark brown with light brown mottling, while the ¢ is a solid clay color. Soc. B.: This is a peaceful, schooling fish.

nocturnal

M: Can be maintained in small, heavily vegetated aquaria. Include hiding places. Water: pH 6.0-7.5; hardness up to 20° dGH. B: Unknown.

F: O; small live foods and flake foods. T: 18°-28°C,

‘Ne

L: 12 cm, A: 60 cm, R: b, D: 2

s

¥

ba

4

Silurus glanis, yellow morph bred in Poland

424

1822)

Catfishes

Conta conta

3

Conta conta

@

Asian Hillstream Catfishes

Fam.: Sisoridae

(HAMILTON, 1822)

Gagata cenia

F: C; all types of live and frozen foods. In nature, these fish primarily feed on insects floating on the water surface.

Syn.: Pimelodus cenia. Hab.:

Asia:

Pakistan,

northern

India,

Bangladesh, Burma, and Nepal. The pictured animal was captured in Assam. F.1.: Ca. 1985. Sex.: Unknown.

Soc. B.: Peaceful, lively, diurnal catfish. Keep at least 6 specimens. M: G. cenia requires good filtration and aeration, a smooth-edged substrate, and plenty of swimming space. Plants are

left undisturbed, but mulm may be whirled up as it searches for food. Hiding places are only occasionally sought. Water: pH 6.0-7.2; hardness up to 15° dGH.

S: According to SANDS, some specimens may reach a length of 30 cm (ca. 12 in.). However, a maximum length of 12 cm seems more realistic, since HAMILTON reports a maximum length of ca. 8 cm (3 in.). Perhaps we are dealing with a communication problem. The latter measurement will probably not be surpassed in the aquarium. Unlike this species, all of G. gagata's fins with the exception of the caudal fin have black tips.

B: Not known.

T: 20°-24°C, L: 8 (12 cm), A: 80 cm, R: b, m, D: 2-3

Glyptosternum reticulatum Syn.: Glyptosternum

McCLELLAND,

stoliczkae.

Hab.: Asia: northwestern Indian states, Afghanistan, Pakistan, China, and the southern republics of the former Soviet Union. F.1.: Unknown. Sex.: Unknown.

Soc.

B.: Peaceful

towards

heterospe-

cifics. Slight territorial behavior may be displayed towards conspecifics. M: Needs a large, unheated aquarium with strong filtration and illumination. The aquarium should have plants especially chosen to tolerate the low temperatures that will reign in the tank. Water: pH around 7; hardness up to 20° dGH. B: Unknown.

F: O; flake foods and probably be accepted.

FD tablets will

S: In contrast to its relatives in the genus Glyptothorax, Glyptosternum speT: 12°-24°C, L: 15 cm, A: 100 cm, R: b, D: 3

426

1842

cies do not have a suckermouth. Species identification using this photo is not unequivocal, since the anal fin cannot be clearly seen. JAYARAM indicates that G. reticulatum has a membrane connecting the anal and caudal fins.

Catfishes

Gagata

cenia from Assam

2

Glyptosternum

&

Fd

reticulatum

427

Fam.: Sisoridae

Asian Hillstream Catfishes

(VALENCIENNES, 1840)

Glyptothorax platypogon Brown hillstream catfish Syn.: Pimelodus platypogon, P. cyanochlorus, Glyptosternum platypogon, G. kukenthali. Hab.: Asia: Java, Sumatra, laysia.

F: O; small live foods, algae, and flake foods.

Borneo, Ma-

F.1.: Unknown. Sex.: Unknown.

Soc. B.: This peaceful catfish neither disturbs plants nor other fishes. M: Because G. platypogon inhabits mountain creeks in its natural habitat, a good filtration system complete with aeration must be provided and high temperatures will have to be avoided. A moderate-sized aquarium is sufficient. Water: pH 6.0-7.0; hardness up to 15° dGH. B: Unknown. T: 18°-22°C,

L: 10 cm, A: 80 cm, R: m, b, D: 2-3

Glyptothorax trilineatus Three-striped hillstream catfish Syn.: Gilyptothorax laosensis.

Hab.: Asia: Thailand, Burma, northern India, eastern Himalayas, Pakistan, Bangladesh.

BLYTH,

S: These catfish are rarely imported because their delicacy in front of elevated temperatures makes them difficult to transport.

F.1.: Unknown. Sex.: Unknown.

Soc. B.: Though little is known, it is probably a peaceful, diurnal catfish. Cover is occasionally sought. M: House in large, well-filtered, oxygenrich aquaria. Specimens imported to date have proven to be very sensitive to high temperatures, so keep the water cool. Little free swimming space is needed. Water: pH 6.0-7.2: hardness up*to 10° dGH.

B: Not known. F: O; unfortunately, more exact information is not available. Probably an omnivore that also feeds on aufwuchs. Try good flake foods.

T: 10°-20°C, L: 30 cm, usually smaller, A: 100 cm, R: b, D: 4 (1)

428

1860

Catfishes

Gly tothorax trilineatus

429

Fam.: Sisctidae

Asian Hillstream Catfishes

Hara hara

(HAMILTON,

Syn.: Pimelodus hara. Hab.: Asia: in the northern and northeastern Indian states. Also found in

Nepal and Bangladesh. F.1.: Unknown. Sex.: Unknown.

Soc. B.: Peaceful, nocturnal schooling fish. Hiding places are sought during the day. Its behavior is similar to that of South American armored catfishes. M: H. hara's captive environment

must

be well-filtered and aerated, heavily planted, and riddled with hiding places. Water; pH 6.0-7.5; hardness up to 20° dGH. Its temperature requirement varies according to origin. B: Unknown.

F: O; primarily small live foods, but flake foods can occasionally be offered. T: 12°-28°C (depending on origin), L: 7 cm, A: 60 cm, R: b, D: 2-3

430

1822)

Fam.: Trichomycteridae Subfam.: Pygidiinae

Bullockia maldonadoi Chiienian parasitic catfish Syn.: Hatcheria maldonadoi. Hab.: South America: in the Pacific Andean rivers of central Chile.

F.1.: Unknown. Sex.: Unknown.

Soc. B.: Peaceful inhabitant of the lower water strata. When danger threatens, it may bury itself in the substrate.

Catfishes Parasitic Catfishes

(EIGENMANN, 1927) F: O; detritus (mulm) is readily searched. Best to alternate small live foods and flake foods. S: In the course of her ecological study, Gloria ARRATIA discovered that both juveniles and adults prefer shallow standing water zones of large rivers and bodies of water.

M: Small, temperate, well-planted tanks with a fine-grained substrate and a few hiding places make appropriate habitats for these animals. Do not house with significantly larger fishes. Good filtration is recommended, but current is not appreciated. B. maldonadoi can be maintained in unheated aquaria. Water: pH 6-7; hardness up to 15° dGH. B: Unknown.

T: 16°-26°C, L: 5 cm, A: 60 cm, R:b, D: 2-3

431

Fam.: Trichomycteridae

Parasitic Catfishes

Subfam.: Pygidiinae

*

Pygidium

cf. stellatum

Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: rios.

Brazil, Puerto Bar-

F.I.: Not exactly known. Sex.: Unknown. Soc. B.: Peaceful, small catfish that generally remains hidden in the sandy substrate during the day, they are therefore frequently

overlooked.

M: Even the smallest aquaria are appropriate. Substrate should be of fine sand. Plants are left unharmed. Limit P. cf. stellatum'’s tankmates to other small, peaceful fishes. Water: pH 6.0-7.5; hardness below 20° dGH. B: Unknown.

F: C, O; the tiniest live and flake foods.

S: This species is very difficult to identify without exact information on its origin, since over 30, often very similar look-

ing species have been described. T: 22°-24°C, L: 4cm, A: 40 cm, R: b, D: 2-3

432

EIGENMANN,

1918

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

Aphyosemion

[Diapteron] georgiae,

see page 496

Order: Cyprinodontiformes Order: Cyprinodontiformes

BERG,

1940

The scheme is based on PARENT! (1981) and NELSON (1984) as well as our own classifications. The number of species in each taxon is indicated in parenthesis. FamiLy:

Subfamily: Genera: ADRIANICHTHYIDAE

Adrianichthys Xenopoecilus HORAICHTHYIDAE Horaichthys

Weser, 1913 (3 )

Weser, 1913 (1 )

(2 ) 1 KULKARNI, 1940 ( ) KULKARNI, 1940 (1 ) Recan, 1911

OryziipAe (=Oryziatinae Rosen, 1964)(11 ) 1 Oryzias JorDAN & Snyper, 1906 ( 1 ) APLOCHEILICHTHYIDAE (6 6 ) Aplocheilichthyinae Myers, 1928 (65 6 ) Aplocheilichthys BLeeker, 1863 (43 ) Congopanchax Pott, 1971 (2) Hylopanchax Pott & LamBert, 1965(1) Hypsopanchax Myers, 1924 (6) Laciris Huser, 1981 (1) Lamprichthys Recan, 1911 (1) Pantanodon. Myers, 1955 (2) Plataplochilus Ax, 1928 (6) Procatopus BOULENGER, 1904 (3) Fluviphylacinae Roserts, 1970 (1) Fluviphylax WHITLEY, 1965 (1) POECILIIDAE see page 582

Garman, 1895 (164)

CyPRINODONTIDAE

Git, 1865 (100+ 5 to 43 Orestias) Aphaniinae SCHEEL, 1968 (12 ) Aphanius Narbo, 1827 (12 ) Cyprinodontinae Git, 1865 (35 Cualac Miter, 1956 (1 Cyprinodon Lacépepe, 1803 (29 ) Floridichthys Husss, 1926 (2) Garmanella Huss, 1936 (1 ) Jordanella Goopve & BEAN, 1879 (1 Megupsilon Miter & Watters, 1972(1

Fundulinae JorDaN & GitBerT, 1882(42) Adinia Chriopeoides

Cubanichthys Fundulus

Leptolucania Lucania Valenciinae

Valencia Profundulinae, Profundulus

434

)

Girard, 1859 (1 ) Fowter, 1939 (1 )

Huss, 1926 (1 ) Lacépéde, 1803 (35 )

Myers, 1924 (4 ) Girard, 1859 (3)

(2 )

Myers, 1928 (2) (5 )

Huses, 1924 (5)

Orestiinae Git, 1893 (5 to 43) Orestias VALENCIENNES, 1839 (5-43) Empetrichthyinae JorDaN, EVERMANN & Ciark, 1930 (4) Crenichthys Huses, 1932 (2) Empetrichthys Gi-Bert, 1893 (2) GOODEIDAE see page 582

JoRDAN, 1923 (35)

APLOCHEILIDAE Bueeker, 1860, (308) Aplocheilinae (182 Adamas Huser, 1979 (1 Aphyoplatys Ciausen, 1976 (1) Aphyosemion Myers, 1924 (102) Aplocheilus — McC etanp, 1839 (4) Diapteron Huser & Seecers, 1977 (5) Epiplatys Git, 1862 (32) Foerschichthys ScHELL & ROMAND,

1981 (1) Fundulosoma AHL, 1924 (1) Nothobranchius Peters, 1868 (31 Pachypanchax Myers, 1933 ee Paranothobranchius Seecers,1985(1 )

Pronothobranchius Raova, 1969 (1 ) Rivulinae HOEDEMANN, 1962 (new usage) (126) Austrofundulus Myers, 1932 (2)

Campellolebias Vaz-FERREIRA & SierRA, 1974 (3) (= Cynopoecilus?) Cynolebias STeINDACHNER, 1876 (28) Cynopoecilus REGAN, 1912 (9) Neofundulus Myers, 1924 (4) Pterolebias Garman, 1895 (8) Rachovia Myers, 1927 (5) Rivulus Poey, 1860 (62) Terranatos TAPHORN & THOMERSON, 1978 (1) (= Cynolebias? ) Trigonectes Myers, 1925 (4) ANABLEPIDAE Anablepinae Anableps (Gronow) Jenynsiinae Jenynsia Oxyzygonectinae Oxyzygonectes

Garman, Garman, Scorou, GUNTHER, GUNTHER, Parenti, Fowter,

1895 (5) 1895 (3) 1777(3) 1866 (1) 1866 (1) 1981 (1) 1916 (1)

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps Fam.: Anablepidae Subfam.: Oxyzygonectinae

Oxyzygonectes

dovil

Oxyzygonectes

dovii

°

(GUNTHER, 1866)

Oxyzygonectes dovii Syn.: Haplochilus doviil, Zygonectes dovii, Fundulus dovii, Aplocheilus dovii, Oxyzygonectes dowi. Hab.:

Central America:

Pacific Coast of

M: According to FROMM (J. AKA, 15 (5); 201-210, 1982) and ZURLO (DATZ, 38 (12): 547— 550, 1985), caring for this species is unproblematic as long as it is

ther north as well. From the sea to freshwater, but preferably brackish water la-

kept in a very large tank and salt is added to the water. Cover the tank well, since the animals jump.

goons.

B: Refer to the above mentioned articles

Panama

and

Costa

Rica,

possibly fur-

F.i.: 1979 by D. FROMM from Golfito, Costa Rica, to the United States. Exported from the United States by G. ZURLO to Germany.

in 1983

Sex.: See photos. 3 d are yellow-brown, turning lighter ventrally, and have more elongated yellowish fins. °° are fuller through the ventral area and have small, rounded, transparent fins. Soc. B.: Peaceful and somewhat shy. Can be housed with equal-sized fishes that tolerate salt in the water. In nature, these fish swim in large schools; this behavior is not exhibited in captivity. T: 22°-28°C,

by FROMM

and ZURLO.

FROMM

is the

most explicit. He bred the fish at 24°29.5°C. Typical for killifishes, O. dovii spawned on an artificial fiber mop. A ? with a total length of 17 cm released 41 eggs in one day. The young were easily reared on Artemia nauplii. F: C; live foods and all kinds of commercial diets.

S: The systematics

of this species

is

controversial. While numerous authors place this monotypic genus into the subfamily Fundulinae, PARENTI considers it

more cies.

closely related to Anableps

spe-

L: 15-35 cm, A: 200 cm, R: t, m, D: 2-3

435

.

Fam.: Poeciliidae Subfam.: Aplocheilichthyinae

RADDA, 1971

Aplocheilichthys camerunensis Cameroon lampeye Syn.: None.

soft, slightly acid water is best. Despite

Hab.: West Africa: southern Cameroon and northern Gabon, in creeks and rivers of the rain forests of the inland pla-

its small size, the aquarium must be comparatively large with many plants, including floating species. Do not illuminate the tank excessively.

teau.

F.I.: 1971 ers.

by RADDA

and fellow travel-

Sex.: The 3's fins, most notably the dorsal fin, are yellowish, whereas its flanks are metallic blue. 22 have a transparent and rounded, not elongated, dorsal and anal fins and an anteriorly fuller body.

Soc. B.: Peaceful but shy schooling fish. M: Not an easy fish to care for, since it demands exceptional water quality. Very

B: Difficult. Though

the animals

spawn

on plants such as Java moss or filters or similar items, they prefer a wool mop. The breeding tank has to be set up so that the eggs can be removed one by

one. The fry hatch after 10-14 days and must be fed infusoria at first. Add Artemia to the diet later. Frequent cautious water exchanges (drip method) are important to maintain the excellent water quality demanded by this species. F: C; small live foods.

T: 20°-24°C, L: 3 cm, A: 60 cm, R:t, m,

Aplocheilichthys kongoranensis Syn.: Haplochilichthys kongoranensis, Haplochilus atripinnis (not PFEFFER, 1896), Aplocheilichthys johnstoni (not

GUNTHER,

1898).

Hab.: Africa: coastal plains of east Tan-

zania, including the Rufiji and Ruvu Basins. F.1.: January 1981 by EGGERS, KASSELMANN, and SEEGERS from Kibiti, Tanzania. Sex.: Not always easy to distinguish. ¢ 3 are generally more intensely colored and bigger with slightly elongated fins. The coloration and morphology of 6 6 of different populations may vary. The 2° have transparent fins and a more slender caudal peduncle. Soc. B.: Like most Aplocheilichthys species, A. komgoranensis lives in groups, though there does not seem to be an intense cohesion between the animals as is found in some schooling fishes. Every fish within the school maintains its individual space. The animals tend to be shy and peaceful in aquaria.

(AHL, 1924) M: Place in well-planted aquaria that have peaceful inhabitants, possibly small barbs or characins would make suitable tankmates. The water should be soft and neutral to slightly acid. Cover the aquarium, since the animals are accomplished jumpers. B: For unknown reasons, this species is problematic to breed. Perhaps it is because upon hatching the fry are extremely tiny, demanding correspondingly small foodstuffs. In general, this species is an adhesive spawner which lays its eggs among plants. A species tank with plenty of Java moss is best for breeding. Remove the juveniles, or place a pair or 1 to 2 366 and several 22 ina tank by themselves and pick the eggs from the spawning substrate. Put the eggs in*a rearing container until they develop. After about 14-20 days, the

young

Feed them small Artemia

F: C; all kinds of small live foods. Flakes can be fed occasionally.

T: 22°-26°C, L: 4. cm, A: 60 cm, R: t, m, D: 3-4

436

hatch.

nauplii and infusoria.

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

Aplocheilichthys kongoranensis,

WC, Rufiji River Camp,

Tanzania

~.

Fam.: Poeciliidae Subfam.: Aplocheilichthyinae

SEEGERS, 1984

Aplocheilichthys lacustris Syn.: Aplocheilichthys maculatus tris.

lacus-

Hab.: Africa: Tanzanian coastal basin south of Dar es Salaam in the Mbezi Basin and at Kibiti.

F.1.: January 1981 by EGGERS, KASSELMANN, and SEEGERS. Sex.:

dd

are

slightly larger,

have

a

deeper caudal peduncle, a golden brown body, and brightly colored fins.

22 are generally paler with a stout anterior body and rather transparent fins. Soc. B.: Like A. maculatus; in their natural biotope, A. lacustris can be found swimming along the water surface in small groups, though each preserves its “personal space,” even while swimming.

B: As for A. kongoranensis, but this species is easier to breed. F: C; small live foods. Flakes can be fed

occasionally. S: A. lacustris was initially described as a subspecies of A. maculatus, but an additional population was found outside the type locality in a large lake at Kibiti, and since the two populations correspond both in color and meristic values, yet deviate from the two like populations of A. maculatus of Lake Baringo and north of Dar es Salaam, A. lacustris deserves species status. Morphological characteristics further confirm this taxonomic classification.

M: As for A. kongoranensis. T: 22°-26°C, L: 3.5 cm, A: 60 cm, R:t, m, D: 23

Aplocheilichthys maculatus Spotted lampeye

KLAUSEWITZ, 1957

Syn.: None.

Lake

Hab.: Africa: Lake Baringo, Kenya, and Tanzanian coastal regions north of Dar es Salaam.

ter.

F.1.: 1956 by Tropicarium Frankfurt, Co. Sex.: dd have brighter colors and larger fins. 2@ have virtually transparent fins, a more slender caudal peduncle, and a fuller anterior body. Soc. B.: In nature, these fish are usually found in small groups, rarely singly. Peaceful animals that only resort to bit-

ing if placed in limited confines. They do not school.

B: The animals are adhesive spawners. Eggs are laid on plants, peat fibers, or similar materials. After 2-3 weeks—depending on temperature—the young hatch and can immediately be fed Artemia nauplii. F: C; small live foods and flakes.

S: This species has a notoriously disjointed distribution. The relation between the populations of Lake Baringo in Kenya and those of the coastal regions of TanZania is not clear; the fish look identical.

M: Keep ina small, well-planted aquarium containing either conspecifics or small heterospecifics. Water chemistry does not seem to be particularly important; populations from the coastal region of Tanzania are found in neutral to slightly

acid and soft water,

while those from

T: 22°-26°C, L: 3.5. cm, A: 60 cm, R:t, m, D: 2-3

438

Baringo live in hard, alkaline wa-

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

Aplocheilichthys lacustris, WC,

Aplocheilichthys maculatus,

WC,

Kibiti, Tanzania

S Bagamoyo,

Tanzania

.

Fam.: Poeciliidae Subfam.: Aplocheilichthyinae

(BOULENGER, 1914)

Aplocheilichthys moeruensis Moeru lampeye Syn.: Haplochilus moeruensis, Haplochilichthys moeruensis, Micropanchax moeruensis. Hab.: Africa: south Zaire (Shaba) and north Zambia in Lakes Moero and Mweru Wantipa as well as their respective drainages and headwaters, e.g., Luapula River. F.I.: 1986 by SEEGERS and co-travelers from Lake Mweru Wantipa, Zambia. Sex.: Sometimes differences are very slight. dd are comparatively more slender and brighter blue with yellowish gray fins. The 22 are often larger with a rounder anterior body. Their colors are less intense, and the fins are almost transparent.

Soc. B.: Retiring, almost shy species. Although the fish seek the company of conspecifics in a community aquarium, each animal requires individual space. They are not true schooling fish. M: Can be kept in small to medium-sized aquaria. Aquatic vegetation should be arranged to form hiding places. A. mo-

eruensis is nearly always found among plants close to the shore, rarely in the open water. Only calm, small fishes are suitable tankmates. The water should be soft to medium-hard with an acidic to neutral pH. B: Not very difficult in a species tank. As

long as the tank is choked with plants, fry can be left in the tank, since they will find shelter among the vegetation. Breeding these fish in a more efficient manner requires a small tank with fineleaved plants (peat or synthetic fibers) and either pairs or a group made-up of

more 22 than od. Remove the parents after one week. Young hatch after about 2 weeks and are collected or left in the same tank and fed infusoria and Artemia salina. Growth is slow. F: C; small live foods, particularly Artemia salina nauplii. S: This very unpretentious species has possibly been confused in the literature with other species. Its relationship to A. myaposae (BOULENGER, 1908) is undefined.

T: 20°-26°C, L: 4 cm, A: 60 cm, R: t, m, Drs

Aplocheilichthys myaposae Syn.: Haplochilus myaposae, Haplochilichthys myaposae, Micropanchax myaposae.

Hab.: South Africa: small bodies of water and swampy regions of the basins of the Cuianzu and Ciulo Rivers in Angola to the Okavango Basin in Botswana, the Zambezi Basin in Zambia, Zimbabwe, Mozambique, and northern South Africa (Natal, Transvaal). F.I: Unknown.

Sex.: dd are a brighter blue and have larger fins. 22 are fuller anteriorly. Soc. B.: Peaceful, small fish. Like most Aplocheilichthys species, these animals form loose schools. T: 20°-26°C, L: 4.cm, A: 60 cm, R:t, m, D: 3

440

(BOULENGER, 1908) M: As for A. kongoranensis. B: Refer to A. kongoranensis maculatus.

and A.

F: C; small live foods and flake foods.

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

Aplocheilichthys moeruensis,

Aplocheilichthys myaposae,

WC,

WC,

Lake Mweru

South Africa

Wantipa,

Zambia

~

Fam.: Poeciliidae Subfam.: Aplocheilichthyinae

AHL, 1928

Aplocheilichthys normani Norman’s lampeye Syn.: Aplocheilichthys gambiensis, Micropanchax macrurus manni, Aplocheilichthys manni, Poropanchax manni, P. normani. Hab.: Africa: savanna regions south of the Sahel from Senegal through the Chad Basin to the White Nile in Sudan and the Niger and Benue Basins in Nigeria. F.1.: Unknown.

Sex.: dd are brighter colored, particularly in regard to the blue marking on the top of the iris, and have elongated fins. 2 2 are more matte and have transparent, rounded fins, a rounded

anterior

body, and a more elongated caudal peduncle.

Soc. B.: Peaceful, shy species. It requires less personal space within its loose group than other Aplocheilichthys species. M: Do not associate with large aggressive fishes. Subdued light (floating T: 22°-26°C, L:

442

4cm, A: 60 cm, R:t, m, D: 3

plants) will emphasize its bright eye color. Cover the aquarium well, and leave

free swimming space. The water should be acid to slightly alkaline and soft. Frequent water mended.

exchanges

are

recom-

B: Spawns among plants, etc. Place a group in a moderate-sized tank containing fine-leaved plants. If a high yield is desired, remove the parents when the first young appear, remove the young as they hatch, or collect the eggs. When efficiency is not an issue, parents and young can be kept together in large tanks, since well-fed breeders are not cannibalistic towards their young. Infusoria and Artemia nauplii make appropriate starter foods.

F: C; small live foods such as water fleas and Artemia nauplii. Offer flake foods to add variety.

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

This creek in Uganda is inhabited by labyrinth fishes, cichlids, baros, and Aplocheilichthyidae.

443

.

Fam.: Poeciliidae Subfam.: Aplocheilichthyinae

WILDEKAMP, 1977

Aplocheilichthys omoculatus Syn.: None. Hab.: Africa: Tanzania, in the Little Ruaha Basin of central Tanzania.

F.1.: 1976 by WILDEKAMP and company. Sex.: dd are somewhat larger and have a metallic blue body with yellow dorsal and anal fins. 22 are more matte and have transparent unpaired fins. ‘Soc. B.: Peaceful and shy species. Not a marked schooling fish, even though they live in loose groups. Only found singly or in small groups in their natural habitat. M: Although best kept in a plant-choked aquarium, an area must be kept open to allow the fish to swim. In nature, the fish

were found along swampy creek edges (Little Ruaha, southwest Sao Hill, Tanzania), Data from this biotope on June 24,

1985, at about 2 p.m. were as follows: air temperature 17.8°C, water temperature 15.2°C, pH 6.3, dGH and dkKH less than 1°, conductivity 13.5 uS. Barbs and one Amphilius were by-catches. Similar water values should prevail in aquaria containing these animals. Note the cool water

temperature.

B: Water values should be very close to those found in its natural habitat; however, the temperature should be slightly higher. These animals are adhesive spawners, so add Java moss, peat fibers, or synthetic fibers to the tank to act aS a spawning substrate. Juveniles hatch after about 14 days and immediately accept Artemia salina nauplii. F: C; live foods commiserate to its size.

T: 16°-22°C, L: 3.5 cm, A: 60 cm, R:t, m,.b, D: 3

Aplocheilichthys pfaffi Pfaff's lampeye

DAGET, 1954

Syn.: Micropanchax pfaffi, Aplocheilichthys kingi (not BOULENGER, 1918), A. longicauda.

M: As for A. omoculatus; however, it should be kept at higher temperatures,

Hab.: Africa: savanna regions south of the Sahel belt from Guinea through Mali, the northern lvory Coast, north Ghana, Burkina Faso, north Nigeria, Niger, north Cameroon, Chad, and Sudan.

ter.

F.1.: To Holland in February of 1980 by K. ZISDERVELD from Ouagadougou, Burkina Faso,

i.€., 238°-26°C. A. pfaffi likes moving waB: As for A. omoculatus

F: C; small live foods as well as flakes.

S: The pictured fish’s identification is not absolutely sure. A. pfaffi may be a synonym of a previously described species.

Sex.: Sometimes differences are very slight. d 3 tend to be a more pronounced blue-silver, and their fins are larger and slightly silver-blue. 29 are an inconspicuous hue with rounder and more transparent’ fins. Their anterior body is rounder, and their caudal peduncle is somewhat narrower.

Soc. B.: See Aplocheilichthys omoculatus. T: 22°-26°C, L: 3 cm, A: 60 cm, R:t, m, D: 3-4

444

and A. usan-

guensis, though when breeding, the temperature must be elevated.

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

é

Aplocheilichthys omoculatus,

WC, Kibaha, Tanzania

Aplocheilichthys pfaffi, Ovagadougou,

Burkina

Faso

~

Fam.: Poeciliidae Subfam.: Aplocheilichthyinae

DAGET, 1964

Aplocheilichthys rancureli Filamentous lampeye Syn.: Poropanchax rancureli, Micropanchax rancureli, Aplocheilichthys macrophthalmus

MEINKEN,

1932.

Hab.: Africa: rivers and creeks of the coastal plains of southwestern Ghana and the southern Ivory Coast.

F.l.: 1954 by SHELJUZHKO from the Ivory Coast to Munich. Sex.: Sexes are not always easy to distinguish. d 3 are slimmer and have elongated unpaired fins. Their body is bluegreen and, depending on the light, strongly iridescent with a faint longitudinal stripe running along its center. The fins are yellow; some populations have red-fringed fins (see photo). 2 2 havea stouter, anteriorly fuller body and small, rounded, transparent fins.

M: As for Aplocheilichthys camerunensis. Clean water and good filtration are necessary to maintain this somewhat sensitive species. B: As forA.camerunensis. Not very pro-

lific. F: C; small live foods and Artemia plii.

nau-

S: A. rancureli is repeatedly confused with A. macrophthalmus, its closest relative. The latter has a more southern distribution.

Soc. B.: See Aplocheilichthys kongoranensis. 1;24°=26°C; Ev 35 cm, Aa 40cm

Retin:

Aplocheilichthys: usanguensis Usangu lampeye Syn.: Aplocheilichthys

WILDEKAMP,

sp. “Mbeya.”

Hab.: Africa: southeast Tanzania, at Usangu Flats and the upper basin of the Great Ruaha. F.1.: 1976 by WILDEKAMP elers.

and co-trav-

Sex.: Both sexes have a bluish silver body. dd have a black line along the upper edge of the operculum and yellow dorsal, ventral, and anal fins. Dominant specimens occasionally have a yellow caudal peduncle as well. 22 have a fuller anterior body, a slimmer caudal peduncle, and transparent fins.

is present, e.g., Java moss. Newly hatched fry must be fed infusoria, since Artemia nauplii are too large. F: C; small live foods. Flake foods are occasionally accepted. S: Like A. maculatus, A. usanguensis is also a member of the subgenus Lacustricola. The black spot on the upper edge of the operculum is one characteristic of the subgenus.

Soc. B.: As for Aplocheilichthys omoculatus. Not a pronounced schooling fish. Gregarious, yet they require individual space. M: See A. omoculatus. Maintain moderate temperatures.

under

B: See A. omoculatus. Fry can be reared in the breeding tank if sufficient shelter T: 17°-22°C, L: 3 cm, A: 40 cm, R: t, m, D: 3-4

446

1977

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps



Aplocheilichthys

rancureli

Aplocheilichthys

usanguensis

Fam.: Poeciliidae (MYERS & CARVALHOI in MYERS, 1955) Fluviphylax pygmaeus Subfam.: Fluviphylacinae South American lampeye, pygmy lampeye Syn.: Potamophylax pygmaeus. Hab.: South America: its tributaries.

the Amazon

and

F.1.: In July of 1985, E. FRECH and A. WERNER imported three specimens from Santarem.

Sex.: dd have yellowish fins and a yellow-brown to bluish body that has several vertical gray stripes that fade posteriorly. The gray-blue 2 2 (see photo) do not have vertical stripes, the fins are smaller and, for the most part, transparent.

Soc. B.: This schooling fish is probably similar to Aplocheilichthys species, where each animal, despite living in a group, requires a certain distance from other members of the school.

M: Information is sparse because FOERSCH (DATZ, 40 (2): 65-66, 1987)

is the only person to date that has ever maintained this fish. It will live in captivity, but its diminutive size complicates its maintenance. A species tank is definitely required. However, the most difficult part of caring for these animals is acquiring them in the first place. B: A lack of imported animals has precluded this endeavor. Breeding is probably similar to other small Aplocheilichthys. Whether or not the smallest foods are administered the first days posthatch is probably decisive tor success or fail-

ure. F: C; smallest live foods, including Artemia nauplii. S: This very small sensitive Aplocheilichthyidae is the only family member found in the Americas.

Ti: 24°-26°C; Ls 2 cm, Az 30cm, R:t, De4

Hypsopanchax catenatus Chain lampeye

RADDA, 1981 Subfam.: Aplocheilichthyinae

Syn.: None.

F: C; moderate-sized

Hab.: Africa: southeast Gabon, 61 km south of Franceville on the road to Boumango between Madziba and Mboki.

avoid worms.

F.1.: July 1980 by HOFMANN

and PURZL

to Vienna. Sex.: dd have brighter colors and a broader anal fin base; 2 9, in contrast, are smaller and have a more rounded anterior body.

Soc. B.: Peaceful fish. Keep a group. M: As for Plataplochilus ngaensis. H. catenatus also requires clean, excellent water.

B: This species was not further distributed after its import (only ¢ 3?). Consequently, nothing is known about its breeding behavior, but it should be similar to P. ngaensis. T: 22°-26°C, L: 6 cm, A: 80 cm, R:t, m, D: 4

448

live foods. Try to

S: Closely related to Hypsopanchax zebra.

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

Z Hypsopanchax

catenatus,

:

a

WC from the type locality

.

Fam.: Poeciliidae Subfam.: Aplocheilichthyinae

MYERS, 1955

Pantanodon podoxys Syn.: None. Hab.: Africa: narrow coastal regions of east Africa from Kenya to Tanzania, perhaps also in Mozambique, near mangroves and brackish water swamps. To

date it has been found at three sites: Malindi, Tanga, and Dar es Salaam. F.1.: 1978 by WILDEKAMP elers from Dar es Salaam.

Sex.:

dd

are

and co-trav-

commonly

larger and

brighter blue with bigger dorsal and anal

fins; the dorsal fin may be yellowish. 2 2 hardly have any color in their fins, andes their anterior body is rounder.

Soc. B.: Not a schooling fish in the true sense of the word, though the animals live in groups. Rarely found alone. Peaceful towards both conspecifics and heterospecifics.

initially thought. Successful breeding and long-term care have failed because of lack of imports. Following water values in its natural habitat, the aquarium water should be saline and not overly soft or acid. The fish require plenty of free swimming space. B: Little information is available, but the fish seem to breed like Aplocheilichthys species (Substrate spawners). F: C; all kinds of live foods and, occasionally, flake foods.

S: Due to research on preserved specimens by WHITEHEAD (1962), it was initially supposed that P. podoxys subsisted solely on planktonic foods. But live imported animals have proven this false. There are no special dietary requirements.

M: Little information is available, but the species seems to be easier to keep than T: 24°-28°C, L:5 cm, A: 80 cm, R:t, m, D: 4

Plataplochilus chalcopyrus Syn.:'None. Hab.: West River 50 km Mouila. The Fougamou, Mouila (not

Africa: Gabon, in the Diala south of Lambarene towards pictured strain comes from south of Lambarene towards far from the type locality).

F.I.: 1976 by BOCHTLER and HERZOG. Sex.: dd have a blue body and transparent yellow fins with a reddish fringe. Although all fins are elongated, the caudal fin is notably so. The lighter colored 2 2 are smaller without elongated fins.

Soc. B.: See Plataplochilus ngaensis. Mi As for R. ngaensis. B: As for P. ngaensis. F: C; live foods and, occasionally, flake

foods. S: HUBER (1981) considers P. chalcopyrus and P. ngaensis synonymous, T: 22°-26°C, L:5 cm, A: 80 cm, R:t, m, D:3

450

LAMBERT, 1963 but the type specimens would have to be examined and compared to make

this decision. The pictured animal seems to have much in common to the type specimen of P. chalcopyrus and is definitely not identical to the fish now imported as P. ngaensis (LANDSBERG and NUMRICH have made new collections which can be used as a reference). Specimens imported in 1976 by BOCHTLER and HERZOG and distributed as P. chalcopyrus are slimmer fish that have a longer snout and a more posteriorly situated dorsal fin.

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

{

Pantanodon podoxys,

WC, TZ 83/1, Dar es Salaam, Tanzania

x

Plataplochilus chalcopyrus,

Fougamou,

south of Lambarene,

Gabon

Fam.: Poeciliidae Subfam.: Aplocheilichthyinae

(PELLEGRIN, 1924)

Plataplochilus loemensis Syn.: Haplochilus loemensis, Aplocheilichthys loemensis, Procatopus loemensis, P. cabindae (not BOULENGER, 1911). Hab.: West Africa: coastal plains of Zaire, Angola, Congo (country of type locality), and southwest Gabon.

F.1.: 1986 by Max AMMER, Holland.

Wapenfeld,

Sex.: Full-grown ¢¢ are more colorful, but less so in bred specimens. The d's anal fin is rectangular. 2 2 have an almost triangular anal fin.

regular water exchanges, and aeration are necessary. Avoid high temperatures; 22°-24°C are sufficient. Since this species is susceptible to Oodinium, salt added to the water is recommended. B: Quite difficult, even for specialists. The animals are adhesive spawners which place their eggs on plants or a perlon mop. If the water is not exceptionally clean, many of the eggs will fungus. The eggs should be stored in water containing acriflavine (but very little and not during the days just prior to hatching). After 12-14 days, the fry hatch

Soc. B.: Very lively, active schooling fish. Shy and skittish, particularly if only one or two specimens are kept.

from the relatively large eggs and immediately eat Artemia salina nauplii. Growth is not fast.

M: P. loemensis can be associated with small barbs and/or characins, etc. The tank should contain plenty of free swimming space, but still have roots and vegetation around the edges. Provide diffused lighting and some sun. Water should be soft to medium-hard and slightly acid. Very sensitive to suboptimal water conditions. Good filtration,

F: All types of live foods such as Daphnia, Cyclops, glassworms, mosquito larvae, and Artemia; cautiously feed bloodworms and Tubifex! S: P. loemensis is a lively swimmer that demands a roomy tank. To date, only individual specimens have been imported from Gabon by dedicated aquarists.

T: 22°-24°C, L:6 cm, A: 60 cm, R: m, t, D: 3-4

Plataplochilus miltotaenia Syn.: Procatopus miltotaenia, chilus pulcher.

LAMBERT, 1963 Plataplo-

Hab.: West Africa: Gabon. The type locality of P. miltotaenia is on the road from Libreville to Kango .in northwest Gabon at PK 40. The pictured specimen was captured 20 km south of Lambarene, that is, south of Ogowe.

F.I.: 1976 by BOCHTLER and HERZOG. Sex.: Similar to other species of Plataplochilus. 3 3 are larger with elongated fins, a red stripe that extends from their eye into the caudal fin, and a blue body, the intensity of which depends on the amount of light. 2 2 are inconspicuously colored and lack elongated fins. Though present, the red lateral stripe is almost invisible. T: 22°-26°C, L:5 cm, A: 80 cm, R:t, m, D:3

452

Soc. B.: Like P. ngaensis. M: As for P. ngaensis. B: As for P. ngaensis. F: C; live foods and, occasionally, flake foods. S: The pictured population was sold as Plataplochilus pulcher. HUBER (1981) considers P. pulcher to be a synonym of P. miltotaenia. This book follows the latter opinion. It is possible that P. pulcher is a synonym of P. ngaensis, which may also be the case for P. miltotaenia, Although the red line is less accented in P. ngaensis, it is present. Comparing the type specimens is the only way to resolve these questions.

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

)

Plataplochilus

loemensis

Plataplochilus miltotaenia,

south of Lambarene,

Gabon

(AHL, 1924)

Plataplochilus ngaensis

B: While Java moss or similar materials

Syn.: Haplochilichthys ngaensis, Procatopus ngaensis, Aplocheilichthys ngaensis, Plataplochilus mimus, ? P. pulcher.

may be used as a spawning

Hab.: West Africa: northwest Gabon and southwestern Equatorial Guinea.

For efficient reproduction, each ¢ requires his own spawning substrate. Sometimes the fish spawn in a group. After the fish spawn, remove the substrate and transfer it into a small aquarium until the young hatch. While it is possible to collect the eggs, those laid deep in the substrate may be damagea as they are removed. The young, depending on temperature, need about 2 weeks to hatch. Infusoria and Artemia

F.I.: 1986 by LANDSBERG & NUMRICH? Sex.: 6d are blue, becoming more iridescent towards the caudal fin, with a faint strioe running along its side. The fins are transparent and yellowish and partially elongated, particularly the upper lobe of the caudal fin. In contrast, 22 are smaller, have rounded instead of elongated fins, and a more matte coloration.

Soc. B.: Although

P. ngaensis

substrate,

they are just as likely to press their eggs into crevices and cracks, for example, filter intake slits or large-pored sponges.

nauplii are suitable initial foods. Growth ~

is a so-

iS SIOW.

cial fish, it does not school. Each specimen requires its own free space les

F: C; live foods, particularly planktonic

hostilities and injuries occur

items

M: Requires very clean, well-filtered water. The aquarium cannot be overly small. Plant the edges with a free hand, and partially cover the surface with floating plants. The water should be soft with a neutral or slightly acid pH. Frequent water exchanges are a necessity.

S: The type specimens hail from the Noja River south of the border between Gabon and Equatorial Guinea. It is possible that nga = ngaensis originated from a typographical error (nga vs. noja).

i: 20°=26°C.

Sem, Ancolen:

Plataplochilus miltotaenia

454

Raum

Das

Killifisnes, Egg-L

Z

ra

ik Ay

ieee

ar

Lake George, Uganda. The reed or papyrus shore may best be crossed at a hippopotamus pass, but beware ...

455

~.

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Aplocheilinae

(POLL, 1952)

Epiplatys [Aphyoplatys] duboisi Congo killle Syn.: Aplocheilus duboisi. Hab.: Africa: eastern Congo and western Zaire, in drainage basins of the lower Kasai and central Zaire as well as the western Zaire tributaries.

F.I.: 1953 (?) by P. BRICHARD. Sex.: ¢6¢ are blue to blue-green with red dots arranged in 5-6 longitudinal _rows. The fins are usually blue with red dots and elongated. Depending on the population, the fins will either have a yellow or blue fringe with submarginal red stripes. 22 are paler and do not have elongated fins.

Soc. B.: Small, peaceful, shy species.

B: Set the tank up as if breeding adhesive-spawning Epiplatys species, one spawning mop or peat fibers as its sole decoration and perhaps a small filter. One pair per breeding tank is optimal. The parents are removed after one week, or the eggs can be collected from the spawning substrate. The young, which hatch after 1-2 additional weeks, have

to be fed infusoria, since Artemia nauplii are too large. F: C; small live foods. Artemia can also be fed to adults.

nauplii

S: A very small, relatively sensitive species.

M: In accordance with their origin of rain forest biotopes, use soft, slightly acid water. Though the aquarium does not need to be large, it should offer hiding places, for example, within dense vegetation. T: 22°-26°C, Lk: 3.5 cm, An60icm, Rt

my, De4

Continuation of Aphyosemion bualanum kekemense (p. 462): This species can also be bred like a roon to the Central African Republic. Alsubstrate spawner; hydrate the peat most every creek within its distribution (peat fibers are better than just peat) area (Savanna zones) has a different after 3 weeks. Raise the newly hatched strain. Each of the various strains should young with Artemia nauplii and infusobe kept separate to avoid crossbreedria. ing. Pass each strain on with corresponding habitat information to maintain F: C; live foods. pure strains and prevent chaotic crossS: A. b. kekemense is one of numerous es. geographic strains found from CameT: 20°-24°C, L:5 cm, A: 60 cm, R: m, b, D:

456

g24

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

Epiplatys [Aphyoplatys| duboisi

Aphyoplatys duboisi

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Aplocheilinae

RADDA,

Aphyosemion amieti Amiet’s killie Syn.: None. Hab.: Africa: western.Cameroon, in a small area near the lower Sanaga and neighboring systems in the rain forest.

F.I.: In 1974 by RADDA to Vienna, but the animals died. A new import was made in February of 1975 by PURZL to Vienna. Sex.: See photos. dd are brown dorsally and dark orange ventrally. There are horizontal rows of dots running above the pectoral fins to the caudal fin which frequently coalesce into pronounced lines, outlining the orange zone. The outer edge of the anal fin and the lower caudal fin are blue with a dark red stripe proximally. The dorsal and upper tail fin are red and blue-green patterned with a

blue fringe.

T: 22°-28°C,

ee,

Aphyosemion

458

Soc. B.: A robust and usually peaceful species. Behaves like Aphyosemion gardneri. M: Not difficult to care for. Recommen-

dations made for A. gardneri largely hold true for this species. B: See A. gardneri. A. amieti should be treated as a substrate spawner.

F: C; hardy live foods. After the fish are acclimated, frozen foods and various commercial foods can be fed occasionally.

S: This species is related to A. puerzii, the A. gardneri group, and A. fallax.

22 are brown with rows of

small, light red dots which into the fins.

may extend

L: 7 cm, A: 80 cm, R: m, b, t, D: 2-3

Ss

banforense,

es

see p. 460

1976

Killifisnes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps



Aphyosemion

amieti

3

Aphyosemion

amieti

2

~

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Aplocheilinae

RADDA & PURZL, 1976

Aphyosemion amoenum Syn.: None.

Hab.: West Africa: Cameroon, the Nyong system, in a creek close to Sonbo.

F.l.: December

RADDA.

1975 by PURZL and

Sex.: dd are a colorful blue to bluegreen, becoming orange posteriorly. Of the four longitudinal rows of red dots, the dots of the top two often merge into lines. A. cameronense forms—which includes this species—typically have a red stripe along their ventral side that extends into the caudal fin. The unpaired fins have numerous close red stripes running along the fin rays. These stripes are less pronounced along the edge of its tail fin, being replaced by blue-white and orange areas. The dorsal and anal fins are orange. 2° are a solid brown with red spots or lines and round, brown transparent fins.

M: Like all representatives of the A. cameronense group, this species is somewhat problematic to maintain. The aquarium should contain soft to mediumhard, slightly acid water. The substrate should be dark, and vegetation should be included to provide hiding places. A species tank is recommended, but they can be kept with small, peaceful fishes.

B: Not simple. Treat them as adhesive spawners. Collect the eggs regularly from the spawning substrate (wool mop) and place them in another container to hatch. After 12-14 days, the fry hatch and require infusoria and Artemia nauplii for the first few days. F: C; live foods of all kinds. Feed worms sparingly. S: A. amoenum belongs to the subgenus Mesoaphyosemion in the A. came-

ronense

group.

Soc. B.: Peaceful and rather shy. dd are hostile towards ¢ conspecifics and congeners. T: 20°-24°C, L: 5 cm, A: 60 cm, R: b, m,

(SEEGERS, 1982)

Aphyosemion [Roloffia] banforense Syn.: Aphyosemion liberiensis BOULENGER, 1908), A. nigrifluvi.

(not

Hab.: West Africa: central Guinea near Mamou, southern Burkina Faso around

Banfora and the Comoé Basin, and possibly south of the Sahel zone in Guinea, Mali, and the Ivory Coast.

F.I.: July 1979 by ROMAND,

SCHMITT,

and GUIGNARD from Guinea to France. October 1980 by B. BAUER from Burkina Faso to Germany. Sex.: dd are green with red-brown dots. Both the top and the bottom of the caudal fin have a submarginal red-brown longitudinal stripe. The dorsum and dorsal fin are bronze. The pectoral, ventral, and anal fins have a smoky black edge. 2 @ are solid brown with dark red-brown T222°-26°C,

460

Lz 5 em, A: 60cm,

dots. Their fins are

round

and

translu-

cent.

Soc. B.: The fish live singly and are relatively shy, though to what extent depends on the individual. M: As for all other Aphyosemion species—a dark substrate (peat?), dim light, and plants that tolerate these conditions such as Java moss, Java fern, and Anubias. The water should be soft and neutral.

B: Set up either as an adhesive or substrate spawner. Similar to most other small Aphyosemion species. See A. punctatum.

F: C; live foods commiserate to its size, particularly mosquito larvae.

R2t;m; b, D: 3

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

Aphyosemion

Aphyosemion

amoenum

[Roloffia] banforense

3, WC, Banfora,

Burkina Faso

~

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Aplocheilinae

(BOULENGER, 1911)

Aphyosemion batesii Syn.: Fundulus batesii, Fundulopanchax batesii, Raddaella batesii, Aphyosemion spectabile, Fundulus gustavi, Fundulus splendidus?, Aphyosemion (Fundulopanchax) schreineri, Aphyosemion kunZing Hab.: Africa: from the Dja and Sanaga Basins in southeast Cameroon through northern Gabon and the lvindo Basin to the Congo region of northern Zaire. F.I.: 1971 by HERZOG, RADDA, and cotravelers.

Sex.: dd are usually larger and, depending on population, quite colorful with elongated fins. 22 are brown to gray with round fins.

Soc.

B.: d¢

are usually peaceful to-

wards heterospecifics, particularly in large tanks. However, they tend to be aggressive towards conspecific dd.

Even unripe



are not spared from

enmities when housed in small tanks. 22 are generally peaceful. M: Never keep two 6. Either keep singly or a group in a medium-sized aquarium with several 2 2. Hiding places must T: 22°-26°C,

be provided for nondominant fish. The water should be acidic to neutral and soft to medium-hard water.

B: Most successful when bred as a substrate spawner. Offer a peat substrate. Place one 6 with several 22 and feed sparingly. After one week, the breeders should be removed and the peat lightly pressed and stored warm in a plastic bag for about 6 weeks (label). The peat is then rehydrated in an aquarium with cool water, and the hatching young are immediately fed Artemia nauplii. Growth is rapid. The peat can be dried and rehydrated in 14 days; this can be repeated several times.

F: C; all types of live foods as well as

larger food items, including beef heart. S: It has not been unquestionably decided if the nominate species A. splen-

didum

(PELLEGRIN,

L: 7.5 cm, A: 80 cm, R: m, b, D: 3

Aphyosemion bualanum kekemense Syn.: None. Hab.: Africa: west Cameroon, near the town of Kekem, 35 km north northeast of

N’'kongsamba on the road to Bafoussam.

F.I.: 1973 by RADDA and SCHEEL. Sex.: dd have elongated fins and numerous red vertical striations along their blue to blue-green body, resulting in a

bright, colorful animal. 2 2 are brownish with red spots that form short vertical stripes on the body. Their fins are largely transparent and round. Soc. B.: Peaceful, cies,

rather shy subspe-

RADDA & SCHEEL, 1975 M: As for most small Aphyosemion species. See A. punctatum. The red colors are displayed the best under moderate lighting. The water in their natural habitat was soft and slightly acid (pH 6) and between 21° and 23°C. The water in its Captive environment should mirror these values. B: A. bualanum should be bred as an adhesive spawner. Either use a continuOus set-up or remove the parents after

one from wool ment ium

week. Collect the eggs regularly the spawning material (Java moss, mop, peat fibers). Egg developin a rearing dish containing aquarwater requires about 16-18 days.

Continued on p. 456.

462

1930) and A. kunzi

RADDA, 1975 are autonomous species. They are probably merely populations within one large distribution area. A. batesii has been placed within the subgenus Raddaella by HUBER (1977).

Killifisnhes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

Aphyosemion batesii 3, WC, Bumba, Zaire, Z 86/9

Aphyosemion

bualanum

kekemense

.

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Aplocheilinae

RADDA & HUBER, 1978

Aphyosemion buytaerti Buytaert’s killie Syn.: None. Hab.: Africa: southwest Congo, in the Ekouma Creek near Ogoué between Zanaga and Voula II. Only known from the type locality (collection code RPC

28). F.l.: July 1978 by BUYTAERT and WACHTERS to Belgium. Sex.: ¢¢ are more colorful. They are green along their anterior dorsum, but yellow ventrally. Within the green area are longitudinal rows of red dots. The dorsal fin and upper caudal fin are finely outlined in blue. The lower fins, including the lower lobe of the caudal fin, have a yellow fringe. 2° are brown with red dots that are also present in their colorless, transparent fins. Soc. B.: Thoroughly peaceful. M: This form is difficult to maintain and especially troublesome to breed. It requires meticulously clean water. OtherPeli mel

Gulewo.cms As COLI

wise, follow recommendations made for A. punctatum. The water temperature should be temperate. Water in its natural biotope was as follows: 18°C, pH 7.2, conductivity 40 uS, and a high iron concentration. B: See A. punctatum. Breeding has proven to be extraordinarily difficult. Captive populations are extinct once again. F: C; live foods commiserate to its size.

S: A. buytaerti is probably not a true species, but a strain of A. wachtersi. The photos in the Aquarium Atlas bear witness to this. Bred specimens of nominate A. buytaerti are even more similar to A. wachtersi. Both A. buytaerti and A. wachtersi mikeae are probably just regional stains of A. wachtersi. Only new collections can prove whether or not they

have stable characteristics and can be recognized

as subspecies.

Eatin O) Dr4

SCHEEL,

Aphyosemion celiae Margined killie Syn.: None.

Hab.: Africa: west Cameroon, springs and small rain forest creeks in the basin of the Mungo River.

1971

can be fed Artemia nauplii from the beginning. F: C: live foods.

S: A. celiae is an extemely variable spe-

F.l.: 1971 by SCHEEL.

cies that has very different geographi-

Sex.: ¢¢ are red-brown, but blue-green anteriorly. The fins have a yellow or white edge followed proximally by a red band. 29 are a uniform brown. Red-brown dots are only faintly visible.

cal morphs. There are a number of transitional strains that are very similar in appearance to A. calliurum which confounds groupings. This includes very colorful forms with broad yellow fin

Soc. B.: Peaceful, rather shy species. Since it has been known to leap from the water when disturbed, a cover is necessary., M: Like all small Aphyosemion species, it should be maintained in soft and slightly acid to neutral water. See A.

fringes, one of which has been described as A. celiae winifredae. All of these morphs should be kept pure and passed along with a description of their origin—if available—as mentioned under A. bualanum.

punctatum.

B: As for A. bualanum, but this is a more pronounced substrate spawner. The fry 1222°-26°C;

464

Ly 45.em, Az60'cmy) Ramos

bas

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

Cameroon Aphyosemion celiae, F; Loc. 26,

~

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Aplocheilinae

HUBER & RADDA, 1977

Aphyosemion citrineipinnis Lemon-fin killie Syn.: None.

Hab.: West Africa: central Gabon, in the Ngounié system on the western slope of the Du-Chaillu Massif.

F.I.: 1976 by HUBER and RADDA. Sex.: The 66 have blue sides, a brown dorsum, and yellow fins. 2° are predominantly brown, and their fins are mostly transparent.

Soc. B.: This small, peaceful, shy species leads a reclusive life in large aquaria, hardly ever emerging. M: As for all small Aphyosemion species; refer to A. punctatum. Due to its delicate nature, this fish should not be

kept in a community aquarium. Water should be soft to medium-hard, slightly acid, and temperate. B: See A. punctatum. Either breed as an adhesive or substrate spawner. Correspondingly, the eggs can be collected and hatched in water or dried. This species is not very prolific. At high temperatures (above 22°C), breeding frequently terminates. F: C; live foods, especially mosquito larvae. S: It is questionable if A. citrineipinnis is truly an autonomous species, as it may be just a population of A. ocel/atum.

T: 18°-22°C, L:5 cm, A: 50 cm, R: m, b,

Aphyosemion fallax

AHL, 1935

Swallow-tail killie

Syn.: Fundulopanchax spurrelli (not BOULENGER, 1913), Aphyosemion gulare schwoiseri, A. kribianum. Hab.: Africa: coastal basin of west Cameroon, from Malende-Nyoke N Muyuka to Kribi.

F.I.: 1930 or 1931 burg.

by Aquarium

Ham-

Sex.: See Vol. 2, p. 602. d¢ are quite colorful, being green-yellow to greenblue with red spots. These spots, depending on the population (Malende strain), can coalesce into longitudinal bands, particularly above the lateral line. The fins are elongated. The tail fin is forked and both the topmost and bottommost rays are elongated. Particularly beautiful specimens have an elongated anal fin. 2 2 are brown and can be distinguished from other Aphyosemion species by their dark spot on the caudal peduncle. Soc. B.: Normally peaceful towards heterospecifics. dd can be aggressive among themselves. Immature 22 may

be bitten to death. As a precaution, transport singly.

M: See Vol. 2, p. 602. Compare this species to A. sjoestedti. B: See Vol. 2, p. 602. F: C; large live foods. S: The northern strain from Malende which was described as Aphyosemion gulare schwoiseri has reached Germany in recent years. It is therefore presented here as a comparison to the southern form from Kribi that was introduced in Vol. 2, p. 602. A. fallax has different geographic populations in the coastal regions of Cameroon. That these populations are in fact A. fallax has only recently become apparent (SEEGERS:

DATZ, 39 (8): 347-351, 1986). The fish maintained from the '60's to prior to 1986 (some perhaps even today) as A. fallax are really a strain of Aohyosemion gulare (see in Vol. 1, p. 533). A. fallax is the closest relative of A. sjoestedti and continues its distribution south. Its body morphology and design are similar (see Vol. 1, p. 539 and Vol. 2, p. 608).

T: 22°-26°C, L: 9 cm, A: 100 cm, R: b, m, D: 3-4

466

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

Aphyosemion

fallax 3, Malende,

Cameroon

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Aplocheilinae

Aphyosemion

fallax

Aphyosemion

fallax, Movanke,

468

2°, Malende,

Cameroon

Cameroon

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

Aphyosemion

franzwerneri

6, WC, Cameroon,

type locality

SCHEEL,

Aphyosemion franzwerneri Werner’s roundtail killie Syn.: None. Hab.: West Africa: Cameroon, basin of the lower Sanaga and Wuri. Few habi-

tats are known; the type locality is a small spring pool 15 km north of the fork in the road of Douala-Edea-Yabassi wards Yabassi.

to-

F.I.: To Denmark in January 1969 by J J) SCHEEL. Sex.: Not always as clearly defined as other Aphyosemion species. dd have a design of red-brown dots and spots on a yellowish to greenish brown background. The caudal fin has a yellow fringe. The 2 °'s fins are more rounded, and the caudal fin hardly has a yellow fringe. Their body is not quite as colorful, and their anterior body is fuller.

Soc. B.: Peaceful, shy species.

T: 22°-26°C,

1971

M: In nature the fish live in tiny bodies of water among fallen leaves, plants, and similar iterns. The water was acidic (pH 6) with a hardness of less than 1° dGH. Provide shallow, similarly composed water in its captive environment. The shallow water is to accommodate its poor swimming ability and benthic lifestyle. B: Difficult and not very productive; best attempted in a separate breeding tank with peat fibers, wool mops, etc., from which the eggs can be collected and transferred into a hatching dish. After 14-16 days, the young hatch and should be fed infusoria at first; from the second to third day, Artemia nauplii can be added to their diet. Growth is slow. F: C; live foods.

S: Do not confuse their unusual hopping locomotion with ill health

L: 5 cm, A: 60 cm, R: b, D: 4

469

~

~

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Aplocheilinae

(BOULENGER, 1911)

Aphyosemion gardneri gardneri Clausen’s steel-blue killie Syn.: Haplochilus brucii, Fundulus gardneri, Fundulopanchax gardneri.

F: C; live foods. After acclimation, beef heart and flakes are also accepted.

Hab.: West Africa: Nigeria. The type locality is Okwoga (70°N, 7°45’E), Cross

S: Several

River Basin, southeastern

F.l.: The nominate

Nigeria

form was

probably

imported for the first time in 1974 by PURZL and RADDA. Sex.: dd are a colorful blue-green with

red dots.

22 are brown to gray-brown

with red-brown

dots.

Soc. B.: This robust species is a suggested beginner fish. To minimize aggressions among dd, keep either one or a group of the gender, never only two, A group of 22 should be kept as well, since the dd tend to be aggressive towards unripe ° @. M: Odds for successfully maintaining this species are enhanced in tanks supporting heavy plant growth, particularly “Dutch” aquaria. Hiding places should be available. Water values are not critical, though the water should not be overly hard or alkaline.

B: A. gardneri and all its subspecies can be bred as either substrate spawners or adhesive spawners. In the first case, and atrio (1 d and 2 @ 9) is introduced into a 20 | tank containing a peat substrate and medium-hard water with a temperature of 24°-26°C. Provide hiding places among peat fibers and plants for the °°. Leave the breeders in the tank for one week. During that time, feed the breeders light meals of live foods. Remove the water after the parents are transferred and keep the peat slightly moist for 3 weeks in a plastic bag. Afterwards, rehydrate the substrate and eggs with fresh water. The young can be raised with Artemia nauplii. Growth is rapid. When breeding as an adhesive spawner, use a spawning mop, synthetic fibers, or peat fibers instead of peat and regularly collect the eggs and place them in a separate container (2-3 weeks).

T: 22°-26°C,

470

L: 6 cm, A: 60 cm, R: t, m, D: 2

subspecies

of A. gardneri

have been described. Moving from northwest to southeast within the distribution area allows several trends to be followed. The fringes of the fins become less and less yellow and, at the same time, its annual nature diminishes somewhat. The latter development is probably a consequence of the fish adapting to its surroundings. In the north, the fish live in savannas, but in the south, its distribution includes rain forests.

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

Aphyosemion gardneri lacustre

~

.

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Aplocheilinae RADDA,

Aphyosemion gardneri lacustre Syn.: None. Hab.: West Africa: Nigeria, basin of Lake Ejagham; west Cameroon.

1974

specimen to specimen, but as a whole, they are generally duller in this subspecies than in the others.

F.1.: 1970 by HAEFELIN and RADDA. Sex.: It is difficult to distinguish 2° of

Soc. B.: Like the nominate form.

this subspecies from those of other subspecies. dd, in comparison, are more colorful, with a greenish brown and orange body. The anal fin is orange. The intensity of the red spots varies from

B: Experience has shown that this strain is best bred as a substrate spawner. Therefore, use peat as the spawning medium and dry it afterwards.

M: As for the nominate form.

F: C; like the nominate form.

T: 22°-26°C, L: 6 cm, A: 60 cm, R: t, m, D: 2-3

RADDA,

Aphyosemion gardneri mamfense Mamfe killie Syn.: None.

Instead of a broad yellow fringe on the unpaired fins, blues predominate.

Hab.: West Africa: western Cameroon, drainage of the upper Cross River around Mamfe.

F.I.: 1966 by SCHEEL to Denmark. Sex.:

22

dots, while

are brownish with red-brown

¢6

are very colorful. This

subspecies varies greatly in coloration. Hardly one ¢ is similar to another, particularly when comparing various populations. In contrast to other subspecies, A. g. mamfense are generally more greenish. A. g. gardneri, particularly A. g. nigerianum, tends to be more blue.

1974

Soc. B.: Like the nominate form. M: As for the nominate form.

B: Principally like A. gardneri gardneri. In concordance to its rain forest habitat, this subspecies is easier to breed as an adhesive spawner than the nominate form. F: C; like the nominate form.

S: A. g. mamfense is found in the western region of A. gardneri’s distribution.

Tr 22° 24°C, L:'6 cm, A:'60 cm, Rit, m;, Ds 2=3

Aphyosemion gardneri nigerianum Nigeria killie Syn.: Aphyosemion gardneri obuduense. Hab.: West Africa: Nigeria and western Cameroon. Type locality is the Arum at the southern edge of Jos Plateau in central Nigeria. F.I.: In 1913 by BRANDT, many.

Leipzig, Ger-

Sex.: Similar to the nominate form. However, A. g. nigerianum 36 generally have intense yellow borders on the fins followed proximally by a red stripe. The “blue” morph has white- or blue-bordered fins and a dull red-brown stripe instead of the bright red stripe of the previously described morph. T: 22°-26°C, L: 6 cm, A: 60 cm, R: t, m, D: 2

472

CLAUSEN,

1963

Soc. B.: Like the nominate form, but this form may be even more aggressive. M: Like the nominate form.

B: In comparison to other A. gardneri subspecies, A. g. nigerianum is a more pronounced substrate spawner. Use peat as the spawning substrate. F: C; like the nominate form.

S: The subspecies A. g. nigerianum lives in southern and central Nigeria, predomi-

nately in the lower Niger and

Benoué

Basins. It inhabits the majority of the species’ distribution area. See Vol. 1, p. 532.

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

Aphyosemion

gardneri nigerianum,

Akure,

Nigeria

.

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Aplocheilinae

RADDA & PURZL, 1985

Aphyosemion hanneloreae Hannelore’s killie Syn.: None. Hab.: Africa: tributaries of the Nyanga in the central Du Chaillu-Massif in Gabon and possibly Congo. F.I.: To Vienna, in June of 1985 from the locality GHP 85/11 at Malinga, Gabon.

Sex.: As for almost all Aphyosemion species, ¢¢ are more colorful and have elongated unpaired fins. They are yellow-green to brown-green with rows of red dots which often coalesce, forming interrupted longitudinal stripes. The unpaired fins have a yellow fringe followed proximally by a red band. The area between the body and the red band is blue-green with red dots. 2 2 are brown with colorless, transparent, round fins.

B: As for A. punctatum. Unfortunately, due to the inconsistency of breeding successes, supply does not always keep up with demand. F: C; small- to moderate-sized live foods.

S: RADDA & PURZL, 1985 described A. h. wuendschi as a subspecies of A. hanneloreae. A. hofmanni RADDA, 1980 is one of its relatives.

Soc. B.: Peaceful, small killifish. M: As indicated for A. punctatum. T: 19°-21°C, L:

4cm, A: 60 cm, R: m, b,

Aphyosemion hofmanni Hoffmann’s killie

RADDA,

1980

Syn.: None.

F: C; live foods.

Hab.: Africa: southwest Gabon, in the drainage of the Mbomi River of the Du Chaillu-Massif.

S: This species is a close relative of A. hanneloreae RADDA & PURZL, 1985. More specific information has to wait until further collections can be made

F.I.: In June of 1980, one 3 was imported to Vienna from the type locality GHP. 12/80.

Sex.: dd

have a red-brown

body with

dark red longitudinal striations, even along the ventral area. The fins are yellow-brown and have red lines running

along the fin rays. 22 are gray-brown with transparent and colorless fins. The longitudinal stripes, while also present, are very faint. Soc. B.: Probably peaceful. M: Information is sparse, since only one 3 has been imported alive. It can be supposed that its needs are very similar to those of Aphyosemion punctatum. B: Probably similar to A. punctatum. T: 19°-22°C, L: 4 cm, A: 60 cm, R: m, b, D: 3-4?

474

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

Aphyosemion

hanneloreae,

WC from the type locality, Gabon

Aphyosemion hofmanni, WC from the type locality, Gabon

Par

~

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Aplocheilinae

HUBER & RADDA, 1977

Aphyosemion joergenscheeli Syn.: None. Hab.: Africa: Gabon, Lee

Du Chaillu-Massif.

peated imports. In principle, follow recommendations under A. punctatum. F: C; live foods.

IATA

Sex.: While dd have red and blue designs on their blue-green body, 2° are brown and do not have a colorful design. Soc. B.: Peaceful, solitary lifestyle.

shy species with a

S: A. joergenscheeli has a stouter body than other Aphyosemion species. In ad-

dition, its dorsal and anal fins are almost exactly opposite to each other. It has some rather primitive characteristics which leads us to believe this species is a relict.

M: Care should be similar to that of all other small Aphyosemion species (see A. punctatum). Depending on the origin of the specimens, moderate temperatures and/or perfect water may be important maintenance conditions. Hence, provide good filtration. B: Breeding is apparently difficult, since it has not been successful despite reT: 18°-20°C, L: 5 cm, A: 60 cm, R: m, b,

Aphyosemion lefiniense Lefini killie Syn.:

Aphyosemion

WOELTJES, (not

water (about 10° dGH and pH 6.0-6.5,

Hab.: Africa: southern Congo, in the Lefini Basin north of Brazzaville.

respectively). The illumination should be moderate. Do not forget to cover the tank.

MEINKEN,

cognatum

1984

1951).

F.l.: The exact date is unknown. Probably by P. BRICHARD in the ‘60's.

Sex.: dd are blue to brown with numerous red dots which extend into the fins. The fins have submarginal red bands. A. lefiniense differs from related forms by its yellow-edged fins (occasionally

white-edged). defined round.

29

red-brown

are brown with very dots.

Soc. B.: Shy and peaceful. gage in hierarchical fights.

Their fins are

¢ d may en-

B: Use normal protocol for small Aphyosemion species. They can be bred as either adhesive or substrate spawners. If the eggs are collected, they will need 14-16 days in water to hatch. When using peat, rehydrate after 3 weeks.

F: C; all types of live foods commiserate to its size. S: A. lefiniense belongs to the A. christy group, that is, the A. elegans species group.

M: Requires a rather small tank, preferably one housing conspecifics, small Characins, or other peaceful fishes. Decorate the aquarium as a jungle biotope with plants such as Java moss and Anubias tied to bogwood. Use soft, acid T: 22°-26°C, L: 4.5 cm, A: 50 cm, R: m, b, D: 3

476

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

Aphyosemion

lefiniense

~

~

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Aplocheilinae

(BOULENGER,

Aphyosemion loennbergii Loennberg’s killie Syn.: Fundulus loennbergii, F. pappenheimi, Fundulopanchax loennbergii, Aphyosemion bivittatum (not LONNBERG, 1895), A (Fundulopanchax) uniStrigatus. Hab.: Africa: southwest Cameroon, in the basins of the Nyong, Loikundje, and Kienke

Rivers.

F.I.: Unknown because this species has been repeatedly confused with related species from the subgenus Chromaphyosemion.

Sex.: dd have red dots distributed over their body, a bluish caudal fin, and elongated fins. They are very colorful. 2°, like all Aphyosemion 2°, are a nondescript brown with round fins. Soc. B.: Chiefly peaceful and shy. Displays and occasional confrontations are limited to the ¢ gender.

M: Maintenance is fairly easy as long as they are kept in a dark tank with an T: 22°-26°C,

appropriate substrate and good vegetation. Decorate the tank with bogwood, Java moss, and Java fern. The fish often leap vertically from the water when frightened, so cover the aquarium. Water chemistry is of little importance as long as extreme values are avoided. B: Though it can be bred as a substrate spawner, A. loennbergii prefers to adhere its eggs on plants or artificial substrates. The eggs can be collected or stored in peat and rehydrated after about 3 weeks. This is the most difficult Chromaphyosemion species to breed. F: C; live foods. Flakes may occasionally be accepted.

S: A. bivittatum, A. onym A. multicolor), and A. volcanum as cies all belong to the aphyosemion.

bitaeniatum (synA. splendopleure, well as this spesubgenus Chrom-

L: 7 cm, A: 60 cm, R: m, b,

Aphyosemion mirabile traudeae

RADDA,

Syn.: None. Hab.: West Africa: west Cameroon,

near

Manyemen. F.I.: 1970 by RADDA and co-travelers. Sex.: dd are brown anteriorly, turning blue-green towards the caudal fin. They are covered with red dots that tend to unite on the anterior half of the body, forming longitudinal stripes. The caudal fin has a yellow stripe along the dorsal and ventral edge which is followed proximally by a red stripe. 2 2 are comparatively dull, being brown with transparent

fins Soc. B.: Generally peaceful; ¢3 may occasionally be aggressive among themselves.

1971

an abundance of vegetation. Its colors are enhanced with subdued lighting and a dark substrate. The water should be slightly acid and not too hard. B: As for A. gardneri. Best bred as a substrate spawner. Store the peat for about 3 weeks before adding water. F: C; live foods, larvae.

particularly mosquito

S: Experimental crosses seem to indicate that A. mirabile mirabile is independent, while its subspecies—moense, traudeae, and intermittens—seem to be much more closely related among themselves than to the nominate form.

M: This species is easy to maintain, even in community tanks, as long as there is T: 22°-26°C, L: 5 cm, A: 50 cm, R: m, b, D: 2-3

478

1903)

Killifisnhes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

Aphyosemion

loennbergii, CCMP

85/12, Soca Palm, Cameroon

#

Ta

Aphyosemion

mirabile- traudeae

A

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Aplocheilinae

Fundulopanchax [Callopanchax] monroviae Monrovia killie Syn.: Aphyosemion monroviae, “Roloffia" monroviae. Hab.: Africa: southern Liberia, in swamps and swampy remnants of flowing waters in tropical rain forests between the St. Paul and the Mano Basins.

F.I.: 1971 by ROLOFF. Sex.: dd have avery colorful bright red design. 2 2 are a simple brown without much red. Their fins are smaller and transparent. Soc. B.: Lively. Aggressive among themselves. Do not associate with very small fishes and always keep in large aquaria. M: Arrange the tank’s furnishings such that the animals are not in constant contact with each other. Include ample vegetation. Water should be soft and slightly acid to neutral. Keep either one 36 or

(ROLOFF & LADIGES, 1972)

several 3 ¢ with a group of 2 2 to prevent hostilities from becoming focused. B: Breed as substrate spawners. Place one 6 with 2-3 2° for one week ina moderate-sized tank with a peat bottom

and peat fibers. Check the fish regularly and feed sparingly. Afterwards, remove the peat, press lightly, and allow to dry briefly. The peat should be stored in a plastic bag and kept warm. After 6-8 weeks, add cool fresh water. The young immediately accept Artemia salina nauplii upon hatching. While growth is rapid, it may be irregular. You may want to redry the peat and add water again after 2-3 weeks.

F: C; live foods, even some large items. Frozen foods and beef heart can also be fed.

T: 22°-26°C, L:9 cm, A: 80 cm, R:m, b, D: 3

Biotope where Fundulopanchax

480

[Callopanchax] monroviae

can be found

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

Bey * ee

ae

Fundulopanchax

[Callopanchax] monroviae

“blue’

Fundulopanchax

[Callopanchax] monroviae

“red”

~

~

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Aplocheilinae

SCHEEL,

Aphyosemion ndianum Red-tail killie Syn.: None. Hab.: West Africa: Ndian Basin at Csomba, the border of southeast Nigeria and southwest Cameroon.

F.l.: 1959 by H. S. CLAUSEN to Denmark. However, these imported specimens did not become distributed. In 1975 the species was again imported

by W. WACHTERS to Belgium. Sex.: 6 6, depending on the population, are green to blue and covered with red dots and lines. A red stripe runs along the ventral posterior body into the tail. Even the green to blue-green fins have red dots or stripes (tail fin). The throat is white. 22 are brownish with small redbrown spots on the body and fins. Soc. B.: Although A. ndianum \ooks like a robust species, it is usually very shy

1968

and skittish. It may overcome its timidity to a certain degree if housed with larger Aphyosemion species (A. gardneri, A. sjoesteadti, and related species), though this should only be attempted in large show tanks that are at least 1.20 m long. Avoid hybrids. M: As for A. gardneri. Due to its bashful nature, the species is problematic and not appropriate for beginners.

B: As for A. gardneri. Either breed as an adhesive or a substrate spawner. In the latter case, the peat is stored for about two months and then rehydrated with fresh water. The young immediately accept Artemia nauplii.

F: C; live foods, beef heart and, occasionally, flake foods.

T: 22°-25°C, L: 7 cm, A: 80 cm, R: t, m, b, D: 3-4

(SCHMIDT, 1928)

Aphyosemion oeseri Oeser’s killie Syn.: Panchax oeseri, P. pictus, Aphyosemion

meinkeni,

A. santaisabellae.

Hab.: West Africa: Equatorial Fernando Poo Island.

Guinea,

F.I.: 1928 by R. OESER. Sex.: 2°, like those of most Aphyosemion species, are brownish with transparent, round fins. A. oeseri has longitudinal rows of red-brown dots on the body. In 366, these rows of dots are more pronounced, and the body is yellow-green to bluish. The tail fin has a white to yellow fringe which is followed proximally by a red stripe. The dorsal and anal fins may have the same pat-

ter should not be too hard or alkaline. Part of the aquarium should have a dense plant thicket; a dark substrate and moderate illumination serve to enhance its colors.

B: As for A. gardneri. Best bred as an adhesive spawner, collecting the eggs from the spawning substrate. Breeding the fish as a substrate spawner is also possible. If bred in this manner, rehydrate the peat after four weeks. F: C; live foods. Beef heart and flake foods are occasionally accepted after the fish become acclimated.

tern.

Soc. B.: Amiable as a whole, but

3d

may be aggressive towards conspecific or congener 3d. M: A. oeseri's robust nature allows it to be kept in community aquaria. The waT: 22°-26°C, L: 7 cm, A: 80 cm, R: m, b, D: 3

482

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

Aphyosemion

oeseri

~

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Aplocheilinae

RADDA & PURZL, 1977

Aphyosemion punctatum

Spotted killie Syn.: Aphyosemion striatum ogoense (not PELLEGRIN, 1930), A aff. wildekampi. Hab.: Africa: northeast Gabon to Congo, in rain forest creeks of the lvindo and Ogowe Basins.

F.I.: 1974 by BOCHTLER and co-travelers. Sex.: ¢ A. punctatum have a blue-green body overlaid with red dots and longitudinal stripes. Their yellow fins have a red fringe. The 2 are light brown with greenish yellow, slightly transparent fins. Soc. B.: Peaceful species with a solitary lifestyle. M: Best kept in a species tank. This species can be cared for in a community tank containing small, retiring fishes such as characins. Subdued illumination en-

B: In show tanks where the parents receive good nutrition, young survive. The fish spawn on fine-leaved plants, peat fibers, and similar materials. For more efficient breeding, a pair or one ¢ and two ¢2 should be placed in a small tank (about 10 |). The breeders are either left for an extended continuous setup or removed after a few days. In the former case, collect the eggs regularly and transfer them into a rearing container where they will hatch after about 14-16 days. When peat fibers are used, they can be removed and stored moist in a plastic bag then rehydrated as for substrate spawners. Newly hatched young immediately accept Artemia nauplii. F: C; small live foods of all kinds.

spawning substrate of choice. Water should be soft and acid with a moderate

S: Some authors feel that A. punctatum is at most a subspecies of A. wildekampi, merely extending its northern distribution. A. aureum is another close rela-

temperature.

tive.

hances

its colors.

T: 20°-22°C,

Java

moss

is the

L: 4.5 cm, A: 60 cm, R: m, b, D: 3-4

Aphyosemion raddai Radda’s killie Syn.:

Aphyosemion

SCHEEL, meinkeni

(not

1975

Hab.: Africa: southern Cameroon, in rain forest creeks of the upper Kellé-Nyong system at the western edge of the inland plateau.

M: These animals can be kept in community with smaller, nonaggressive fishes such as characins. Plant the tank well. Intense illumination is not appreciated. Water should be soft and slightly acid. Vary its diet.

F.1.: 1971 by RADDA and co-travelers.

B: Adhesive spawners which either ad-

MYERS,

1933).

Sex.: dd have an intense red design on a blue-green background. The colors tend to vary according to the animal's origin. @@, in contrast, are an inconspicuous brown with round fins. Soc. B.: Predominately peaceful and shy. Hiding places should be furnished, even though they are so appreciated the fish rarely emerge. 3 will occasionally fight among themselves.

here their eggs to plants and other substrates or bury them in a peat substrate. The eggs can be collected (only possible in breeding tanks with few spawning possibilities) or removed with the

spawning substrate each week and incubated separately. This species is somewhat sensitive and not very fecund.,

F: C; live foods of corresponding Limit the amount of worms fed.

T: 22°-26°C, L: 5 cm, A: 50 cm, R: t, m, b, D: 3-4

484

size.

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

Aphyosemion raddai, WC at Pouma, 25 km from Yaounde, Cameroon

~

~

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Aplocheilinae

RADDA,

Aphyosemion scheeli Orange-fringed killie Syn.: Aphyosemion “burundi,” A. akamk-

paense. Hab.: Africa: southeast Nigeria, in rain forest and gallery forest creeks of the lower Cross River system. F.I.: 1968 by SCHEEL, perhaps already in 1964 as the undescribed species A. “purundi.” Sex.: dd are more colorful. They are green to blue-green with red dots that can merge to form horizontal stripes. Unpaired fins are green to blue-green proximally with a red stripe distally and yellow, rarely yellow-orange, fringes. The dorsal fin is generally free of striations. 2 2 are brown with—at the most—a faint rendition of the 33's coloration. Soc. B.: A robust, but generally peaceful species.

1970

all Aohyosemion species, subdued lighting and a dark substrate enhance their colors. A moderate water hardness is not detrimental, although water in its natural biotope is soft. The pH should be around neutral. B: A. scheeli can either be bred as a substrate or an adhesive spawner. Egg development in a rearing container takes about 16-21 days. If tne animals are treated like substrate spawners (see Nothobranchius eggersi), then water can be added to the peat after 3-4 weeks. Newly hatched fry can be fed Artemia salina nauplii. Growth is quite rapid when the young are fed a good diet.

F: C; all types of live foods. After acclimation, frozen foods are accepted. Flake

foods may be eaten.

M: Not particularly sensitive. They can be kept in a community aquarium. Like T: 22°-26°C, L: 5 cm, A: 60 cm, R: m, b,

(BRUNING, 1929)

Aphyosemion splendopleure Splendid killie Syn.: Fundulopanchax splendopleuris, Aphyosemion bivittatum (not LONNBERG, 1895).

Hab.:

West Africa: coastal

regions of

southeastern Nigeria through Cameroon and Equatorial Guinea to northwestern Gabon. F.l.: To Germany during the first half of 1929 by GRIEM from Tiko, Cameroon. Sex.: 22 are simply brownish with— depending on their mood—two dark longitudinal stripes and transparent, round-

ed fins. dd are a colorful iridescent bluegreen with very elongated fins. There are a number of differently colored local populations. Soc. B.: Peaceful towards nonrelated species. Hostilities may break out between conspecific dd and some congeners.

M: As for A. punctatum, though this species is slightly more suitable for community tanks as long as they are not densely stocked and the population consists of small species such as characins. Some specimens—each individual is different—are very shy and remain hidden. Others have a more robust nature and patrol their territory to expel rivals. B: Breed described

as

F: C; live foods. Some animals will accept flakes once in a while.

S: Aphyosemion bitaeniatum, A. bivittatum, A. loennbergii, A. voleanum, and this species belong to the subgenus

Chromaphyosemion

T: 22°-26°C, L: 6 cm, A: 80 cm, R: t, m, b, D: 3

486

as an adhesive spawner under A. bualanum.

RADDA,

1971.

Killifisnhes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

Aphyosemion

Aphyosemion

scheeli

splendopleure

3, WC, Meme

River, Cameroon

~

~

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Aplocheilinae

RADDA & HUBER, 1978

Aphyosemion wachtersi wachtersi Wachter’s killie Syn.: None. Hab.: Africa: southern Congo, surroundings of Zanaga in the upper basin of the Ogowe River.

F.1.: July/August 1978 by BUYTAERT and WACHTERS.

Sex.: dd are more colorful and have larger fins. They are yellow ventrally and even have a yellow stripe on the lower edge of the anal and caudal fins. The dorsal half of the body has red spots which merge into longitudinal bands and transgress into the dorsal and caudal fins. Both of these fins have blue spots and a superior white-blue edge of variable width. 22 are solid brown with round fins. A shadow of the 34’s colors is represented in 2°.

Soc. B.: Generally considered to be a peaceful species. Only do tablish a social hierarchy.

fight to es-

M: As for most small Aphyosemion cies, for example,

mense.

A. bualanum

spekeke-

At the type locality on July 24,

T: 17°-22°C, L: 5 cm, A: 80 cm, R: m, b,

1978, at 8:30 the following values were measured: air temperature 19°C, water temperature 17°C, pH 5.5. Gymnallabes alvarezi was found in the same biotope. Never keep at overly warm temperatures.

B: As for A. bualanum kekemense. However, lower temperatures are important.

WACHTERS (DKG Journal 11 [8/9], 1979) left the juveniles in the breeding tank with the parents until the young were about 8 weeks old. But this is probably only possible when the parents are well fed. WACHTERS mentions that some juveniles have xanthic (yellow) coloration which disappears as the fish age. This has also been observed in other Aphyosemion and Rivulus species and seems to be in response to prevailing water conditions. F: C; all types of live foods. S: A. wachtersi has one described subspecies other than the nominate form: A. wachtersi mikeae. 13-4

Aphyosemion wildekampi Wildekamp’s killie Syn.: Aphyosemion Hab.: Africa: southwestern

BERKENKAMP,

“K 4.”

B: As for A. punctatum.

southeast Cameroon and Central African Republic.

F.1.: Imported into the Netherlands during the summer of 1972 by P. J. VLAMINCK from Diang, 40 km west of Bertoua, Cameroon. Sex.: dd are yellowish brown with 4-6 rows of dots which sometimes coalesce into lines. The dots may form a herringbone design over the posterior body. Unpaired fins are yellow with small red

F: C; medium-sized

Some authors consider the latter synonymous to A. wildekampi. Other references claim A. wildekampi is more

closely tied to A. striatum (BOULENGER, 1911) and A. escherichi

a solid brown body with small red dots and colorless fins.

B.: Peaceful,

small

Aphyosemion

species.

M: As for A. punctatum. T: 20°-24°C, L: 4.5 cm, A: 60 cm, R: m, b, D: 3-4

488

live foods.

S: A. wildekampi is a close relative of A. punctatum RADDA & PURZL, 1977.

dots and lines and a red edge. 2 2 have

Soc.

1973

(AHL, 1924).

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

Aphyosemion

wachtersi wachtersi,

RPC 78/30, Voula ||, Congo

set ‘ Or: i esas iy

Aphyosemion

wildekampi

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Aplocheilinae

Aphyosemion:

zygaima,

WC,

“Mindouli”

HUBER.

Aphyosemion zygaima Mindouli killie Syn.: Aphyosemion PELLEGRIN, 1931).

louessense

(not

Hab.: West Africa: Congo, near the town of Mindouli in the basin of the upper Niari.

F.1.: 1964 by P. BRICHARD and T. ROBERTS. Sex.: dd are more colorful, having red spots on a green body. The fins are likewise green. The spots on the fins, particularly the tail fin, merge into longitudinal stripes. 22 have a similar redbrown spotted design, but on a solid brown body.

nity tank. Even maintaining the animals in a species tank does little to overcome its reclusive nature. If several do are kept in a moderate-sized tank, they will chase each other out of their hiding places.

B: As for A. punctatum. A. zygaima is not very fecund, and the young are slow growing. F: C; live foods,

S: A. zygaima louessense.

M: As for all small Aphyosemion species (see A. punctatum). A. zygaima is rarely seen when housed in a commu-

490

particularly

mosquito

larvae.

Soc. B.: Generally peaceful to the point of extreme shyness. Virtually always hidden.

T: 18°-22°C,

1981

L: 5 cm, A: 60 cm, R: m, b, D: 3-4

is closely related to A.

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Rivulinae

Cynolebias

elongatus

3

STEINDACHNER,

Cynolebias elongatus Blue pearl fish Syn.: Cynolebias holmbergi, C. robustus (in part).

C. spinifer,

Hab.: South America: southern Uruguay and Argentina, pampas region in the lower basin of the Rio de la Plata.

F.I.: 1912 by A. HAASE. Sex.: dd are somewhat larger, bluegray to gray-brown, and have more fin rays. & 2 have dark brown spots and a fuller ventral area.

Soc. B.: Generally peaceful, but due to their size, they should not be housed with small fishes. Spent 9° are often unduly molested; therefore, provide hiding places. M: This species is often kept in overly warm

water.

In nature,

water

tempera-

1881

B: Substrate spawner. Breeding can only be accomplished in a separate tank containing a deep layer of peat. The animals dive into the peat to spawn. After one week, decant the water and store the peat in a plastic bag for 3-4 months. Then add cool water, as is normally done for substrate spawners. See Pterolebias staecki for details. Raise the fry on Artemia nauplii. Larger foods can quickly be added to the diet. Growth is rapid. F: C; all types of large live foods. S: There are two species which have been imported under the name C. e/on-

gatus. The species bred by FOERSCH (Aquarienmagazin 12 (2): 86-93, 1978) is probably not C. e/ongatus, but C. robustus.

tures range from a few degrees (southern winter) to above 30°C (southern summer). A large: aquarium is necessary. T: 16°-25°C,

L: to 14 cm, A: 100 cm, R: m, b, D: 3

491

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Aplocheilinae MEINKEN,

Aplocheilus werneri Werner's panchax Syn.: Aplocheilus day/ werneri. Hab.: Asia: relictlike presence in the Kottawa Forest of southern Sri Lanka

(Ceylon). F.1.: 1964 by WERNER Co, Munich. Sex.: d6¢ are usually larger and have elongated dorsal, anal, and caudal fins. They are generally more colorful, prima-

rily having more red. 2 are shorter and stouter with rounder and more transparent unpaired fins. The degree of color in the longitudinal band that extends from the base of the pectoral fins to the caudal peduncle depends on their mood.

Soc. B.: Peaceful. Small fishes may be considered prey. When several 66 are kept in one aquarium, they display until a social hierarchy is established. 122°=26°C

M: Can be placed in almost any standard aquarium. Under these conditions, itis easily cared for. It appreciates plants that reach the water surface and those that float. The water should be soft and neutral to slightly acid. However, water chemistry is not important for captivebred specimens. Cover the aquarium. B: Continuous adhesive spawner. Well-

conditioned

22 daily lay eggs among

plants. For directed reproduction, It is best to use one 6 and two 29 ina moderate-sized spawning tank. Regularly collect the eggs from the spawning substrate. They hatch in the brooding container after about two weeks. F: C; live and flake foods.

yl Sicme Ay SOlcma Ret Dae

Aplocheilus werneri 3, Kottawa Forest, Sri Lanka

492

1966

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

2, WC, Kottawa Forest, Sri Lanka

Aplocheilus werneri, WC, Kottawa Forest, Sri Lanka

mes

~

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Rivulinae Cynolebias elongatus. See p. 491. Cynolebias nonoiuliensis Giant pearl fish

TABERNER,

Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: Argentina, 15 km north of the town of 9 de Julio, province of Buenos Aires.

F.I.: 1980 by Dr. K. H. LULING. Sex.: ¢d are larger with more pronounced fins. Like most 3 Cynolebias, the dorsal and anal fins have more fin rays. They are reddish brown, turning lighter ventrally, with bluish fins. ° 2 are light brown with dark brown mottling. Soc. B.: Peaceful, but its size allows it to tackle relatively large fishes, which excludes small fishes from being suitable tankmates. M: As is customary with Cynolebias_ species. House in a species tank. A peat substrate is recommended. Java moss, Anubias, or Java fern growing on bog-

wood

SANTOS can

& CASTELLI,

be distributed

1975

around

the

edges. Conditions in its natural habitat were as follows (LULING, Das Aquarium, 14 [134]: 394-396): ambient temperature 26°C, water temperature 18°C at the surface, 14°C at '/2 m depth, pH 6.8, and a total hardness of 1.7° dGH. Maintain these fish at cool temperatures.

B: Substrate diver. A large container of peat placed into the maintenance tank will quickly be accepted as a spawning substrate. After one week, the peat is treated as described for Ptero/ebias staecki and P. wischmanni, that is, pressed, briefly dried, and stored in a plastic bag for 4-5 months. The fry immediately eat Artemia nauplii upon hatching and grow very quickly. F: C; large live foods.

T: 15°-25°C, L: 10 cm, A: 80 cm, R: m, b, D: 3-4

(REGAN, 1912)

Cynopoecilus melanotaenia Black-banded pearl fish Syn.: Cynolebias melanotaenia. Hab.: South America: southeastern Brazil and northern Uruguay, usually in shallow, stationary waters. Often found with Cynolebias adloffi and C. wolterstorffi. F.l.: 1912 by A. MAYER from the area around Paranagua, southeast Brazil.

Sex.: dd

are more colorful and larger

with elongated dorsal and anal fins. The throat is white, and the body is redbrown with a dark brown.band running from the mouth through the eye to the tail. A second band lays over the stomach. Both are framed by light greengold scales. The red-brown unpaired fins frequently have a dark edge. ° 2 area light brown with less pronounced lateral stripes. Fins are more rounded.

Soc. B.: These animals are relatively aggressive among themselves; thus sufficient refuges should be offered. Peaceful towards characins, catfishes, etc. M: As for Rachovia hummelincki. A thin layer of peat or peat fibers makes an T: 18°-24°C,

494

adequate substrate. Use peat fibers, roots, and plants (i.e., Java moss and Java fern) to provide secluded areas. Soft to medium-hard and slightly acid to neutral water with moderate tures is recommended.

tempera-

B: Best when bred as a substrate spawner. See R. hummelincki. The animals rarely dive into the substrate. Instead, they normally spawn on top of the substrate, or even in the open water or on plants. Treat the substrate as you would for any substrate spawner. Rehydration can be attempted after 2-3 months, depending at what temperature

the substrate was stored. The large fry immediately accept

Artemia

nauplii.

F: C; hardy live foods.

S: C. aureoguttatus CRUZ, 1974 is probably its closest relative. The newly described Campellolebias species from southeastern Brazil is presumably related to this species as well.

L: 5.5 cm, A: 60 cm, R: t, m, b, D: 3-4

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

i

Cynolebias nonoiuliensis

*

-

3, WC, 9 de Julio, Argentina

cee

UT¥ +

Cynopoecilus

melanotaenia

~

~

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Aplocheilinae

(RADDA, 1975)

Aphyosemion [Diapteron| fulgens Syn.: Aphyosemion Diapteron fulgens.

georgiae

fulgens,

Hab.: Africa: northeastern Gabon, in the lvindo Basin.

F.I.: 1972 by HERZOG and BOCHTLER. Sex.: d¢ are blue, turning red-brown posteriorly. The fins are very colorful. The caudal and anal fins have a broad orange stripe along the edge which is followed proximally by a narrow bluewhite stripe. The dorsal fin is orange to red-brown with a reticulated light blue to light orange design and a narrow light blue to whitish fringe. 2 2 are small and brown with almost colorless fins. Soc. B.: This tiny species is peaceful towards heterospecific fishes. ¢¢ are frequently involved in intense hierarchical fights. M: Can be kept with small fishes such as characins. The aquarium should have T2118°=22°GC, 2 3.5iemyAz60icm)

a dark substrate and plenty of vegetation, e.g., Anubijas barteri nana, Java fern, Java moss, and Bolbitis, to enhance the animal's colors. The plants can be fastened to bogwood. Water should be slightly acid to neutral, medium-hard, and temperate. B: Breed in a small aquarium that has plenty of Java moss or peat fibers. The eggs can be collected and allowed to develop in a separate receptacle, though finding them is problematic. It is best to leave the eggs in the tank and remove the fry after 2-3 week. More fry result when the parents are removed at that time as well. The young should be fed infusoria and Artemia nauplii. Rearing the offspring in the breeding tank has the added advantage that the young can find additional microfoods among the plants during the first days. F: C; small live foods.

Rat, mic, D:4

Aphyosemion [Diapteron] georgiae Syn.: Aohyosemion georgiae, Diapteron georgiae. Hab.: West Africa: central Gabon, basins of the lvindo and the central Ogowe between Booué and Mékambo.

F.I.: 1972 by HERZOG and BOCHTLER. Sex.: 63 are red-brown with blue dots. These dots are distributed differently in

(LAMBERT & GERY, 1967) B: As for A. fulgens. This species will also spawn in peat fibers. The peat can then be left “dry” for about 3-4 weeks. After this time lapse, add water. F: C; the diminutive size of the animals limits its menu to those live foods small enough for the fish to consume.

distinct populations. The lower tail fin as well as the dorsal, anal, and ventral fins are dark orange. Blue dots cover the dorsal fin and, to a lesser degree, the red-brown upper lobe of the tail fin. 2 2 are smaller and totally light brown with translucent, round fins.

Soc. B.: As for A. fulgens. M: See A. fulgens. T: 18°-22°C, L:3.5 cm, A: 60 cm, R:t, m, b, D: 4

496

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

ee |are

ce

roe Bieri

aS a AMAAra

Aphyosemion fulgens

Aphyosemion georgiae

~

~

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Aplocheilinae

BERKENKAMP

Epiplatys coccinatus Syn.: None. Hab.: Africa: Wadalna, central Liberia.

F.I.: December of 1978 by Dr. V. ETZEL. Sex.: dd have blue to blue-green sides and a bronze dorsum. Depending on its mood, 8-11 oblique dark crossbands are visible. The fins have a light blue edge followed proximally by a red-brown

then a blue-green simple red-brown ent fins.

stripe.

22

timal water and even bred therein as long as the water chemistry values are not extreme. The aquarium should contain opportunities for concealment in the form of dense plant stands, etc.

area

with round, transpar-

Soc. B.: Like E. f. fasciolatus; however, E. coccinatus is generally shyer and more retiring. M: See

E. f. fasciolatus.

& ETZEL, 1982

B: As for E. f. fasciolatus. F: C; all types of live foods, including aquatic insects. S: This species belongs to the E. fasciolatus group. Based on coloration and meristic values, E. coccinatus could be a subspecies (?) of E. ruhkopfi.

The collection

site was a forest creek with brown, soft,

slightly acid (pH 6.2) water. Captive-bred specimens can be maintained in subopT: 22°-26°C, L: 7 cm, A: 80 cm, R: t, m, D: 2-3

Epiplatys esekanus Eseka panchax Syn.: None. Hab.: West Africa: Cameroon, in a small creek in the basin of the lower Sanaga and Nyong Rivers near the EdeaYaounde-Eseka crossroad.

F.I.: 1966 (?) by SCHEEL to Denmark. Sex.: ¢ 3 are more colorful. They have a number of red-brown to black-brown dots arranged in longitudinal rows on their gray-green body. The semielongated fins are blue (dorsal, upper caudal) or yellow-brown (anal, lower caudal). 22 are smaller and browner with less intense dots and smaller, less colorful fins. Soc. B.: Generally a peaceful, rather shy species.

M: Due to their somewhat delicate nature, E. esekanus is best kept in a species tank with soft, slightly acid water. Floating plants will serve to dim the illuT: 22°-26°C,

498

L: 7 cm, A: 60 cm, R: t, m, D: 4

SCHEEL,

1968

mination, which in turn tends to enhance the $6’s colors.

B: Breeding is difficult and not prolific. Best bred as an adhesive spawner. Fol-

low suggestions for E. sexfasciatus rathkei, however,

the fry of

E. esekanus

grow slower.

F: C; all types of live foods commiserate to its size, particularly flying insects (Drosophila, wax moths).

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

Epiplatys coccinatus,

Epiplatys esekanus

WC,

RL 46, Wadalna,

Liberia

~

~

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Aplocheilinae

BERKENKAMP

Epiplatys fasciolatus puetzi Syn.: None. Hab.: Africa: Buchanan.

Liberia,

20

km

north

of

F.I.: 1982 by Dr. V. ETZEL and W. PUTZ. Sex.: do are larger and have elongated fins. They are shiny blue to violet with a copper brown dorsum. The caudal, anal, and ventral fins have yellow to orange fringes. 22 are smaller with a brownish body and colorless fins. Soc. B.: See E. f. fasciolatus.

M: As described for &. f. fasciolatus. According to the first describers, the animals were fished from a 80 cm wide, 20-50 cm deep, clear water creek that had the following characteristics on November 11, 1982 at 16:30: ambient temperature 27°C, pH 5.8, conductivity 0.68 uS. The water was acid and poor in

& ETZEL, 1985

ions. E. f£ puetzi will tolerate values outside those of its natural habitat as long as extremes are avoided. B: As for E. f. fasciolatus.

F: C; all kinds of live foods, even larger ones. See E. f. fasciolatus. S: Although &. f. puetzi definitely belongs within the E. fasciolatus group, it should be more closely related to E. olbrechtsi (= E. fasciolatus olbrechtsi?), mediating between olbrechtsi and fasciolatus.

T: 22°-28°C, L: 8 cm, A: 80 cm, R: t, m, D: 2-3

Epiplatys fasciolatus tototaensis Totota panchax

ROMAND,

Syn.: Epiplatys fasciolatus huwaldi. Hab.: Africa: southwest Monrovia and Totota. F.I.: 1964 by BRASCH

Liberia,

B: As for E. f. fasciolatus. near

F: C: live foods.

and a co-worker:

perhaps imported earlier under a different name. Sex.: dd are blue with a brown dorsum. The posterior body has oblique stripes which may darken or virtually disappear, depending on their mood. The anal and tail fins are blue distally with a red-brown to black edge. 2 2 are smaller with round fins and inconspicuous colors. Soc. B.: See E. f. fasciolatus.

M: This subspecies is robust and easy to,maintain, Instructions concerning care can be found under E. f. fasciolatus. E. f, tototaensis undergoes pronounced mood-related color changes. Oblique stripes and sometimes a dark longitudinal band appear when the fish becomes frightened. T: 22°-28°C, L: 8 cm, A: 80 cm, R: t, m, D: 2-3

500

1978

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

*,

Epiplatys

fasciolatus_tototaensis

~

~

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Aplocheilinae BOULENGER,

Epiplatys nigricans Black panchax Syn.: None.

Hab.: The type specimens of E. nigricans hail from Dungu along the upper Uele River in northeast Zaire. If the specimens which nowadays are considered E. nigricans are indeed this species, then E. nigricans is broadly distributed throughout the entire Congo Basin to Kasai. F.I.: Probably CHARD.

in the '50’s by P. BRI-

Sex.: The dd’s fins are larger, more elongated, and yellowish, frequently with a black edge. The body is yellowishbrown and often has a reticulated redbrown design. When excited, a black band appears along its side from the snout to the caudal peduncle, but it almost totally disappears as the fish calms.

to medium-hard and neutral to slightly acid water are required. Moderate-sized fishes can be housed in the same tank. B: Use a separate breeding tank and follow suggestions made under Aphyosemion punctatum. The eggs can be stored in a plastic bag for about 2-3 weeks in peat fibers then rehydrated. However, the more common method is to collect the eggs from the spawning substrate (wool mop, spawning fibers, peat fibers) or to transfer all of the spawning substrate into a separate tank after one week. When the fry hatch, feed them Artemia during the first days, graduating slowly to larger live foods.

22 have a fuller anterior body, a more slender caudal peduncle, and more transparent, rounded fins. It is not always easy to distinguish genders.

Soc. B.: Peaceful. Conspecific display among themselves.

¢d

1913

may

M: Heavy vegetation, including a section of natant or floating plants, and soft

F: C; live foods. ideal.

Mosquito

larvae are

S: It is very questionable whether this species is indeed E. nigricans. Numerous authors consider this taxon a synonym of E. chevalieri, while others consider it a subspecies. All these hypotheses remain conjecture until more live specimens from E. nigricans's type |ocality are imported.

T: 20°-26°C, L: 5.5 cm, A: 60 cm, R: t, m, D: 3

Epiplatys njalaensis Red-spotted panchax Syn.: None.

Hab.: Africa: in flowing waters of the rain forests of southwest Sierra Leone to neighboring Guinea. F.I.: 1975 by E. ROLOFF from Niala, Sierra Leone.

Sex.: dd are larger and have a pale blue to brownish body with a few rows of red dots along their sides that extend

into the caudal peduncle. The caudal fin is yellow superiorly and blue inferiorly with a red line running along both the superior and inferior edges. The dorsal fin, the central section of the caudal fin, and frequently the anal fin have red lines running along the fin rays. The dorsal fin T: 22°-28°C, L: 6 cm, A: 80 cm, R: t, m, D: 3

502

NEUMANN,

1976

is yellow, whereas the anal fin is light blue to yellowish. The 2 2 have a brownyellow body and transparent fins. The posterior body has 10-12 slanted bands that vary in intensity depending on mood.

Soc. B.: See E. fasciolatus, though this species is considered more peaceful and shy. M: As for E. fasciolatus.

B: As for E. fasciolatus. F: C; live foods, including larger ones.

S: A member of the E. fasciolatus group. This species has a broader distribution than presently thought, as BLEHER found this species in Guinea as well.

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

=?

Epiplatys nigricans

Epiplatys njalaensis

Siaesoe ae

sa

.

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Aplocheilinae

BERKENKAMP,

Epiplatys sexfasciatus baroi Red six-barred panchax Syn.: None.

B: See E. s. rathkei.

Hab.: Africa: southwestern Cameroon, the area around Kumba and the Kiende Basin.

F: C; as for E. s. rathkei.

1975

Flees 1970; Sex.: As the picture shows, 66 are an intense red-brown, becoming metallic green to blue anteriorly. The scales have a red center which form longitudinal rows of red dots along its sides. There are 5— 7 vertical dark stripes on the posterior body. All fins are orange-red except the clear pectoral fins. 2 2 have less intense colors, and their fins are round. Soc. B.: See E£. s. rathkei, though subspecies is more bashful.

this

M: As for E. s. rathkei.

T: 22°-26°C,

L: 7 cm, A: 80 cm, R: t, m, D: 2-3

Epiplatys sexfasciatus rathkei Rathke’s six-barred panchax Syn.: Panchax sexfasciatus, Aplocheilus sexfasciatus, Haplochilus infrafasciatus. Hab.: Africa: west Cameroon, in the drainage basins of the Mungo, Sanaga, and Nyong Rivers. F.1.: Unknown.

Sex.: dd are larger and more intensely colored with 6-9 slightly oblique crossbands on their yellowish brown body. The elongated fins are red-brown distally, yellow proximally. The 2° are browner, smaller, and have round, almost colorless fins. They also have crossbands. Soc. B.: Usually peaceful, but larger specimens have been known to turn predacious towards small fishes. Hence, small species make inappropriate tankmates.

M: Not difficult. Suitable for community aquaria. Although the water values should be soft and slightly acid, E. sexfasciatus tolerates medium-hard, slightly

RADDA,

alkaline water as well. Vegetation is advantageous. The fish like to hover beneath leaves of floating plants such as water sprite (Cerotopteris). B: Adhesive spawners. Place one ¢ and

several 22 into a moderate-sized tank containing a spawning mop of artificial or peat fibers, Java moss, or similar. Methodically collect the eggs and transfer them into a separate container, perhaps one containing acriflavine as a fungal prophylactic. Depending on temperature, the eggs will need between 14 and 16 days to hatch. Juveniles immediately accept Artemia salina. With a good diet and regular water exchanges, the fry grow rapidly.

F: C; live foods, including small water beetles, etc. After acclimation, foods are also accepted.

flake

S: E. sexfasciatus rathkei is one of four

subspecies.

The others are the nomi-

nate form E. s. sexfasciatus

(see Vol. 1,

p. 562), E. s. togolensis, and E. s. baroi.

T: 22°-26°C, L: 8 cm, A: 80 cm, R: t, m, D: 2-3

504

1970

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

Epiplatys

sexfasciatus

Epiplatys sexfasciatus

baroi

rathkei, WC,

Kumba,

Cameroon

Pe.

~

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Aplocheilinae

SEEGERS,

Nothobranchius eggersi Eggers’ notho Syn.: Nothobranchius sp. “Ruhoi.” Hab.: Africa: east Tanzania, in the lower Rufiji Basin. F.I.: January 1981 by EGGERS, KASSELMANN, and SEEGERS. Sex.: dd are large, colorful fish with gorgeous fins. 2° are light brown with gray overtones

and

brownish

with the blue form or its descendants. The “red head” morph is probably totally diluted by crosses.

transpar-

ent fins. Soc. B.: Peaceful towards heterospecific fishes. dd are aggressive among themselves, particularly in small aquaria. Congener 3¢ will also fight. Individual ¢ ° will be chased to death as soon as they are spent.

M: Their colors are brightest when kept in a species tank with a dark substrate (peat). Never keep 2 do together. It is always best to keep either one 3 ora group of dd. Without exception, keep several 22. The fish are not very demanding in regard to water values, but neutral to slightly acid, soft water is the most favorable. A good diet of live foods is important.

B: Substrate spawner. Place one

¢ and

2-3 2 into a 20 | spawning tank that has a layer of peat or peat fibers and feed sparingly. After one week, the animals and the water are removed and the peat lightly pressed, slightly dried, then stored in a plastic bag for 6 weeks at moderate temperatures. Afterwards, water is added to the peat in a small aquarium. The fry immediately accept Artemia nauplii. If the eggs do not hatch, redry the peat and add water again after 14 days. The process may need to be repeated several times. F: C; all types of live foods; beef heart is less appreciated than worms. S: Three color morphs have been found: N. eggersi “blue,” which the type belongs to (see photo); N. eggersi “red head,” and N. eggersi “red.” Only one 3 of the latter has been imported (see photo on p. 509). All animals offered as “red” are a cross of the pictured animal T: 24°-28°C, L: 5 cm, A: 60 cm, R: b, m, D: 3

506

1982

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Aplocheilinae

Nothobranchius

eggersi “blue”

|

Nothobranchius eggersi, “red” x “blue” hybrid

508

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

Nothobranchius eggersi, WC, red morph, Selous Game

Reserve, Tanzania

509

.

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Aplocheilinae

WILDEKAMP,

Nothobranchius elongatus Slender notho Syn.: Nothobranchius guentheri (not PFEFFER, 1893), N. palmgvisti “elongate,” N. sp. “Munyenze,” N. sp. “Kaloleni,” N. sp. “Mariakani,” N. sp. “Uganda,” N. spe Uae: Hab.: Africa: southeast Kenya, in seasonal pools and flood plains about 2030 km northwest of Mombasa around the towns of Kaloleni and Mariakani.

F.I.: 1962 by J. H. E. LEAKY to the United States; from there it was exported Great Britain and Germany.

to

Sex.: dd are blue-green with a bright red caudal peduncle and tail fin. All their fins are larger. 2 2 are smaller and graybrown with almost colorless fins. Soc. B.: Peaceful. Comparable to N. eggersi. M: See N. eggersi. B: As for N. eggersi. F: C; live foods of all kinds, particularly worms and mosquito larva. Beef heart is accepted after the fish are acclimated.

T: 24°-28°C, L: 6 cm, A: 60 cm, R: m, b, D: 3 =

=

Rt

NNN

A small water remnant in the jungle; habitat of Roloffia liberiensis.

510

1982

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

ba

~

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Aplocheilinae

Nothobranchius foerschi Foersch’s notho Syn.: Nothobranchius palmquisti (not LONNBERG, 1907), N. sp. “Dar es Salaam,” N. “Vivoplani.”

Hab.: Africa: coastal lowlands of eastern Tanzania, probably the drainages of the Rufiji and Ruvu Rivers. Its precise distribution is unknown.

F.I.: 1956 by Tropicarium Co., Frankfurt. Sex.: dd are more colorful, having a carmine caudal fin and reddish dorsal and anal fins. 2 2 are smaller and brown. Their fins are brownish and transparent. Soc. B.: Peaceful towards heterospecifics. Conspecific dd may engage in fights. Immature or spent 22 may be treated rough. It is best to transport these fish singly. M: Of all the Nothobranchius, this is one of the most undemanding. The animals frequently wane when housed with lively

WILDEKAMP

& BERKENKAMP,

1979

tankmates. An ideal fish either for a species tank or tranquil community tanks that have a dark substrate (peat), bogwood, Java moss, and Java fern. The water should be soft with a pH of 6.5 to 7.5. Copious quantities of live foods are important. B: N. foerschi is an annual fish and a substrate spawner. Breeding is similar to that of N. eggersi. Like said species, N. foerschi is usually kept at temperatures that are too low. Higher tempera-

tures (up to 30°C) stimulate the spawn to hatch sooner. F: C; live foods of all kinds. Although the animals relish worms, these foodstuffs should be fed in a controlled manner

lest diseases and fatty degeneration result.

T: 22°-26°C, L: 5 cm, A: 60 cm, R: m, b, D:3

Nothobranchius interruptus Kikambala notho Syn.: Nothobranchius “U 6,” N. jubbi interruptus.

Hab.: East Africa: southeast Kenya, coastal regions around the Mwatsuma River, particularly the surroundings of Kikambala.

F.I.: August 1978 by E. HOLLER.

WILDEKAMP

1979

B: As for N. eggersi. F: C; all types of live foods, especially

worms.

S: N. interruptus is closely related to N. melanospilus and continues its distribution roughly towards the north.

Sex.: dd have a gray-blue body with a reticulate design formed by the redbrown edges of their scales. The caudal fin is blunt and dark red with a dark to transparent edge. The anal fin is yellow-

ish green; the dorsal fin is bronze with brown spots. 22 are smaller and solid gray-brown with round, transparent fins. Soc. B.: Peaceful towards heterospecifics. dd are aggressive among themselves. Occasionally, aggressions may be directed towards immature 29 as well.

M: See N. eggersi. T: 22°-26°C, L: 6.5 cm, A: 60 cm, R: m, b, D: 3

512

& BERKENKAMP,

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

Nothobranchius

Nothobranchius

foerschi

interruptus,

WC,

Kikambala,

Kenya

~

~

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Aplocheilinae

Nothobranchius kafuensis. See p. 522.

WILDEKAMP,

Nothobranchius lourensi Green notho Syn.: None.

1977

Soc. B.: Peaceful. ¢ d occasionally fight

Hab.: Africa: Tanzania, in the Ruvu Basin. So far only known from the type locality, a puddle along the MorogoroDar es Salaam road between the Ruvu Bridge and Kwaraza.

to establish hierarchy. A shy species when compared to other members of the genus.

F.1.: 1976 by WILDEKAMP ions.

B: As for N. eggers/. Usually not as fecund.

and compan-

Sex.: 2 2 are gray-brown, and their fins are mostly transparent. Larger ¢d have a gray-blue to greenish body. The scales are distinctly edged in red-brown, creating a reticulate pattern. Unpaired fins have red-brown stripes running parallel to the fin’s edges which frequently disintegrate into dots.

M: As for N. eggersi. However, lourensi is more sensitive.

F: C; moderate-sized

N.

live foods.

S: N. lourensi is similar in color and pattern to N. korthausae, a species from the island of Mafia in Tanzania. N. korthausae is probably N. /ourensi's closest relative.

T: 24°-28°C, L: 5 cm, A: 60 cm, R: m, b, D: 3

SEEGERS,

Nothobranchius luekei Luke’s notho Syn.: None. Hab.: Africa: Tanzania, east Atlantic coastal lowlands, Mbezi Basin, ca. 40 km south of Dar es Salaam.

F.l.: January

1983

by SEEGERS

and

WISCHMANN. Sex.: The ¢d’s unpaired fins have a red fringe. The body is blue-gray. 22 are uniformly brown with transparent fins.

Soc. B.: Peaceful, shy species. M: As for N. eggersi, though the diminutive size of the fish has to be taken into account. A species tank is recommended. This species was found with Nothobranchius melanospilus, N. rubripinnis, Ctenopoma muriei, Clarias gariepinus, and various barbs and characins, though they were all juveniles. The water temperature

was

around

30°C

soria and microfoods until they can handle Artemia. Growth is relatively slow. Judging from prevailing temperatures found in their natural habitat, this species is normally maintained and bred at suboptimal temperatures.

F: C; all types of small live foods. Artemia nauplii are suitable for full-grown specimens. S: N. luekei is the smallest known Nothobranchius species. It and N. janpapi belong to the subgenus Aphyobranchius.

at

18:00. The pH was 7.3.

B: As for N. eggersi. Fry are very small when they hatch and must be fed infuT: 24°-30°C, L: 4 cm, A: 60 cm, R: t, m, b, D: 4

514

1984

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

Nothobranchius

/ourensi

Nothobranchius luekei, WC, Mbezi River type, Tanzania

~

~

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Aplocheilinae

(PFEFFER,

Nothobranchius melanospilus Beira notho Syn.: Fundulus melanospilus, F. orthonotus (not PETERS, 1844), Nothobranchius guentheri (not PFEFFER, 1893), N. emini, N. eimincki, N. seychellensis. Hab.: Africa: southeast Kenya and east Tanzania, coastal lowlands from the basin of the Umba River (Kenya) to the Lukuledi (Tanzania). This is the most common Nothobranchius species within its distribution area. Inhabits seasonal puddles and flood areas. F.|.: Unknown.

Sex.: dd are colorful. The red edges on their blue scales form a reticulate pattern. The caudal fin is carmine red; the dorsal and anal fins have red spots. 2 2 are brown with black spots and transparent fins.

1896)

Soc. B.: Generally peaceful towards heterospecifics. dd are aggressive towards each other. Occasionally, dd may direct their hostilities towards °° as well. Pack singly when anticipating a lengthy transport. M: As for N. eggersi. However, because of its larger stature, this species needs a bigger tank. B: Substrate spawner. As for N. eggersi. F: C; live foods, particularly worms. Beef heart is accepted once the fish are acclimated.

T; 22°-28°C, L: 7 cm, A: 80 cm, R: m, b, D: 2-3

HILGENDORF,

Nothobranchius neumanni Neumann’s notho Syn.: Fundulus neumanni. Hab.: Africa: central Tanzania, basins of the Bubu River and Lakes Manyara and Ruaka.

F.1.: January of 1982 by CLASSEN and SEEGERS from Chipogola, Tanzania. Sex.: 22 are a drab gray-brown with fins that are virtually always transparent. 36, in contrast, normally have a bright red caudal fin and a blue-gray body. The anal fin has red-brown, yellow, white, and black stripes, depending on the population. These stripes are frequently incomplete.

Soc. B.: Normally peaceful towards erospecifics. dd are frequently gressive towards conspecific 36d immature or spent 2 2. Aggressions more

pronounced

hetagand are

in wild caught speci-

mens than in captive-bred specimens. M: As for N. eggers/. However, while N. neumanni is generally considered more robust, it is more delicate in many regards. For example, rapid environmen-

tal changes and food shortages are to its detriment, as it quickly becomes emaciated and wanes. Likewise, a negative response is quickly displayed when the water quality or temperature become suboptimal. It seems that these animals have a shorter life span than species from coastal lowlands.

B: Principally like N. eggersi. If possible, place several 22 in the breeding tank. A group set-up consisting of several 3 3 and a number of 2 2 in a large aquarium sans decoration other than a dish of peat for oviposition has proven effective. Feed the breeders well. Frequent water exchanges are required. N. neumanni fry must be “swimming in food” after they hatch. Lack of food causes growth defects which are hard to compensate for. F: C; all types of hardy live foods, cluding worms.

in-

S: Its closest relative, whose distribution partially overlaps that of N. neumanni, is N. taeniopygus.

T: 24°-28°C, L:6 cm, A: 80 cm, R: m, b, D: 3

516

1905

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

Nothobranchius

melanospilus,

Nothobranchius

neumanni,

Singida,

WC,

WC,

Mtanza,

Bahi

Tanzania

Swamps,

ca.

70 km

from

Dodoma

towards

Tanzania

517

~

.

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Aplocheilinae

WILDEKAMP,

Nothobranchius polli Poll’s notho

1978

Syn.: Nothobranchius brieni (not POLL, 1938), N. taeniopygus (not HILGENDORF, 1981).

sign, while the proximal half has a blue

Hab.: Africa: southeast Zaire and perhaps Zambia, in seasonal puddles, swamps, and ditches in the upper Lufira Basin in the province of Shaba.

Soc.

F.I.: 1960 by E. GRAINDORGE Netherlands.

to the

design.

¢@

are light brown with trans-

parent fins. B.: Aggressive

towards

congener

33 and immature or spent 2 2. Otherwise, this is considered a peaceful species. M: As for N. eggersi. B: As for N. eggersi.

Sex.: Like all Nothobranchius species, 36 are very colorful. The photo, due to its age, is too red and does not show the true colors of the species (see DATZ, 15 (8): 225, 1962). In reality the dds body is reddish to dark brown. Every scale along the fish’s side has a bright blue center. Though the upper edge of the dorsal fin and the stripe on the tail fin appear white in the photo, they are really light blue. The distal half of the anal fin is orange with a red-brown de-

F: C; hardy live foods. S: N. polli is one of a group of similar species that comes from southern central Africa, inhabiting southern Zaire, Zambia, eastern Namibia, and northern Zimbabwe. Of this group, Nothobranchius sp. “Kayuni State Farm,” WN. sp. “Chunga,” and “Nega Nega” from Zambia have entered the hobby and have been recently described as N. kafuensis (see pp. 522-623).

T: 22°-28°C, L: 5 cm, A: 60 cm, R: m, b, D:3

Nothobranchius robustus Robust notho Syn.: Nothobranchius sp. “K 86/13, Sio River.”

AHL, 1935 selves. N. robustus frequently the bottom.

hide in

Hab.: Africa: Tanzania, Kenya, and Uganda, in the Lake Victoria Basin. Found in swamps and dead river arms.

M: As for N. eggersi.

F.I.: To Switzerland in 1985 by DE RHAM from the area around Ahero, Kenya, though they probably died out. Imported

F: C; like all Nothobranchius species, it prefers live foods. Flake foods are only exceptionally accepted.

into Germany in 1986 by EGGERS

and

SEEGERS from the Sio River, Kenya. |mported to the Netherlands and Great Britain from Uganda in 1988 by WILDEKAMP. and companions. Sex.: Only dd have large, bright red unpaired fins and ventral fins that are blue anteriorly. 22 are a solid brownish-gray, and their fins are more rounded.

B: Substrate for details.

See

N. eggersi

S: The type specimens of N. robustus were collected south of Lake Victoria in northern Tanzania. Nevertheless, no live specimens matching the pictured fish have been collected from that local, so its identity is not entirely definite. But the description by AHL (somewhat skimpy) fits the presented fish.

Soc. B.: See N. eggersi. Although this species is generally considered shyer than its congeners, it is possible that its dd are more aggressive among themT: 24°-28°C, L: 5.5 cm, A: 60 cm, R: b, m, D: 3

518

spawner.

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

Nothobranchius robustus,

WC, K 86/13 Sio River, Kenya

Dili

~

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Aplocheilinae

Nothobranchius rubripinnis Red-finned notho Syn.: Nothobranchius sp. “TZ 83/5," N. SO KIA 85/20. Hab.: Africa: Tanzania, along coastal lowlands, Mbezi (TZ 83/5) and Mbemkuru Basins (KTZ 85/28).

F.l.: January

1983

by SEEGERS

and

SEEGERS,

S: Now that the southern form from Mbemkuru has been kept in captivity for several generations and there is more information, it is questionable whether it and the Mbezi population are indeed the same species. Corresponding research has not been concluded.

WISCHMANN.

Sex.: ¢¢ are colorful fish with red fins. Only the dorsal fin is yellowish to bronze with red-brown dots and stripes. The snout and throat are red, while the flanks are blue-green. 2°92 are smaller and brownish with transparent, round fins. Soc. B.: Peaceful. dd, especially those of the small southern form from Mbemkuru, become very aggressive among themselves when kept in a limited space. Their shy nature and tendency to zigzag through the aquarium as they search out new hiding places among the substrate is quite deviant from the norm. M: Generally, suggestions given for N. eggersi hold true. Animals from Mbemkuru, however, should be kept in a species tank with a peat bottom. In nature, both forms live together with N. melano-

spilus, though this should not be carried over to the aquarium lest the smaller N. rubripinnis proves inferior.

B: As for N. eggersi. The offspring of the Mbemkuru form (KTZ 85/28) are very small, requiring infusoria as their initial food. F: C; live foods.

T: 22°-28°C, L: 5 cm, A: 80 cm, R: m, b, D: 3-4

520

1986

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

Pe

Cy

is ‘pa : 4

ee eA

we?

,

ne

¥¥

re

‘)

.!

A '+ wee, SO

by

Nothobranchius rubripinnis, WC, TZ 83/5 Mbezi

River, Tanzania

~

.

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Aplocheilinae

HILGENDORF,

Nothobranchius taeniopygus Stripe-finned notho Syn.: Fundulus taeniopygus, F. (Nothobranchius) orthonotus (not PETERS,

1844) Hab.: East Africa: central Tanzania, in the Bubu and Wembere River Basins.

F.l.: One

3 in 1978 by R. WILDEKAMP

and companions; several specimens were imported in 1985 from various locals by ROTH, SEEGERS, WILDEKAMP, and companions.

Sex.: dd have a yellowish to light gray body overlaid by a gray or brown reticulate design created by the edges of the scales. The fins are medium gray and yellow mottled, while the anal and caudal fins have a black edge and a yellow or white stripe proximally. This stripe may be followed by other stripes, some complete, others broken, on the anal fin. 2 2 are smaller and brown with round transparent fins.

1891

Soc. B.: Like most Nothobranchius species, this fish is usually peaceful towards heterospecifics. Conspecific 3d or related species may be attacked.

M: As for N. eggers/. The values at the collection site at the upper Wembere Basin close to the type locality 37 km west of Itigi at the train tracks to Tabora (KTZ 85/9) on the June 22, 1985, at about 9:00 were the following: ambient temperature 20.5°C, water temperature

17.2°C, pH 8.2, 6° dGH,

5° dKH, con-

ductivity 210 uS. Other localities likewise had rather low temperatures and a neutral to alkaline pH.

B: See N. eggersi, but the temperature does not need to be as high. F: C; hardy live foods, including worms. Beef heart is accepted after the animals are acclimated.

T: 18°-24°C, L: 6 cm, A: 60 cm, R: m, b, D:3

Nothobranchius kafuensis Syn.: None. Hab.: Africa: Zambia, in the Kafue Basin southwest of Lusaka. The pictured wild caught specimens represent a population from the area around the town of Chunga. A similar population was found at the town of Nega Nega.

WILDEKAMP

B: As indicated for N. eggersi. species.

1989 Fecund

F: C; live foods; worms are readily accepted. After acclimation, beef heart is eaten.

F.l.: 1979 by the Dane ROSENSTOCK from the Kayuni State Farm, Monze, Zambia. Sex.: ¢¢ have colorful orange-edged blue scales and orange fins. 2 area simple gray-brown with transparent fins.

Soc. B.: Peaceful. dd are aggressive towards other 3¢ 3 and immature or spent 2°. Best. if transported singly, particularly over long distances. M: As for N. eggers/. Although this species can be cared for in a community tank, it is not recommended. These animals require tropical temperatures and good foods (live). T: 22°-28°C, L: 5 cm, A: 60 cm, R: m, b, D: 3

522

& ROSENSTOCK,

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

, Tanzania

Nothobranchius

kafuensis,

WC, Chunga,

Zambia

oui

~

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Aplocheilinae

(DUMERIL, 1861)

Pachypanchax omalonotus Powder-blue panchax Syn.: Poecilia omalonota, Epiplatys homalonotus, Aplocheilus omalonotus, Haplochilus omalonotus, Pachypanchax homalonotus, Poecilia nuchimaculata, Pachypanchax nuchimaculatus, Panchax sakaramyi (?).

Hab.: Western and northern Madagascar and the islands of Nossi Bé. Found in rivers and creeks.

F.1.: To France at the end of 1953 by J. ARNOULT.

Sex.: 6d have elongated fins and more intense colors. The @ @’s fins are round, and they have a larger girth.

Soc. B.: Generally peaceful. Single specimens, however, may be quarrelsome. M: Simple. A suitable species for community aquaria. Water values are of secondary importance. The aquarium should

contain opportunities for concealment among plants, since ¢¢ may be intensely pursued by dd. B: Not very difficult. As for Epiplatys fasciolatus. However, the large eggs can frequently be collected from the mainte-

nance aquarium if the fish have a preferred spawning site. Juveniles frequently survive in a species tank or lightly stocked community aquarium without further ado. F: C; all types of live foods as well as commercial diets. S: This species was widely distributed in the 50's and '60’s. Unfortunately, it has since disappeared from the hobby. In 1975 anew group was imported into

France, but all the dd died, leaving only 2 2 until the captive population was once again extinct.

Ti 22°=28°@; Le sicm, AssOlcmy Raemn Dae

Nothobranchius [Paranothobranchius] ocellatus Syn.: Paranothobranchius ocellatus. Hab.: Africa: east Tanzania, in the Rufiji Basin at Mtanza and the Ruvu Basin. F.l.: One 2 was imported in 1981 by G. EGGERS, C. KASSELMANN, and L. SEEGERS. Sex.: The sexes are not always easy to distinguish. The only captured 3d was

larger than the 2. The body was bluegray, turning whitish ventrally, and the fins were yellowish to blue-gray. There were two black ocelli on the tail fin which had a yellow ring around them (sex determining characteristic?). The 2 only had one ocellus. Her fins were transparent, and her body was gray-brown. Soc. B.: While nothing is known about its social behavior, it is probably similar to other Nothobranchius species.

M: The 2 was easily cared for using suggested maintenance conditions listed T: 22°-26°C, L:6 cm, A: 80 cm, R: m, b, D:

524

(SEEGERS, 1985)

under N. eggersi. N. eggersi and P. ocellatus are found together in nature. B: Has proven impossible, since dod have not been imported. But it is suspected that breeding is similar to that of N. eggersi and N. melanospilus. F: C; live foods. In contrast to its appearance, this species does not seem to be particularly predacious.

S: N. ocellatus was found in a flood pool with N. melanospilus and N. janpapi, but despite several attempts throughout the year and many seasons, it proved impossible to capture more specimens. In

contrast to the two other species found in the same pool, this species seems to be rare,

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

§

Pachypanchax omaionotus

Nothobranchius ocellatus

2°, WC, Mtanza, Tanzania

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Aplocheilinae

Nothobranchius [Pronothobranchius] kiyawensis

“Accra Hills, Ghana“

(AHL, 1928)

Nothobranchius [Pronothobranchius] kiyawensis Syn.: Nothobranchius kiyawensis, Aphyosemion kiyawense, Fundulus gambiensis, Nothobranchius gambiensis, Aphyosemion seymouri, Pronothobranchius kiyawensis..

Hab.: West Africa: Gambia, Ghana, northern Nigeria, in savannas. So far only very disjunct distributions are known. F.1.: To Great Britain in 1968.

Sex.: dd have larger fins and a light body with numerous variable longitudinal rows of red dots. The unpaired fins have a red edge followed by a distinct (caudal fin) or faint (dorsal, anal) yellow to orange zone. From the caudal peduncle, a flamelike red-brown zone extends posteriorly into the caudal fin. 2 are more brown, even though their colors are basically the same as those found in 66, particularly the red dots. Their anterior body is rounder, and their

fins are small and transparent.

Soc. B.: Peaceful, but 6d can be very aggressive among themselves. M: Corresponds to most Nothobranchius species. See N. eggersi.

B: Similar to many Nothobranchius species, but considered more difficult. See N. eggersi. For unknown reasons, some set-ups incur high losses during storage. F: C; all types of live foods, particularly worms. S: So far, only the form from Ghana (Accra Plains) has been imported alive. It has been described as Aphyosemion seymouri. An additional form from Gambia has been imported under the name Fundulus gambiensis. \t is strange that no

T: 22°-26°C, L:6 cm, A: 80 cm, R: m, b, D: 4

526

additional

populations

have

found in this large distribution area.

been

Fam.: Aplocheilidae

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

Subfam.: Rivulinae

Pterolebias staecki 6, WC, type local “Lago Janavaca,

Manaus, Brazil”

Pterolebias staecki Staeck’s longfin killie Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: only known from the type locality: Lago Janauaca, south of the Amazon just above the confluence of the Rio Negro, south-southwest of Manaus, Brazil.

F.I.: March of 1986 by Dr. W. STAECK. Sex.: have more sign. have

dd are larger, more slender, and elongated fins. They are generally colorful and have an intense deThe smaller, stouter 2 2 commonly transparent fins.

Soc. B.: Comparatively shy and retiring. Peaceful. Conspecifics are largely ignored. They spend extensive amounts of time alone, hidden.

M: Keep this sensitive delicate fish in a species tank. Decorate as instructed for P. wischmanni. Water values from the collection site.on March 20, 1986, at 14:00 hr were as follows: ambient temT: 24°-28°C,

SEEGERS,

1987

perature 30°C, water temperature 27°C, dGH and dKH less than 1°, pH 7.2, conductivity 52 uS. B: This annual toothcarp is a substrate diver. Decorate the breeding tank as described for P. wischmanni. The peat containing the eggs is pressed lightly and slightly dried, e.g., with some newspaper, then placed into a labeled plas-

tic bag. Apparently, P. staecki demands a relatively long storage time (6 months), even at high temperatures. Place the peat into a small aquarium and add water. After one day, the peat is again dried then rehydrated. P. staecki frequently

only hatch after this process has been repeated several times. Rearing the young is nonproblematic as long as Artemia salina nauplii are fed and regular water exchanges are performed. F: C; live foods.

L: 10 cm, A: 80 cm, R: t, m, b, D: 4

527

Pu

.

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Rivulinae

SEEGERS,

Pterolebias wischmanni Spangled longfin killie Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: so far only known from the type locality, a small creek between the Rio Chipiria and Rio Amaquiria about 120 km south of Pucallpa, Peru.

Fl: July of 1981 by H. J. WISCHMANN. Sex.: 3 are larger with elongated fins and a brightly colored body. 22 are red-brown with round, transparent fins.

Soc. B.: Peaceful and rather shy. dd may be aggressive among themselves. M: Either a species tank or a community aquarium containing tranquil, not overly small fishes is appropriate. Provide hiding places and filter the tank's illumination through floating plants. Choose a dark substrate (peat), and decorate the tank with bogwood, Java moss, and Java fern. The substrate in its natural habitat

1983

was covered by a thick layer of leaves, branches, etc. The water should be slightly acid to slightly alkaline and soft.

B: P. wischmanni is an annual and a substrate diver. Place a dish containing at least 10 cm of boiled peat, which is usually an acceptable spawning substrate, in a separate breeding tank. This relatively large species demands a roomy breeding tank of corresponding proportions. Treat the peat as described for P. staecki. F: C; all types of live foods. Frozen foods and beef heart are accepted after acclimation.

T: 24°-26°C, L: 14 cm, A: 80 cm, R: t, m , b, D: 3-4

DE BEAUFORT,

Rachovia hummelincki

1940

Coastal spot-finned killie Syn.: None.

tank with bogwood adorned with plants

Hab.: South America: Colombia and Venezuela, mouth of the Rio Magdalena to the Paraguana Peninsula east of Lake Maracaibo, immediate coastal regions.

such as Java moss, Java fern, water sprite, and Anubias. Use peat instead of sand as the substrate.

F.l.: 1968 or 1969. A more could not be determined.

exact date

Sex.: dd are gray-brown with individual light gray scales distributed over the body. Dorsal and anal fins are graybrown to green with dark brown spots that sometimes join to form short lines. The inferior caudal fin has a white, yellow, or orange stripe. 22 are smaller, more uniformly brown, and have small, round, almost colorless fins.

B: The breeding tank can be decorated as described above, or the peat can be placed in a container. Each week, or after the fish have utilized the peat for spawning, remove it, blot and dry it briefly on a newspaper, and store it ina plastic bag. Diapause is about 6 months, depending on temperature. The fry immediately accept Artemia nauplii upon hatching. F: C; live foods.

Soc. B.: Peaceful. dd may be aggressive towards conspecific dd and immature or spent ¢ 2. M: This annual species is a substrate divers. Maintain in a species tank. A dark substrate is recommended. Decorate the T: 22°-26°C, L: 6 cm, A: 60 cm, R: m, b, D: 3-4

528

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

j

Pterolebias wischmanni,

Rachovia

hummelincki

WC, Amaquira,

Peru

be)

~

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Rivulinae

TAPHORN

Rachovia pyropunctata Red-spotted spot-finned killie Syn.: Rachovia

BEAUFORT,

hummelincki

(not DE

1940).

Hab.: South America: Venezuela, Lake Maracaibo Basin.

& THOMERSON,

F: C; all types of live foods, worms.

1978

including

in the

F.I.: Since this species was considered to be a population of R. hummelincki until its scientific description, the date it was first imported cannot be exactly determined. However, it was imported prior to 1973.

Sex.: While dd have numerous orange spots on their brown body (scientific name) and large fins, °° are smaller, virtually solid brown with small fins. Soc. B.: Usually peaceful. M: As for R. hummelincki. B: As for R. hummelincki. T: 22°-26°C, L: 6 cm, A: 60 cm, R: m, b, D:4

Rivulus atratus

GARMAN,

Butterfly rivulus Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: Peru, in the lower Rio Ucayali and upper Amazon Basin.

F.I.: 1981 by P. DE RHAM. Sex.: Sexes are usually difficult to distinguish. od sometimes have a longer caudal fin, but not always. 29 are slightly fuller through their anterior body.

unfortunately, they can probably be attributed more to chance than skill. The eggs are laid on fine-leaved plants. F: C; small live foods, preferably those that move in the open water or along the surface.

Soc. B.: Very peaceful and shy. This solitary living species tends to jump from the water when threatened (cover the tank!). M: Keep in densely planted, shallow aquaria. They are frequently found above the water surface on aquatic plants or stuck to the glass panes. Generally surface oriented. Use soft, slightly acid to neutral water.

B: Very difficult and rarely successful. The few breeding successes have been unable to span several generations, and T: 22°-26°C, L: up to 5 cm, A: 60 cm, R: t, D: 4

530

1895

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

§

Rachovia

pyropunctata

Rivulus atratus

3, WC,

Peru

bee

.

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Rivulinae

Rivulus

MEEK & HILDEBRAND,

cf. brunneus

Syn.: None. Hab.: Rica.

Central America:

Panama,

Costa

F.l.: The exact date is unknown. D. FROMM probably collected this fish in 1981 in Panama and imported it into Europe at the beginning of the 80's. Sex.: ¢d are often larger and always more colorful. The brown to greenish body has longitudinal rows of red-brown dots which frequently coalesce into broad striations. The caudal fin has a dark brown subjacent band and a variable yellow edge. The dorsal and anal fins are greenish to yellowish brown with longitudinal rows of red-brown dots which may either merge, forming longitudinal stripes, or be randomly distributed. Generally, the various populations have very patent designs and colors.

With fewer red-brown dots on their brown body and little color on their unpaired fins, 2 2 have little of note to distinguish themselves.

Soc. B.: Usually peaceful. Single dd may be waspish, particularly towards conspecific ¢d. Individuals may be extraordinarily

B: As for R. rubrolineatus.

F: C; all types of live foods commiserate to its size, preferably those that swim or float along the water surface.

S: The relationship between the morph presented and R. fuscolineatus BUSSING, 1980 has not been resolved. It is not unlikely that R. fuscolineatus is a synonym of R. brunneus. BBs}

BREDER,

Rivulus chucunaque

F: C; all types of live foods, particularly mosquito larvae.

Panama.

F.1.: 1984.

Sex.: dd are more colorful. They have a silver-blue body with 7-8 vertical bluegray stripes or, more probable, spots. The two anterior longitudinal stripes are also blue-gray. The dorsum is graybrown, the fins are yellowish, and the caudal fin is transversed by two longitudinal stripes, one above and one below the caudal peduncle. 2 2 have a brownish body, a very faint rendition of the 3’s design, and a Rivulus-spot on the upper caudal peduncle. Soc. B.: Peaceful. Unfortunately, animals are often very shy.

S: BREDER described two forms in 1925: Rivulus Chucunaque chucunaque, the nominate form, and R. c. sucubti from the lower Rio Sucubte Basin. It is possible that the pictured animal is not the species described by BREDER.

these

M: A shallow, moderate-sized, densely planted species tank is best, since this corresponds the best to conditions in its natural habitat. Due to the fish’s timid nature, few animals will ever be visible.

532

1925

B: As for R. rubrolineatus.

Hab.: Central America:

T: 22°-26°C,

shy.

M: As for R. hartii and R. rubrolineatus. A close fitting cover is important.

T: 20°-26°C, L: up to 7 cm, A: 60 cm, R: ie

Syn.: None.

1913

L: 7 cm, A: 60 cm, R: t, m, D: 3

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

Rivulus chucunaque

~

~

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Rivulinae

FELS & HUBER, 1985

Rivulus derhami Syn.:

1927).

Rivulus

beniensis

(not MYERS,

should be avoided. They can be housed with equal-sized fishes, but ensure

Hab.: South America: Peru, in the Rio Huallaga system at Tingo Maria.

F.I.: 1966 by K. H. LULING, Bonn. Sex.: dd are brown laterally, becoming blue-green posteriorly. There are redbrown spots on the body which sometimes merge. The unpaired fins also have red-brown dots, though they are predominantly blue-green, particularly distally. 2 2 have a Rivulus-spot on the upper caudal peduncle, a corporal pattern similar to that found on the ¢ d, but duller colors. Soc. B.: Peaceful. Usually shy. d d may occasionally be quarrelsome among themselves.

that

there are hiding places among Java moss, etc., so that dd can avoid each other.

B: As for R. magdalenae. The water should be soft with a neutral pH. Some of the very large eggs are laid just below the water surface, occasionally even above the water.

F: C; all types of live foods; worms are readily consumed. S: Much

of the information

about

this

fish has been conveyed under the name Rivulus beniensis. But R. beniensis comes

from Bolivia and has never been

imported.

M: No major demands are placed on water chemistry, but overly hard water T: 22°-26°C,

L: 5 cm, A: 60 cm, R: t, m, D: 3

MYERS,

Rivulus dibaphus Syn.: None. Hab.: South America:

northeast Brazil.

should be subdued. cover the tank well!

1927

Excellent jumper,

F.l.: To Vienna at the beginning of the '80's by A. RADDA.

B: As for R. speciosus.

Sex.: dd have larger fins and more color. They are a medium brown with dark gray to yellow-green sides overlaid with red-brown crossbands. Their stomach and throat are white, the dorsal and caudal fins are striated, and the anal fin is blue-green. 2° are smaller with round fins and medium to dark brown spots on the body.

S: The pictured species is related to R. geayi and R. agilae. While this species is probably R. dibaphus, it is not conClusive.

F: C; moderate-sized

Soc. B.: Normally peaceful. od are sometimes aggressive towards conspecific ¢ 3 and immature or spent °°. M: As for R. speciosus. The aquarium does not necessarily have to be large, but it ought to have sections with dense vegetation (Java moss). The water

should be soft to medium-hard and neutral to slightly

acid.

The

illumination

T: 24°-28°C, L: 5 cm, A: 50 cm, R: t, m, b, D: 4

534

live foods.

Killifisnhes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

bo wk

leas

Rivulus

dibaphus

~

~

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Rivulinae

BUSSING,

Rivulus fuscolineatus

Syn.: None. Hab.: Central America: northwestern Costa Rica, in the Lake Arenal and Rio Bebedero Basins.

F.I.: To the United Sates in 1979 (?) by D. FROMM; imported to Europe from there during the early '80’s. Sex.: Very similar to those of R. cf. brunneus (refer to text there). The dark design of the 6 6, however, is brighter red. 92 have more intense markings, a Rivulus-spot on the caudal peduncle, and frequently a dark shoulder spot.

1980

F: C; all live foods small enough to be consumed. S: The relationship between the forms from Costa Rica described by BUSSING (1980) and the priorly described animals from Panama is largely unclear. R. fuscolineatus may be a synonym of a previously described taxon. While there are readily apparent similarities to R. cf. brunneus, there are also divergent characteristics.

Soc. B.: Like comparable Rivulus species (see A. cf. brunneus). Often very shy. M: As for A. hartii and R. rubrolineatus. B: See AR. rubrolineatus. T: 20°-26°C, L: 7 cm, A: 60 cm, R: t, m, D: 3

Rivulus_ hartii Giant rivulus Syn.: Haplochilus hartii, Rivulus holmiae (not EIGENMANN, 1909). Hab.: South America: Trinidad and Tobago, perhaps also along the northern coast of Venezuela. F.I.: February/March of 1926 Amsterdam to Hamburg.

through

Sex.: dd are greenish and have longitudinal rows of dark round dots which can also be found in the dorsal and anal fins. The caudal fin has an inferior and superior dirty yellow fringe and an unpronounced dark fringe posteriorly. The solid brown 2° are usually smaller with rounder fins.

(BOULENGER, 1890) around the aquarium, attempt to hide, or dive into a soft substrate. In wellplanted aquaria they are hardly visible. Their behavior is highly individual. Some specimens may never overcome their shyness, while others may become relatively tame after acclimation. The tank's cover must be tight fitting. B: As for Rivulus magdalenae.

F: C; live foods, including larger items.

Soc. B.: Robust fish which may predate upon small fishes (characins, etc.). Otherwise, generally peaceful. M: Care is easy as long as water values are not extreme. Not an animal for the community aquarium. When disturbed, they leap vertically from the water, dart T: 22°-26°C,

536

L:

9cm, A: 60 cm, R: t, m, b, D: 3

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

Rivulus hartii, Arima,

Trinidad

~

~

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Rivulinae

Rivulus hildebrandi Panama rivulus Syn.: Rivulus volcanus. Hab.: Central America: western Panama.

F.I.: Unknown; maybe imported into the United States in the early '80's by D. FROMM and exported from there to Europe. Sex.: 22 have the typical Aivulus-spot on the upper edge of the caudal peduncle; however, it may be obscure in older specimens. Their fins tend to be smaller and mostly transparent. d d have slightly brighter colors. Sexual differences are little pronounced in young specimens.

MYERS,

1927

M: As indicated for R. peruanus, though R. hildebrandi is not quite as quarrelsome. B: See R. rubrolineatus. R. hildebrandi, however, has proven to be less fecund. F: C; all types of live foods, particularly those found at the water surface (e.g., wax moths). Feed flakes as the exception, not the rule. S: R. hildebrandi's long body is not particularly attractive. The species might have had an ephemeral presence in the hobby.

Soc. B.: Very shy animals. They immediately try to hide or jump out of the water

when disturbed, making housing this species with other fishes problematic. T: 20°-22°C, L: 8 cm, A: 60 cm, R: m,t, D: 3

Rivulus iridescens Iridescent rivulus Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: Peru, area around Jenaro Herrera, lower Ucayali Basin.

F.I.: 1979 by P. DE RHAM.

FELS & DE RHAM, 1981 coveries. It is possible that several of these nominate species are merely strains of R. rubrolineatus a R. limoncochae.

Sex.: dd are greenish brown and covered with longitudinal rows of red dots. The anal fin is yellow distally, whereas the upper lobe of the tail fin and upper dorsal fin are reddish-bronze color. ¢ 2 are gray-brown and have a Rivulus-spot. Soc. B.: This solitary fish is peaceful towards other fishes. M: As for R. rubrolineatus. B: As for R. rubrolineatus.

F: C; all-types of live foods, preferably those floating on the water surface. Flakes are occasionally accepted. S: R. iridescens belongs to the R. rubrolineatus o R. limoncochae complex. The relationship of these populations is confounded at this time due to new disT: 22°-26°C,

538

L: 7 cm, A: 60 cm, R: t, m, D: 3

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps

Rivulus iridescens,

Jenaro

Herrera,

Peru

ha.

.

Fam.: Aplocheilidae Subfam.: Rivulinae

Rivulus luelingi Luling’s rivulus

SEEGERS,

Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: near Joinville.

southern

Brazil,

F.1.: October of 1982 by LULING. Sex.: dd are stouter and more colorful. They are iridescent green with red-brown spots and bands on the posterior body. The caudal fin has a red semicircle near the caudal peduncle which is followed distally by yellow-green and red-brown stripes. 2° have little to recommend them as far as coloration, being solid brown with traces of darker spots and lines. The Rivulus-spot is present on the upper caudal peduncle. Soc. B.: Peaceful mals.

and

1984

at this time. The species has been maintained in captivity, but it is not considered to be an easy feat. F: C; all kinds foods.

of moderate-sized

live

rather shy ani-

M: Keep these animals in a species tank, though it does not necessarily have to be large. Densely planted sections should be present. The water should be soft and slightly acid.

B: Principally similar to that of Rivulus magaalenae. Difficult and rather unproductive. The origin of the difficulties, and hence, corrective measures, are obscure T: 18°-24°C, L: 4.5 cm, A: 50 cm, R: t, m, D: 4

Continuation of Rivulus rubrolineatus (p. 544): F: C; all types of live foods, preferably S: The relationship of R. limoncochae those that float such as insects and their and R. rubrolineatus and their relatives larvae (Drosophila, wax moths). Flake is confounded at this time due to numerfoods are also occasionally accepted. ous intermediate populations being discovered.

T: 22°-28°C, L: 7 cm, A: 60 cm, R: t, m, D: 3

540

Killifishes, Egg-Laying Toothcarps ——8° dGH and a pH of 7.0-8.5, respectively). Open spawner. Secluded rocks or T: 21°-27°C, L: 18 cm, A: 80 cm, R: m, b, D: 2

Continuation of Cichlasoma amazonarum

Species identification within this genus based on live specimens is not always simple, particularly without exact habitat information.

Some

species

have

been

known to aquarists for a long time, but were repeatedly imported and cared for under erroneous names (e.g., Cichlasoma dimerus as “Aequidens” portalegrensis).

(p. 716): Other species have probably never been imported as aquarium fishes (for example, Cichlasoma sanctifranciscense or C. araguaiense). Most Cichlasoma species will probably never be popular aquarium fishes, since their colors are often less than spectacular and typically digress with age.

T: 22°-27°C, L: 14 cm, A: 60 cm, R: m, b, D: 1

718

Cichlids —————————— a a ee

“Cichlasoma”

—— “Cichlasoma”

bartoni

a. bartoni

3

Fam.: Cichlidae

“Cichlasoma” beani Bean’s cichlid Syn.: Heros beani, Astronotus beani, Cichlasoma beani, Parapetenia beani. Hab.: Central America: Pacific seaboard of northern Mexico. Lowland rivers of the states of Sinaloa and Jalisco, in the Rio

Grande de Santiago and the Rio Presidio Basins.

F.I.: Only a few specimens have reached Germany alive. Sex.: Not known; probably lacking sexual dimorphism and dichromatism.

(JORDAN, 1888) ing places. Plants can probably be included. Avoid high temperatures and extreme acidity. A pH of 7.5 and a hardness of 10° dGH or less are suitable values. B: Open spawner with intense brood care. Courtship dress consists of contrasting black vertical lines and a light dorsum. Juveniles should be easy to raise. F: O; hardy fare is needed, but no particular demands have to be met.

Soc. B.: Since we are dealing with a moderately specialized predator, it can be assumed that “Cichlasoma” beani can stand its ground in front of other cichlids and is particularly aggressive towards conspecifics. M: Decorate a spacious tank with several securely-based rock edifications and hidT: 23°-25°C, L: 30 cm, A: 120 cm, R: b, D: 1-2

Cichlasoma boliviense Bolivian cichlasoma Syn.: None. Hab.: South America: Bolivian Amazon Basin. Found in the Mamoré, Guaporé, San Miguel, Beni, and Madre de Dios River systems.

F.1.: 1985 by W. STAECK and co-travel-

ers. Sex.: Sexes are difficult to distinguish. 3 3 are larger with a stouter head profile and more elongated fins. Sometimes behavior is a better distinguishing characteristic than physical features. Soc. B.: Tranquil retiring species which is not even particularly aggressive towards similar cichlids

KULLANDER, 1983 B: Open spawner. Eggs are small, but numerous. Fry are free-swimming six or seven days postspawning. Raising the fry with Artemia nauplii is unproblematic. Parents remain relatively congenial towards tankmates through spawning and brood care, yet are trustworthy parents.

F: O; all normal foods will be placidly accepted. S: Even after KULLANDER's revision of the genus, C. boliviense maintained its taxonomic place within Cichlasoma. The irregular spots on the caudal peduncle are a distinctive feature of this species.

M: Small aquaria are adequate owing to its inactive demeanor. Use stones, roots, and plants to provide ample hiding opportunities. Water chemistry is secondary. ApH around 7 and a hardness of 15° dGH or less will prove suitable. T: 23°-27°C, L: 17 cm, A: from 80 cm, R: b, D: 1-2

720

Cichlids

:

-)(S)